DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers www.maxim-ic.com GENERAL DESCRIPTION FEATURES The DS21455 and DS21458 are quad monolithic devices featuring independent transceivers that can be software configured for T1, E1, or J1 operation. Each is composed of a line interface unit (LIU), framer, HDLC controllers, and a TDM backplane interface, and is controlled via an 8-bit parallel port configured for Intel or Motorola bus operations. The DS21455* is a direct replacement for the older DS21Q55 quad MCM device. The DS21458, in a smaller package (17mm CSBGA) and featuring an improved controller interface, is software compatible with the older DS21Q55. Four Independent Transceivers, Each Having the Following Features: § Complete T1 (DS1)/ISDN-PRI/J1 Transceiver Functionality § Complete E1 (CEPT) PCM-30/ISDNPRI Transceiver Functionality § Short- and Long-Haul Line Interface for Clock/Data Recovery and Waveshaping § CMI Coder/Decoder § Crystal-Less Jitter Attenuator § Fully Independent Transmit and Receive Functionality § Dual HDLC Controllers § On-Chip Programmable BERT Generator and Detector § Internal Software-Selectable Receiveand Transmit-Side Termination Resistors for 75Ω/100Ω/120Ω T1 and E1 Interfaces § Dual Two-Frame Elastic-Store Slip Buffers that can Connect to Asynchronous Backplanes Up to 16.384MHz § 16.384MHz, 8.192MHz, 4.096MHz, or 2.048MHz Clock Output Synthesized to Recovered Network Clock § Programmable Output Clocks for Fractional T1, E1, H0, and H12 Applications § Interleaving PCM Bus Operation § 8-Bit Parallel Control Port, Multiplexed or Nonmultiplexed, Intel or Motorola § IEEE 1149.1 JTAG-Boundary Scan § 3.3V Supply with 5V Tolerant Inputs and Outputs § DS21455 Directly Replaces DS21Q55 § Signaling System 7 (SS7) Support § RAI-CI, AIS-CI Support *The JTAG function on the DS21455/DS21458 is a single controller for all four transceivers, unlike the DS21Q55, which has a JTAG controller-per-transceiver architecture. APPLICATIONS Routers Channel Service Units (CSUs) Data Service Units (DSUs) Muxes Switches Channel Banks T1/E1 Test Equipment ORDERING INFORMATION PART DS21455 DS21455N DS21458 DS21458N TEMP RANGE 0°C to +70°C -40°C to +85°C 0°C to +70°C -40°C to +85°C PIN-PACKAGE 256 BGA (27mm x 27mm) 256 BGA (27mm x 27mm) 256 CSBGA (17mm x 17mm) 256 CSBGA (17mm x 17mm) DALLAS is a registered trademark of Dallas Semiconductor Corp. MAXIM is a registered trademark of Maxim Integrated Products, Inc. Note: Some revisions of this device may incorporate deviations from published specifications known as errata. Multiple revisions of any device may be simultaneously available through various sales channels. For information about device errata, click here: www.maxim-ic.com/errata. 1 of 270 REV: 040804 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers DOCUMENT REVISION HISTORY REVISION 040804 CHANGES New Product Release. 2 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers TABLE OF CONTENTS 1. DESCRIPTION ................................................................................................................................................9 STANDARDS ...................................................................................................................... 10 2. FEATURE HIGHLIGHTS...............................................................................................................................11 2.1 GENERAL .......................................................................................................................... 11 2.2 LINE INTERFACE ................................................................................................................ 11 2.3 CLOCK SYNTHESIZER ........................................................................................................ 11 2.4 JITTER ATTENUATOR ......................................................................................................... 12 2.5 FRAMER/FORMATTER ........................................................................................................ 12 2.6 SYSTEM INTERFACE........................................................................................................... 13 2.7 HDLC CONTROLLERS ....................................................................................................... 13 2.8 TEST AND DIAGNOSTICS .................................................................................................... 13 2.9 EXTENDED SYSTEM INFORMATION BUS .............................................................................. 14 2.10 CONTROL PORT ................................................................................................................ 14 3. BLOCK DIAGRAM ........................................................................................................................................15 4. DS21455/DS21458 DELTA ...........................................................................................................................17 4.1 PACKAGE .......................................................................................................................... 17 4.2 CONTROLLER INTERFACE................................................................................................... 17 4.3 ESIB FUNCTION ................................................................................................................ 17 4.4 FRAMER/LIU INTERIM SIGNALS .......................................................................................... 17 5. PIN FUNCTION DESCRIPTION....................................................................................................................20 5.1 TRANSMIT SIDE PINS ......................................................................................................... 20 5.2 RECEIVE SIDE PINS ........................................................................................................... 22 5.3 PARALLEL CONTROL PORT PINS ........................................................................................ 24 5.4 EXTENDED SYSTEM INFORMATION BUS .............................................................................. 26 5.5 JTAG TEST ACCESS PORT PINS ........................................................................................ 26 5.6 LINE INTERFACE PINS ........................................................................................................ 27 5.7 SUPPLY PINS .................................................................................................................... 28 5.8 PIN DESCRIPTIONS ............................................................................................................ 29 5.9 PACKAGES ........................................................................................................................ 39 6. PARALLEL PORT .........................................................................................................................................41 6.1 REGISTER MAP ................................................................................................................. 41 7. SPECIAL PER-CHANNEL REGISTER OPERATION ..................................................................................46 8. PROGRAMMING MODEL.............................................................................................................................48 8.1 POWER-UP SEQUENCE ...................................................................................................... 49 8.1.1 Master Mode Register........................................................................................................49 8.2 INTERRUPT HANDLING ....................................................................................................... 50 8.3 STATUS REGISTERS .......................................................................................................... 50 8.4 INFORMATION REGISTERS .................................................................................................. 51 8.5 INTERRUPT INFORMATION REGISTERS ................................................................................ 51 9. CLOCK MAP .................................................................................................................................................52 10. T1 FRAMER/FORMATTER CONTROL REGISTERS .................................................................................53 10.1 T1 CONTROL REGISTERS .................................................................................................. 53 10.2 T1 TRANSMIT TRANSPARENCY ........................................................................................... 58 10.3 AIS-CI AND RAI-CI GENERATION AND DETECTION ............................................................. 59 10.4 T1 RECEIVE-SIDE DIGITAL-MILLIWATT CODE GENERATION ................................................. 60 10.5 T1 INFORMATION REGISTER............................................................................................... 62 11. E1 FRAMER/FORMATTER CONTROL REGISTERS .................................................................................64 11.1 E1 CONTROL REGISTERS .................................................................................................. 64 11.2 AUTOMATIC ALARM GENERATION ....................................................................................... 68 11.2.1 Auto AIS ...........................................................................................................................68 11.2.2 Auto RAI ...........................................................................................................................68 11.2.3 Auto E-Bit .........................................................................................................................68 11.2.4 G.706 CRC-4 Interworking ............................................................................................68 11.3 E1 INFORMATION REGISTERS ............................................................................................ 69 12. COMMON CONTROL AND STATUS REGISTERS.....................................................................................71 1.1 3 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 13. I/O PIN CONFIGURATION OPTIONS ..........................................................................................................78 14. LOOPBACK CONFIGURATIONS ................................................................................................................80 14.1 PER-CHANNEL PAYLOAD LOOPBACK .................................................................................. 83 15. ERROR COUNT REGISTERS......................................................................................................................85 15.1 LINE CODE VIOLATION COUNT REGISTER (LCVCR) ............................................................ 86 15.1.1 T1 Operation....................................................................................................................86 15.1.2 E1 Operation....................................................................................................................86 15.2 PATH CODE VIOLATION COUNT REGISTER (PCVCR) .......................................................... 88 15.2.1 T1 Operation....................................................................................................................88 15.2.2 E1 Operation....................................................................................................................88 15.3 FRAMES OUT OF SYNC COUNT REGISTER (FOSCR) .......................................................... 89 15.3.1 T1 Operation....................................................................................................................89 15.3.2 E1 Operation....................................................................................................................89 15.4 E-BIT COUNTER REGISTER (EBCR)................................................................................... 90 16. DS0 MONITORING FUNCTION ...................................................................................................................91 16.1 TRANSMIT DS0 MONITOR REGISTERS ................................................................................ 91 16.2 RECEIVE DS0 MONITOR REGISTERS .................................................................................. 92 17. SIGNALING OPERATION ............................................................................................................................93 17.1 RECEIVE SIGNALING .......................................................................................................... 93 17.1.1 Processor-Based Receive Signaling............................................................................94 17.1.2 Hardware-Based Receive Signaling ............................................................................94 17.2 TRANSMIT SIGNALING ...................................................................................................... 100 17.2.1 Processor-Based Transmit Signaling ........................................................................100 17.2.2 Software Signaling Insertion Enable Registers, E1 CAS Mode.............................104 17.2.3 Software Signaling Insertion Enable Registers, T1 Mode ......................................106 18. PER-CHANNEL IDLE CODE GENERATION ............................................................................................108 18.1 IDLE CODE PROGRAMMING EXAMPLES ............................................................................. 109 19. CHANNEL BLOCKING REGISTERS.........................................................................................................113 20. ELASTIC STORES OPERATION...............................................................................................................116 20.1 RECEIVE SIDE ................................................................................................................. 119 20.1.1 T1 Mode .........................................................................................................................119 20.1.2 E1 Mode .........................................................................................................................119 20.2 TRANSMIT SIDE ............................................................................................................... 120 20.2.1 T1 Mode .........................................................................................................................120 20.2.2 E1 Mode .........................................................................................................................120 20.3 ELASTIC STORES INITIALIZATION ...................................................................................... 120 20.4 MINIMUM-DELAY MODE ................................................................................................... 121 21. G.706 INTERMEDIATE CRC-4 UPDATING (E1 MODE ONLY)................................................................122 22. T1 BIT ORIENTED CODE (BOC) CONTROLLER.....................................................................................123 22.1 TRANSMIT BOC............................................................................................................... 123 22.2 RECEIVE BOC................................................................................................................. 123 23. ADDITIONAL (Sa) AND INTERNATIONAL (Si) BIT OPERATION (E1 ONLY) ........................................127 23.1 HARDWARE SCHEME (METHOD 1) .................................................................................... 127 23.2 INTERNAL REGISTER SCHEME BASED ON DOUBLE-FRAME (METHOD 2) ............................. 127 23.3 INTERNAL REGISTER SCHEME BASED ON CRC-4 MULTIFRAME (METHOD 3)...................... 130 24. HDLC CONTROLLERS ..............................................................................................................................141 24.1 BASIC OPERATION DETAILS ............................................................................................. 141 24.2 HDLC CONFIGURATION ................................................................................................... 143 24.2.1 FIFO Control ..................................................................................................................145 24.3 HDLC MAPPING.............................................................................................................. 146 24.3.1 Receive...........................................................................................................................146 24.3.2 Transmit .........................................................................................................................148 24.3.3 FIFO Information ...........................................................................................................153 24.3.4 Receive Packet Bytes Available .................................................................................153 24.3.5 HDLC FIFOS .................................................................................................................154 24.4 RECEIVE HDLC CODE EXAMPLE...................................................................................... 155 24.5 LEGACY FDL SUPPORT (T1 MODE) ................................................................................. 155 4 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 24.5.1 Receive Section ............................................................................................................155 24.5.2 Transmit Section ...........................................................................................................157 24.6 D4/SLC–96 OPERATION ................................................................................................. 157 25. LINE INTERFACE UNIT (LIU) ....................................................................................................................158 25.1 LIU OPERATION .............................................................................................................. 159 25.2 LIU RECEIVER ................................................................................................................ 159 25.2.1 Receive Level Indicator................................................................................................160 25.2.2 Receive G.703 Section 10 Synchronization Signal .................................................160 25.2.3 Monitor Mode.................................................................................................................160 25.3 LIU TRANSMITTER ........................................................................................................... 161 25.3.1 Transmit Short-Circuit Detector/Limiter .....................................................................161 25.3.2 Transmit Open-Circuit Detector ..................................................................................161 25.3.3 Transmit BPV Error Insertion ......................................................................................162 25.3.4 Transmit G.703 Section 10 Synchronization Signal (E1 Mode).............................162 25.4 MCLK PRESCALER ......................................................................................................... 162 25.5 JITTER ATTENUATOR ....................................................................................................... 162 25.6 CMI (CODE MARK INVERSION) OPTION ............................................................................ 163 25.7 LIU CONTROL REGISTERS ............................................................................................... 164 25.8 RECOMMENDED CIRCUITS................................................................................................ 173 25.9 COMPONENT SPECIFICATIONS.......................................................................................... 175 26. PROGRAMMABLE IN-BAND LOOP CODE GENERATION AND DETECTION......................................179 27. BERT FUNCTION .......................................................................................................................................186 27.1 BERT REGISTER DESCRIPTION ....................................................................................... 187 27.2 BERT REPETITIVE PATTERN SET..................................................................................... 192 27.3 BERT BIT COUNTER ....................................................................................................... 193 27.4 BERT ERROR COUNTER ................................................................................................. 194 28. PAYLOAD ERROR INSERTION FUNCTION ............................................................................................195 28.1 NUMBER OF ERROR REGISTERS ...................................................................................... 197 28.1.1 Number Of Errors Left Register ..................................................................................198 29. INTERLEAVED PCM BUS OPERATION ...................................................................................................199 29.1 CHANNEL INTERLEAVE MODE ........................................................................................... 199 29.2 FRAME INTERLEAVE MODE ............................................................................................... 199 30. EXTENDED SYSTEM INFORMATION BUS (ESIB) ..................................................................................202 31. PROGRAMMABLE BACKPLANE CLOCK SYNTHESIZER .....................................................................208 32. FRACTIONAL T1/E1 SUPPORT ................................................................................................................209 33. USER-PROGRAMMABLE OUTPUT PINS ................................................................................................210 34. TRANSMIT FLOW DIAGRAMS..................................................................................................................211 35. JTAG-BOUNDARY-SCAN ARCHITECTURE AND TEST-ACCESS PORT .............................................216 35.1 INSTRUCTION REGISTER .................................................................................................. 220 35.2 TEST REGISTERS............................................................................................................. 222 35.3 BOUNDARY SCAN REGISTER ............................................................................................ 222 35.4 BYPASS REGISTER .......................................................................................................... 222 35.5 IDENTIFICATION REGISTER ............................................................................................... 222 36. FUNCTIONAL TIMING DIAGRAMS...........................................................................................................228 36.1 T1 MODE ........................................................................................................................ 228 36.2 E1 MODE ........................................................................................................................ 238 37. OPERATING PARAMETERS.....................................................................................................................251 38. AC TIMING PARAMETERS AND DIAGRAMS..........................................................................................253 38.1 MULTIPLEXED BUS AC CHARACTERISTICS ........................................................................ 253 38.2 NONMULTIPLEXED BUS AC CHARACTERISTICS ................................................................. 256 38.3 RECEIVE SIDE AC CHARACTERISTICS .............................................................................. 259 38.4 TRANSMIT AC CHARACTERISTICS .................................................................................... 265 39. PACKAGE INFORMATION ........................................................................................................................269 5 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers LIST OF FIGURES Figure 3-1. DS21458 Block Diagram ......................................................................................................................... 15 Figure 3-2. DS21455 Block Diagram ......................................................................................................................... 16 Figure 4-1. DS21455 Framer/LIU Interim Signals ..................................................................................................... 18 Figure 4-2. DS21458 Framer/LIU Interim Signals ..................................................................................................... 19 Figure 5-1. DS21455 Pin Diagram, 27mm BGA........................................................................................................ 39 Figure 5-2. DS21458 Pin Diagram, 17mm CSBGA................................................................................................... 40 Figure 8-1. Programming Sequence.......................................................................................................................... 48 Figure 9-1. Clock Map ............................................................................................................................................... 52 Figure 14-1. Normal Signal Flow Diagram ................................................................................................................ 80 Figure 17-1. Simplified Diagram of Receive Signaling Path...................................................................................... 93 Figure 17-2.Simplified Diagram of Transmit Signaling Path.................................................................................... 100 Figure 21-1. CRC-4 Recalculate Method ................................................................................................................ 122 Figure 25-1. Basic Balanced Network Connections ................................................................................................ 158 Figure 25-2. Basic Unbalanced Network Connections ............................................................................................ 159 Figure 25-3. Typical Monitor Application ................................................................................................................. 160 Figure 25-4. CMI Coding ......................................................................................................................................... 163 Figure 25-5. Basic Interface..................................................................................................................................... 173 Figure 25-6. Protected Interface Using Internal Receive Termination .................................................................... 174 Figure 25-7. E1 Transmit Pulse Template ............................................................................................................... 176 Figure 25-8. T1 Transmit Pulse Template ............................................................................................................... 176 Figure 25-9. Jitter Tolerance.................................................................................................................................... 177 Figure 25-10. Jitter Attenuation (T1 Mode).............................................................................................................. 177 Figure 25-11. Jitter Attenuation (E1 Mode) ............................................................................................................. 178 Figure 29-1. IBO Example ....................................................................................................................................... 201 Figure 30-1. DS21455 ESIB Group ......................................................................................................................... 203 Figure 30-2. DS21458 ESIB Group ......................................................................................................................... 204 Figure 34-1. T1 Transmit Data Flow ........................................................................................................................ 211 Figure 34-2. T1 Transmit Data Flow (continued) ..................................................................................................... 212 Figure 34-3. E1 Transmit Data Flow........................................................................................................................ 213 Figure 34-4. E1 Transmit Data Flow (continued)..................................................................................................... 214 Figure 34-5. E1 Transmit Data Flow (continued)..................................................................................................... 215 Figure 35-1. JTAG Functional Block Diagram ......................................................................................................... 216 Figure 35-2. TAP Controller State Diagram............................................................................................................. 219 Figure 36-1. Receive Side D4 Timing...................................................................................................................... 228 Figure 36-2. Receive Side ESF Timing ................................................................................................................... 229 Figure 36-3. Receive Side Boundary Timing (With Elastic Store Disabled)............................................................ 230 Figure 36-4. Receive Side 1.544MHz Boundary Timing (With Elastic Store Enabled) ........................................... 231 Figure 36-5. Receive Side 2.048MHz Boundary Timing (With Elastic Store Enabled) ........................................... 232 Figure 36-6. Transmit Side D4 Timing..................................................................................................................... 233 Figure 36-7. Transmit Side ESF Timing .................................................................................................................. 234 Figure 36-8. Transmit Side Boundary Timing (With Elastic Store Disabled)........................................................... 235 Figure 36-9. Transmit Side 1.544MHz Boundary Timing (With Elastic Store Enabled) .......................................... 236 6 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Figure 36-10. Transmit Side 2.048MHz Boundary Timing (With Elastic Store Enabled) ........................................ 237 Figure 36-11. Receive Side Timing ......................................................................................................................... 238 Figure 36-12. Receive Side Boundary Timing (With Elastic Store Disabled).......................................................... 239 Figure 36-13. Receive Side Boundary Timing, RSYSCLK = 1.544MHz (With Elastic Store Enabled) ................... 240 Figure 36-14. Receive Side Boundary Timing, RSYSCLK = 2.048MHz (With Elastic Store Enabled) .................. 241 Figure 36-15. Receive IBO Channel Interleave Mode Timing................................................................................. 242 Figure 36-16. Receive IBO Frame Interleave Mode Timing.................................................................................... 243 Figure 36-17. G.802 Timing, E1 Mode Only............................................................................................................ 244 Figure 36-18. Transmit Side Timing ........................................................................................................................ 245 Figure 36-19. Transmit Side Boundary Timing (With Elastic Store Disabled)......................................................... 246 Figure 36-20. Transmit Side Boundary Timing, TSYSCLK = 1.544MHz (With Elastic Store Enabled) ................. 247 Figure 36-21. Transmit Side Boundary Timing, TSYSCLK = 2.048MHz (With Elastic Store Enabled) .................. 248 Figure 36-22. Transmit IBO Channel Interleave Mode Timing................................................................................ 249 Figure 36-23. Transmit IBO Frame Interleave Mode Timing................................................................................... 250 Figure 38-1. Intel Bus Read Timing (BTS = 0 / MUX = 1) ....................................................................................... 254 Figure 38-2. Intel Bus Write Timing (BTS = 0 / MUX = 1) ....................................................................................... 254 Figure 38-3. Motorola Bus Timing (BTS = 1 / MUX = 1).......................................................................................... 255 Figure 38-4. Intel Bus Read Timing (BTS = 0 / MUX = 0) ....................................................................................... 257 Figure 38-5. Intel Bus Write Timing (BTS = 0 / MUX = 0) ....................................................................................... 257 Figure 38-6. Motorola Bus Read Timing (BTS = 1 / MUX = 0) ................................................................................ 258 Figure 38-7. Motorola Bus Write Timing (BTS = 1 / MUX = 0) ................................................................................ 258 Figure 38-8. Receive Side Timing, Elastic Store Disabled (T1 Mode) .................................................................... 260 Figure 38-9. Receive Side Timing, Elastic Store Disabled (E1 Mode) .................................................................... 261 Figure 38-10. Receive Side Timing, Elastic Store Enabled (T1 Mode) ................................................................... 262 Figure 38-11. Receive Side Timing, Elastic Store Enabled (E1 Mode)................................................................... 263 Figure 38-12. Receive Line Interface Timing........................................................................................................... 264 Figure 38-13. Transmit Side Timing ........................................................................................................................ 266 Figure 38-14. Transmit Side Timing, Elastic Store Enabled.................................................................................... 267 Figure 38-15. Transmit Line Interface Timing.......................................................................................................... 268 Figure 39-1. DS21458 (17mm CSBGA) .................................................................................................................. 269 Figure 39-2. DS21455 (27mm BGA) ....................................................................................................................... 270 7 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers LIST OF TABLES Table 5-1. DS21455 PIN DESCRIPTION .................................................................................................................. 29 Table 5-2. DS21458 PIN DESCRIPTION .................................................................................................................. 34 Table 6-1. REGISTER MAP SORTED BY ADDRESS .............................................................................................. 41 Table 10-1. T1 ALARM CRITERIA ............................................................................................................................ 63 Table 11-1. E1 SYNC/RESYNC CRITERIA .............................................................................................................. 65 Table 11-2 AUTO E-BIT CONDITIONS..................................................................................................................... 68 Table 11-3. E1 ALARM CRITERIA ............................................................................................................................ 70 Table 14-1. LIUC CONTROL..................................................................................................................................... 82 Table 15-1. T1 LINE CODE VIOLATION COUNTING OPTIONS ............................................................................. 86 Table 15-2. E1 LINE CODE VIOLATION COUNTING OPTIONS............................................................................. 86 Table 15-3. T1 PATH CODE VIOLATION COUNTING ARRANGEMENTS ............................................................. 88 Table 15-4. T1 FRAMES OUT OF SYNC COUNTING ARRANGEMENTS.............................................................. 89 Table 17-1. TIME SLOT NUMBERING SCHEMES................................................................................................. 101 Table 18-1. IDLE CODE ARRAY ADDRESS MAPPING......................................................................................... 108 Table 20-1. ELASTIC STORE DELAY AFTER INITIALIZATION............................................................................ 120 Table 24-1. HDLC CONTROLLER REGISTERS .................................................................................................... 142 Table 25-1. TPD CONTROL.................................................................................................................................... 164 Table 25-2. E1 MODE WITH AUTOMATIC GAIN CONTROL MODE ENABLED (TLBC.6 = 0)............................. 165 Table 25-3. E1 MODE WITH AUTOMATIC GAIN CONTROL MODE DISABLED (TLBC.6 = 1)............................ 165 Table 25-4. T1 MODE WITH AUTOMATIC GAIN CONTROL MODE ENABLED (TLBC.6 = 0) ............................. 165 Table 25-5. T1 MODE WITH AUTOMATIC GAIN CONTROL MODE DISABLED (TLBC.6 = 1) ............................ 165 Table 25-6. TRANSFORMER SPECIFICATIONS................................................................................................... 175 Table 28-1. TRANSMIT ERROR INSERTION SETUP SEQUENCE ...................................................................... 195 Table 28-2. ERROR INSERTION EXAMPLES ....................................................................................................... 197 Table 35-1. INSTRUCTION CODES FOR IEEE 1149.1 ARCHITECTURE............................................................ 220 Table 35-2. ID CODE STRUCTURE ....................................................................................................................... 221 Table 35-3. DEVICE ID CODES.............................................................................................................................. 221 Table 35-4. BOUNDARY SCAN CONTROL BITS .................................................................................................. 223 8 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 1. DESCRIPTION The DS21455 and DS21458 are quad monolithic devices featuring independent transceivers that can be software configured for T1, E1, or J1 operation. Each is composed of a line interface unit (LIU), framer, HDLC controllers, and a TDM backplane interface, and is controlled via an 8-bit parallel port configured for Intel or Motorola bus operations. The DS21455* is a direct replacement for the older DS21Q55 quad MCM device. The DS21458, which comes in a smaller package (17mm CSBGA) and features an improved controller interface, is software compatible with the older DS21Q55. The LIU is composed of a transmit interface, receive interface, and a jitter attenuator. The transmit interface is responsible for generating the necessary waveshapes for driving the network and providing the correct source impedance depending on the type of media used. T1 waveform generation includes DSX-1 line build-outs as well as CSU line build-outs of -7.5dB, -15dB, and -22.5dB. E1 waveform generation includes G.703 waveshapes for both 75Ω coax and 120Ω twisted cables. The receive interface provides network termination and recovers clock and data from the network. The receive sensitivity adjusts automatically to the incoming signal and can be programmed for 0dB to 43dB or 0dB to 12dB for E1 applications and 0dB to 15dB or 0dB to 36dB for T1 applications. The jitter attenuator removes phase jitter from the transmitted or received signal. The crystal-less jitter attenuator requires only a 2.048MHz MCLK for both E1 and T1 applications (with the option of using a 1.544MHz MCLK in T1 applications) and can be placed in either transmit or receive data paths. An additional feature of the LIU is a CMI coder/decoder for interfacing to optical networks. On the transmit side, clock/data, and frame-sync signals are provided to the framer by the backplane interface section. The framer inserts the appropriate synchronization framing patterns and alarm information, calculates and inserts the CRC codes, and provides the B8ZS/HDB3 (zero code suppression) and AMI line coding. The receive-side framer decodes AMI, B8ZS, and HDB3 line coding, synchronizes to the data stream, reports alarm information, counts framing/coding/CRC errors, and provides clock/data and frame-sync signals to the backplane interface section. Both the transmit and receive path have two HDLC controllers. The HDLC controllers transmit and receive data via the framer block. The HDLC controllers can be assigned to any time slot, group of time slots, portion of a time slot, or to FDL (T1) or Sa bits (E1). Each controller has 128-bit FIFOs, thus reducing the amount of processor overhead required to manage the flow of data. In addition, built-in support for reducing the processor time required handles SS7 applications. The backplane interface provides a versatile method of sending and receiving data from the host system. Elastic stores provide a method for interfacing to asynchronous systems, converting from a T1/E1 network to a 2.048MHz, 4.096MHz, 8.192MHz, or N x 64kHz system backplane. The elastic stores also manage slip conditions (asynchronous interface). An interleave bus option (IBO) is provided to allow up to eight transceivers (two DS21455s/DS21458s) to share a high-speed backplane. 9 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers The parallel port provides access for control and configuration of all the DS21455/DS21458’s features. The Extended System Information Bus (ESIB) function allows up to eight transceivers, two DS21455s or two DS21458s to be accessed via a single read for interrupt status or other user-selectable alarm status information. Diagnostic capabilities include loopbacks, PRBS pattern generation/detection, and 16-bit loop-up and loop-down code generation and detection. * The JTAG function on the DS21455/DS21458 is a single controller for all four transceivers, unlike the DS21Q55, which has a JTAG controller-per-transceiver architecture. 1.1 Standards § § § § § ANSI: AT&T: ITU: ETSI: Japanese: T1.403-1995, T1.231-1993, T1.408 TR54016, TR62411 G.703, G.704, G.706, G.736, G.775, G.823, G.932, I.431, O.151, O.161 ETS 300 011, ETS 300 166, ETS 300 233, CTR4, CTR12 JTG.703, JTI.431, JJ-20.11 (CMI coding only) 10 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 2. FEATURE HIGHLIGHTS 2.1 General § § § § § § DS21455: 27mm, 1.27 pitch BGA, compatible replacement for the DS21Q55 DS21458: 17mm, 1.00 pitch CSBGA 3.3V supply with 5V tolerant inputs and outputs Evaluation kits IEEE 1149.1 JTAG-boundary scan Driver source code available from the factory 2.2 Line Interface § § § § § § § § § § § § § § § § § § § § § § Requires a single master clock (MCLK) for both E1 and T1 operation. Master clock can be 2.048MHz, 4.096MHz, 8.192MHz, or 16.384MHz. Option to use 1.544MHz, 3.088MHz, 6.276MHz, or 12.552MHz for T1-only operation Fully software configurable Short- and long-haul applications Automatic receive sensitivity adjustments Ranges include 0dB to -43dB or 0dB to -12dB for E1 applications; 0dB to -36dB or 0dB to -15dB for T1 applications Receive level indication in 2.5dB steps from -42.5dB to -2.5dB Internal receive termination option for 75Ω, 100Ω, and 120Ω lines Monitor application gain settings of 20dB, 26dB, and 32dB G.703 receive-synchronization signal-mode Flexible transmit-waveform generation T1 DSX-1 line build-outs T1 CSU line build-outs of -7.5dB, -15dB, and -22.5dB E1 waveforms include G.703 waveshapes for both 75Ω coax and 120Ω twisted cables AIS generation independent of loopbacks Alternating ones and zeros generation Square-wave output Open-drain output option NRZ format option Transmitter power-down Transmitter 50mA short-circuit limiter with exceeded indication of current limit Transmit open-circuit-detected indication Line interface function can be completely decoupled from the framer/formatter 2.3 Clock Synthesizer § § Output frequencies include 2.048MHz, 4.096MHz, 8.192MHz, and 16.384MHz Derived from recovered line clock or master clock 11 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 2.4 Jitter Attenuator § § § § 32-bit or 128-bit crystal-less jitter attenuator Requires only a 2.048MHz master clock for both E1 and T1 operation with the option to use 1.544MHz for T1 operation Can be placed in either the receive or transmit path or disabled Limit trip indication 2.5 Framer/Formatter § § § § § § § § § § § § § § § § § § § § § Fully independent transmit and receive functionality Full receive- and transmit-path transparency T1 framing formats include D4, ESF, J1-D4, J1-ESF and SLC-96 Japanese J1 support for CRC6 and yellow alarm E1 framing formats include FAS, CAS, and CRC-4 Detailed alarm- and status-reporting with optional interrupt support Large path- and line-error counters for: - T1 – BPV, CV, CRC6, and framing bit errors - E1 – BPV, CV, CRC-4, E-bit, and frame alignment errors - Timed or manual update modes User-defined Idle Code Generation on a per-channel basis in both transmit and receive paths Digital milliwatt code generation on the receive path ANSI T1.403-1998 support G.965 V5.2 link detect RAI-CI detection and generation AIS-CI detection and generation Ability to monitor one DS0 channel in both the transmit and receive paths In-band repeating-pattern generators and detectors - Three independent generators and detectors - Patterns from 1 bit to 8 bits or 16 bits in length RCL, RLOS, RRA, and RAIS alarms interrupt on change of state Flexible signaling support - Software- or hardware-based - Interrupt generated on change of signaling data - Receive-signaling freeze on loss of sync, carrier loss, or frame slip Hardware pins to indicate carrier loss and signaling freeze Automatic RAI generation to ETS 300 011 specifications Expanded access to Sa and Si bits Option to extend carrier-loss criteria to a 1ms period as per ETS 300 233 12 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 2.6 System Interface § § § § § § § § Dual two-frame, independent receive and transmit elastic stores - Independent control and clocking - Controlled-slip capability with status - Minimum-delay mode supported Supports T1 to E1 conversion Ability to pass the T1 F-bit position through the elastic stores in the 2.048MHz backplane mode Programmable output clocks for fractional T1, E1, H0, and H12 applications Interleaving PCM bus operation with rates of 4.096MHz, 8.192MHz, and 16.384MHz Hardware-signaling capability - Receive-signaling reinsertion to a backplane, multiframe sync - Availability of signaling in a separate PCM data stream - Signaling freezing Access to the data streams in between the framer/formatter and the elastic stores (DS21455) User-selectable synthesized clock output 2.7 HDLC Controllers § § § § § § § § Two independent HDLC controllers Fast load and unload features for FIFOs SS7 support for FISU transmit and receive Independent 128-byte Rx and Tx buffers with interrupt support Access FDL, Sa, or single/multiple DS0 channels DS0 access includes Nx64 or Nx56 Compatible with polled or interrupt-driven environments Bit Oriented Code (BOC) support 2.8 Test and Diagnostics § § § § § § § § § § § Programmable Bit Error Rate Testing (BERT) Pseudorandom patterns including QRSS User-defined repetitive patterns Daly pattern Error insertion for single bit or continuous Insertion options include continuous and absolute number with selectable insertion rates Total-bit and errored-bit counters Payload Error Insertion Errors can be inserted over the entire frame or selected channels F-bit corruption for line testing Loopbacks (remote, local, analog, and per-channel payload loopback) 13 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 2.9 Extended System Information Bus § Host can read interrupt and alarm status on up to eight ports (two devices) with a single-bus read 2.10 Control Port § § § § § § § 8-bit parallel control port Multiplexed or nonmultiplexed buses Intel or Motorola formats Supports polled or interrupt-driven environments Software access to device ID and silicon revision Software-reset supported with automatic clear on power-up Hardware reset pin Note: This data sheet assumes a particular nomenclature of the T1 and E1 operating environment. In each 125ms T1 frame, there are 24 8-bit channels plus a framing bit. It is assumed that the framing bit is sent first followed by channel 1. For T1 and E1 each channel is made up of 8 bits, which are numbered 1 to 8. Bit 1, the MSB, is transmitted first. Bit 8, the LSB, is transmitted last. The term “locked” is used to refer to two clock signals that are phase- or frequency-locked or derived from a common clock (i.e., a 1.544MHz clock can be locked to a 2.048MHz clock if they share the same 8kHz component). 14 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 3. BLOCK DIAGRAM Figure 3-1 shows a simplified block diagram highlighting the major components of the DS21458 and DS21455. Figure 3-1. DS21458 Block Diagram MCLK2 MCLK1 TRANSCEIVER #4 TRANSCEIVER #3 8XCLK TRANSCEIVER #2 RNEGO RPOSO RCLKO 2 HDLCs MASTER CLOCK RECEIVE LIU RTIP RRING CLOCK & DATA RECOVERY LOCAL LOOP BACK REMOTE LOOP BACK FRAMER LOOP BACK BERT RECEIVE FRAMER SYNCHRONIZATION ALARM MONITORING SIGNALING EXTRACTION HDLC EXTRACTION DS0 CONDITIONING HDB3/B8ZS DECODER JITTER ATTEN. BACKPLANE CLOCK RECEIVE BACKPLANE INTERFACE ELASTIC STORES SIGNALING BUFFERS INTERLEAVE BUS RATE CONVERSION PAYLOAD LOOPBACK TX OR RX PATH TRANSMIT LIU TTIP TRING WAVESHAPE GENERATION TPD TRANSMIT FRAMER FRAMING CRC RECALCULATE(E1) ALARM INSERTION SIGNALING INSERTION HDLC INSERTION DS0 CONDITIONING HDB3/B8ZS CODER JITTER ATTEN. DS21458 2 HDLCs (1 OF 4 TRANSCEIVERS) JTAG JTDO JTDI ESIB TPOSI TCLKO TNEGO JTCLK JTMS ESIBS0 ESIBRD JTRST ESIBS1 15 of 270 TRANSMIT TRANSMIT BACKPLANE BACKPLANE INTERFACE INTERFACE ELASTIC STORES SIGNALING BUFFERS INTERLEAVE BUS RATE CONVERSION PAYLOAD LOOPBACK BERT CPU INTERFACE MUX/NON-MUX, INTEL/MOTOROLA BPCLK RSYSCLK RCLK RSER RSIG RSIGF RSYNC RFSYNC RMSYNC RCHCLK RCHBLK RLCLK RLINK TSYSCLK TCLK TSER TSIG TSYNC TSSYNC TCHCLK TCHBLK TLCLK TLINK RLOS/LOTC DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Figure 3-2. DS21455 Block Diagram MCLK1 MCLK2 TRANSCEIVER #4 TRANSCEIVER #3 TRANSCEIVER #2 8XCLK RPOSO RPOSI RNEGO RNEGI RCLKO RCLKI 2 HDLCs MASTER CLOCK MUX CLOCK & DATA RECOVERY RRING JITTER ATTEN. TRANSMIT OR RECEIVE PATH TRANSMIT LIU TTIP WAVESHAPE GENERATION TRING BERT RECEIVE FRAMER RECEIVE LIU RTIP BACKPLANE CLOCK JITTER ATTEN. SYNCHRONIZATION ALARM MONITORING SIGNALING EXTRACTION HDLC EXTRACTION DS0 CONDITIONING HDB3/B8ZS DECODER DS21455 TRANSMIT FRAMER FRAMING CRC RECALCULAION(E1) ALARM INSERTION SIGNALING INSERTION HDLC INSERTION DS0 CONDITIONING HDB3/B8ZS CODER MUX RECEIVE BACKPLANE INTERFACE ELASTIC STORES SIGNALING BUFFERS INTERLEAVE BUS RATE CONVERSION TRANSMIT TRANSMIT BACKPLANE BACKPLANE INTERFACE INTERFACE ELASTIC STORES SIGNALING BUFFERS INTERLEAVE BUS RATE CONVERSION LIUC/TPD 2 HDLCs BERT JTAG JTDO JTCLK JTMS JTDI JTRST ESIB TPOSI TPOSO TPOSI TNEGI TNEGO TCLKI TCLKO ESIBS0 ESIBRD ESIBS1 16 of 270 CPU INTERFACE MUX/NON-MUX, INTEL/MOTOROLA BPCLK RSYSCLK RCLK RSER RSIG RSIGF RSYNC RFSYNC RMSYNC RCHCLK RCHBLK RLCLK RLINK TSYSCLK TCLK TSER TSIG TSYNC TSSYNC TCHCLK TCHBLK TLCLK TLINK RLOS/LOTC DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 4. DS21455/DS21458 DELTA This section describes the differences between the DS21455 and DS21458. 4.1 Package DS21455: 27mm, 256-pin, 1.27 ball pitch, BGA (This package has the same footprint and pinout as the DS21Q55.) DS21458: 17mm, 256-pin, 1.00 ball pitch, CSBGA 4.2 Controller Interface DS21455: The CPU interface has 8 address lines with independent chip selects (4) per transceiver. DS21458: The CPU interface has 10 address lines with a single chip select. The upper address lines, A8 and A9, act as coded transceiver selects. 4.3 ESIB Function The ESIB function provides a fast method of determining interrupt and alarm status when multiple ports (up to 8) are being controlled by a single processor. DS21455: The three ESIB signals are brought out for each transceiver. The user must externally configure the ESIB group. DS21458: The ESIB signals are internally bused and only a single set of signals are brought out to enable the connection of another DS21458 into an 8-port ESIB. 4.4 Framer/LIU Interim Signals Access to the clock and bipolar data signals between the framer and LIU function may be used for specialized applications. An internal MUX connects the framer and LIU if these signals are unused. The MUX is controlled via the LIUC/TPD pin and LIUC bit in the LBCR register. The unused inputs must be connected to ground. DS21455: The user has access to all clock and data signals between the framer and LIU on all transceivers as shown in Figure 4-1. DS21458: The user has limited access to clock and data signals between the framer and LIU on all transceivers as shown in Figure 4-2. 17 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Figure 4-1. DS21455 Framer/LIU Interim Signals RPOSO RNEGO RCLKO RPOSI RNEGI RCLKI RPOSO RNEGO RCLKO RPOSI RNEGI RCLKI #1 MUX Rx LIU Tx LIU Rx FRAMER TPOSI TNEGI TCLKI MUX Rx LIU Tx FRAMER MUX RPOSO RNEGO RCLKO #2 Tx LIU Tx FRAMER MUX TPOSI TNEGI TCLKI TPOSO TNEGO TCLKO RPOSO RNEGO RCLKO RPOSI RNEGI RCLKI TPOSO TNEGO TCLKO RPOSI RNEGI RCLKI #3 MUX Rx LIU Tx LIU #4 Rx FRAMER TPOSI TNEGI TCLKI TPOSO TNEGO TCLKO MUX Rx LIU Tx FRAMER MUX Rx FRAMER Tx LIU LIUC 18 of 270 Rx FRAMER Tx FRAMER MUX TPOSI TNEGI TCLKI TPOSO TNEGO TCLKO DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Figure 4-2. DS21458 Framer/LIU Interim Signals RPOSO2 RNEGO2 RCLKO2 RPOSO1 RNEGO1 RCLKO1 #2 #1 Rx LIU Rx LIU Rx FRAMER Tx LIU Tx FRAMER Rx FRAMER Tx LIU Tx FRAMER TPOSO1 TNEGO1 TCLKO1 TPOSO2 TNEGO2 TCLKO2 RPOSO3 RNEGO3 RCLKO3 RPOSO4 RNEGO4 RCLKO4 #3 Rx LIU #4 Rx LIU Rx FRAMER Tx LIU Tx FRAMER Rx FRAMER Tx LIU TPOSO3 TNEGO3 TCLKO3 Tx FRAMER TPOSO4 TNEGO4 TCLKO4 19 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 5. PIN FUNCTION DESCRIPTION 5.1 Transmit Side Pins Signal Name: TCLK Signal Description: Transmit Clock Signal Type: Input A 1.544 MHz or a 2.048MHz primary clock. Used to clock data through the transmit-side formatter. Signal Name: TSER Signal Description: Transmit Serial Data Signal Type: Input Transmit NRZ serial data. Sampled on the falling edge of TCLK when the transmit-side elastic store is disabled. Sampled on the falling edge of TSYSCLK when the transmit-side elastic store is enabled. Signal Name: TCHCLK Signal Description: Transmit Channel Clock Signal Type: Output A 192kHz (T1) or 256kHz (E1) clock that pulses high during the LSB of each channel. Can also be programmed to output a gated transmit-bit clock for fractional T1/E1 applications. Synchronous with TCLK when the transmit-side elastic store is disabled. Synchronous with TSYSCLK when the transmit-side elastic store is enabled. Useful for parallel-to-serial conversion of channel data. Signal Name: TCHBLK Signal Description: Transmit Channel Block Signal Type: Output A user-programmable output that can be forced high or low during any of the channels. Synchronous with TCLK when the transmit-side elastic store is disabled. Synchronous with TSYSCLK when the transmit-side elastic store is enabled. Useful for locating individual channels in drop-and-insert applications, for external per-channel loopback, and for per-channel conditioning. Signal Name: TSYSCLK Signal Description: Transmit System Clock Signal Type: Input 1.544MHz, 2.048MHz, 4.096MHz, 8.192MHz, or 16.384MHz clock. Only used when the transmit-side elastic-store function is enabled. Should be tied low in applications that do not use the transmit-side elastic store. See the Interleaved PCM Bus Operation section for details on 4.096MHz, 8.192MHz, and 16.384MHz operation using the IBO. Signal Name: TLCLK Signal Description: Transmit Link Clock Signal Type: Output Demand clock for the transmit link data [TLINK] input. T1 Mode: A 4kHz or 2kHz (ZBTSI) clock. E1 Mode: A 4kHz to 20kHz clock. Signal Name: TLINK Signal Description: Transmit Link Data Signal Type: Input If enabled, this pin will be sampled on the falling edge of TCLK for data insertion into either the FDL stream (ESF) or the Fsbit position (D4) or the Z-bit position (ZBTSI) or any combination of the Sa bit positions (E1). 20 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Signal Name: TSYNC Signal Description: Transmit Sync Signal Type: Input/Output A pulse at this pin will establish either frame or multiframe boundaries for the transmit side. Can be programmed to output either a frame or multiframe pulse. If this pin is set to output pulses at frame boundaries, it can also be set via IOCR1.3 to output double-wide pulses at signaling frames in T1 mode. Signal Name: TSSYNC Signal Description: Transmit System Sync Signal Type: Input Only used when the transmit-side elastic store is enabled. A pulse at this pin will establish either frame or multiframe boundaries for the transmit side. Should be tied low in applications that do not use the transmit-side elastic store. Signal Name: TSIG Signal Description: Transmit Signaling Input Signal Type: Input When enabled, this input will sample signaling bits for insertion into outgoing PCM data stream. Sampled on the falling edge of TCLK when the transmit-side elastic store is disabled. Sampled on the falling edge of TSYSCLK when the transmit-side elastic store is enabled. Signal Name: TESO Signal Description: Transmit Elastic Store-Data Output Signal Type: Output Updated on the rising edge of TCLK with data out of the transmit-side elastic store whether the elastic store is enabled or not. This pin is normally tied to TDATA. Signal Name: TDATA Signal Description: Transmit Data Signal Type: Input Sampled on the falling edge of TCLK with data to be clocked through the transmit-side formatter. This pin is normally tied to TESO. Signal Name: TPOSO Signal Description: Transmit Positive-Data Output Signal Type: Output Updated on the rising edge of TCLKO with the bipolar data out of the transmit-side formatter. Can be programmed to source NRZ data via the output-data format (IOCR1.0)-control bit. This pin is normally tied to TPOSI. Signal Name: TNEGO Signal Description: Transmit Negative-Data Output Signal Type: Output Updated on the rising edge of TCLKO with the bipolar data out of the transmit-side formatter. This pin is normally tied to TNEGI. Signal Name: TCLKO Signal Description: Transmit Clock Output Signal Type: Output Buffered clock that is used to clock data through the transmit-side formatter (either TCLK or RCLKI). This pin is normally tied to TCLKI. Signal Name: TPOSI (DS21455 Only) Signal Description: Transmit Positive-Data Input Signal Type: Input Sampled on the falling edge of TCLKI for data to be transmitted out onto the T1 line. Can be internally connected to TPOSO by tying the LIUC/TPD pin high. See the LIUC/TPD pin description for a full explanation of this function. TPOSI and TNEGI can be tied together in NRZ applications. 21 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Signal Name: TNEGI (DS21455 Only) Signal Description: Transmit Negative-Data Input Signal Type: Input Sampled on the falling edge of TCLKI for data to be transmitted out onto the T1 line. Can be internally connected to TNEGO by tying the LIUC/TPD pin high. See the LIUC/TPD pin description for a full explanation of the LIUC/TPD function. TPOSI and TNEGI can be tied together in NRZ applications. Signal Name: TCLKI (DS21455 Only) Signal Description: Transmit Clock Input Signal Type: Input Line interface transmit clock. Can be internally connected to TCLKO by tying the LIUC/TPD pin high. See the LIUC/TPD pin description for a full explanation of the LIUC/TPD function. 5.2 Receive Side Pins Signal Name: RLINK Signal Description: Receive Link Data Signal Type: Output T1 Mode: Updated with either FDL data (ESF) or Fs bits (D4) or Z bits (ZBTSI) one RCLK before the start of a frame. E1 Mode: Updated with the full E1 data stream on the rising edge of RCLK. Signal Name: RLCLK Signal Description: Receive Link Clock Signal Type: Output T1 Mode: A 4kHz or 2kHz (ZBTSI) clock for the RLINK output. E1 Mode: A 4kHz to 20kHz clock. Signal Name: RCLK Signal Description: Receive Clock Signal Type: Output 1.544MHz (T1) or 2.048MHz (E1) clock that is used to clock data through the receive-side framer. Signal Name: RCHCLK Signal Description: Receive Channel Clock Signal Type: Output A 192kHz (T1) or 256kHz (E1) clock that pulses high during the LSB of each channel can also be programmed to output a gated receive-bit clock for fractional T1/E1 applications. Synchronous with RCLK when the receive-side elastic store is disabled. Synchronous with RSYSCLK when the receive-side elastic store is enabled. Useful for parallel-to-serial conversion of channel data. Signal Name: RCHBLK Signal Description: Receive Channel Block Signal Type: Output A user-programmable output that can be forced high or low during any of the 24 T1 or 32 E1 channels. Synchronous with RCLK when the receive-side elastic store is disabled. Synchronous with RSYSCLK when the receive-side elastic store is enabled. Also useful for locating individual channels in drop-and-insert applications, for external per-channel loopback, and for per-channel conditioning. See the Channel Blocking Registers section. Signal Name: RSER Signal Description: Receive Serial Data Signal Type: Output Received NRZ serial data. Updated on rising edges of RCLK when the receive-side elastic store is disabled. Updated on the rising edges of RSYSCLK when the receive-side elastic store is enabled. 22 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Signal Name: RSYNC Signal Description: Receive Sync Signal Type: Input/Output An extracted pulse, one RCLK wide, is output at this pin which identifies either frame (IOCR1.5 = 0) or multiframe (IOCR1.5 = 1) boundaries. If set to output-frame boundaries then via IOCR1.6, RSYNC can also be set to output double-wide pulses on signaling frames in T1 mode. If the receive-side elastic store is enabled, then this pin can be enabled to be an input via IOCR1.4 at which a frame or multiframe boundary pulse is applied. Signal Name: RFSYNC Signal Description: Receive Frame Sync Signal Type: Output An extracted 8kHz pulse, one RCLK wide, is output at this pin, which identifies frame boundaries. Signal Name: RMSYNC Signal Description: Receive Multiframe Sync Signal Type: Output An extracted pulse, one RCLK wide (elastic store disabled) or one RSYSCLK wide (elastic store enabled), is output at this pin, which identifies multiframe boundaries. Signal Name: RDATA Signal Description: Receive Data Signal Type: Output Updated on the rising edge of RCLK with the data out of the receive-side framer. Signal Name: RSYSCLK Signal Description: Receive System Clock Signal Type: Input 1.544MHz, 2.048MHz, 4.096MHz, or 8.192MHz clock. Only used when the receive-side elastic-store function is enabled. Should be tied low in applications that do not use the receive-side elastic store. See the Interleaved PCM Bus Operation section for details on 4.096MHz and 8.192MHz operation using the IBO. Signal Name: RSIG Signal Description: Receive Signaling Output Signal Type: Output Outputs signaling bits in a PCM format. Updated on rising edges of RCLK when the receive-side elastic store is disabled. Updated on the rising edges of RSYSCLK when the receive-side elastic store is enabled. Signal Name: RLOS/LOTC Signal Description: Receive Loss of Sync/Loss of Transmit Clock Signal Type: Output A dual-function output that is controlled by the CCR1.0 control bit. This pin can be programmed to either toggle high when the synchronizer is searching for the frame and multiframe or to toggle high if the TCLK pin has not been toggled for 5ms. Signal Name: RCL Signal Description: Receive Carrier Loss Signal Type: Output Set high when the line interface detects a carrier loss. Signal Name: RSIGF Signal Description: Receive Signaling Freeze Signal Type: Output Set high when the signaling data is frozen via either automatic or manual intervention. Used to alert downstream equipment of the condition. 23 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Signal Name: BPCLK Signal Description: Backplane Clock Signal Type: Output A user-selectable synthesized clock output that is referenced to the clock that is output at the RCLK pin. Signal Name: RPOSO Signal Description: Receive Positive-Data Output Signal Type: Output Updated on the rising edge of RCLKO with bipolar data out of the line interface. This pin is normally tied to RPOSI. Signal Name: RNEGO Signal Description: Receive Negative-Data Output Signal Type: Output Updated on the rising edge of RCLKO with the bipolar data out of the line interface. This pin is normally tied to RNEGI. Signal Name: RCLKO Signal Description: Receive Clock Output Signal Type: Output Buffered recovered clock from the network. This pin is normally tied to RCLKI. Signal Name: RPOSI (DS21455 Only) Signal Description: Receive Positive Data Input Signal Type: Input Sampled on the falling edge of RCLKI for data to be clocked through the receive-side framer. RPOSI and RNEGI can be tied together for a NRZ interface. Can be internally connected to RPOSO by tying the LIUC/TPD pin high. See the LIUC/TPD pin description for a full explanation of the LIUC/TPD function. Signal Name: RNEGI (DS21455 Only) Signal Description: Receive Negative Data Input Signal Type: Input Sampled on the falling edge of RCLKI for data to be clocked through the receive-side framer. RPOSI and RNEGI can be tied together for a NRZ interface. Can be internally connected to RNEGO by tying the LIUC/TPD pin high. See the LIUC/TPD pin description for a full explanation of the LIUC/TPD function. Signal Name: RCLKI (DS21455 Only) Signal Description: Receive Clock Input Signal Type: Input Clock used to clock data through the receive-side framer. This pin is normally tied to RCLKO. Can be internally connected to RCLKO by tying the LIUC/TPD pin high. See the LIUC/TPD pin description for a full explanation of the LIUC/TPD function. 5.3 Parallel Control Port Pins Signal Name: INT Signal Description: Interrupt Signal Type: Output Flags host controller during events, alarms, and conditions defined in the status registers. Active-low open-drain output. Signal Name: TSTRST Signal Description: Tri-State Control and Device Reset Signal Type: Input A dual-function pin. A zero-to-one transition issues a hardware reset to the DS21455/DS21458 register set. A reset clears all configuration registers. Configuration register contents are set to zero. Leaving TSTRST high will tri-state all output and I/O pins (including the parallel control port). Set low for normal operation. Useful in board-level testing. 24 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Signal Name: MUX Signal Description: Bus Operation Signal Type: Input Set low to select nonmultiplexed bus operation. Set high to select multiplexed bus operation. Signal Name: AD0 to AD7 Signal Description: Data Bus [D0 to D7] or Address/Data Bus Signal Type: Input/Output In nonmultiplexed bus operation (MUX = 0), it serves as the data bus. In multiplexed bus operation (MUX = 1), it serves as an 8-bit, multiplexed address/data bus. Signal Name: A0 to A6 Signal Description: Address Bus Signal Type: Input In nonmultiplexed bus operation (MUX = 0), it serves as the address bus. In multiplexed bus operation (MUX = 1), these pins are not used and should be tied low. Signal Name: A8 and A9 (DS21458 Only) Signal Description: Address Bus Signal Type: Input Upper address pins for nonmultiplexed (MUX = 0), and multiplexed (MUX = 1) bus operation,. Signal Name: BTS Signal Description: Bus Type Select Signal Type: Input Strap high to select Motorola bus timing; strap low to select Intel bus timing. This pin controls the function of the RD (DS), ALE (AS), and WR (R/W) pins. If BTS = 1, then these pins assume the function listed in parentheses (). Signal Name: RD (DS) Signal Description: Read Input-Data Strobe Signal Type: Input RD and DS are active-low signals. DS active HIGH when MUX = 0. See the bus timing diagrams. Signal Name: CS1 (DS21455 Only) Signal Description: Chip Select for Transceiver 1 Signal Type: Input Must be low to read or write to Transceiver 1 of the device. CS1 is an active-low signal. Signal Name: CS2 (DS21455 Only) Signal Description: Chip Select for Transceiver 2 Signal Type: Input Must be low to read or write to Transceiver 2 of the device. CS2 is an active-low signal. Signal Name: CS3 (DS21455 Only) Signal Description: Chip Select for Transceiver 3 Signal Type: Input Must be low to read or write to Transceiver 3 of the device. CS3 is an active-low signal. Signal Name: CS4 (DS21455 Only) Signal Description: Chip Select for Transceiver 4 Signal Type: Input Must be low to read or write to Transceiver 4 of the device. CS4 is an active-low signal. 25 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Signal Name: CS (DS21458 Only) Signal Description: Chip Select Signal Type: Input Must be low to read or write to the device. CS is an active-low signal. Signal Name: ALE (AS)/A7 Signal Description: Address Latch Enable (Address Strobe) or A7 Signal Type: Input In nonmultiplexed bus operation (MUX = 0), it serves as the upper address bit. In multiplexed bus operation (MUX = 1), it serves to demultiplex the bus on a positive-going edge. Signal Name: WR (R/W) Signal Description: Write Input (Read/Write) Signal Type: Input WR is an active-low signal. 5.4 Extended System Information Bus Signal Name: ESIBS0 Signal Description: Extended System Information Bus Select 0 Signal Type: Input/Output Used to group two DS21455/DS21458s into a bus-sharing mode for alarm and status reporting. See the Extended System Information Bus (ESIB) section for more details. Signal Name: ESIBS1 Signal Description: Extended System Information Bus Select 1 Signal Type: Input/Output Used to group two DS21455/DS21458s into a bus-sharing mode for alarm and status reporting. See the Extended System Information Bus (ESIB) section for more details. Signal Name: ESIBRD Signal Description: Extended System Information Bus Read Signal Type: Input/Output Used to group two DS21455/DS21458s into a bus-sharing mode for alarm and status reporting. See the Extended System Information Bus (ESIB) section for more details. 5.5 JTAG Test Access Port Pins Signal Name: JTRST Signal Description: IEEE 1149.1 Test Reset Signal Type: Input JTRST is used to asynchronously reset the test access port controller. After power-up, JTRST must be toggled from low to high. This action will set the device into the JTAG DEVICE ID mode. Normal device operation is restored by pulling JTRST low. JTRST is pulled HIGH internally via a 10kW resistor operation. Signal Name: JTMS Signal Description: IEEE 1149.1 Test Mode Select Signal Type: Input This pin is sampled on the rising edge of JTCLK and is used to place the test-access port into the various defined IEEE 1149.1 states. This pin has a 10kW pullup resistor. 26 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Signal Name: JTCLK Signal Description: IEEE 1149.1 Test Clock Signal Signal Type: Input This signal is used to shift data into JTDI on the rising edge and out of JTDO on the falling edge. Signal Name: JTDI Signal Description: IEEE 1149.1 Test Data Input Signal Type: Input Test instructions and data are clocked into this pin on the rising edge of JTCLK. This pin has a 10kW pullup resistor. Signal Name: JTDO Signal Description: IEEE 1149.1 Test Data Output Signal Type: Output Test instructions and data are clocked out of this pin on the falling edge of JTCLK. If not used, this pin should be left unconnected. 5.6 Line Interface Pins Signal Name: MCLK1 Signal Description: Master Clock Input for Transceivers 1 and 2 Signal Type: Input A (50ppm) clock source. This clock is used internally for both clock/data recovery and for the jitter attenuator for both T1 and E1 modes. The clock rate can be 16.384MHz, 8.192MHz, 4.096MHz, or 2.048MHz. When using the DS21455/DS21458 in T1-only operation a 1.544MHz (50ppm) clock source can be used. MCLK1 and MCLK2 can be driven from a common clock. Signal Name: MCLK2 Signal Description: Master Clock Input for Transceivers 3 and 4 Signal Type: Input A (50ppm) clock source. This clock is used internally for both clock/data recovery and for the jitter attenuator for both T1 and E1 modes. The clock rate can be 16.384MHz, 8.192MHz, 4.096MHz, or 2.048MHz. When using the DS21455/DS21458 in T1-only operation a 1.544MHz (50ppm) clock source can be used. MCLK1 and MCLK2 can be driven from a common clock. Signal Name: LIUC/TPD (DS21455), TPD (DS21458) Signal Description: Line Interface Unit Connect/Transmit Power-Down Signal Type: Input This is a dual function pin depending on the state of the LTS bit in the LBCR register (LBCR.7). LTS = 0: In this mode the LIUC/TPD pin, along with the LIUC bit of the LBCR register controls the connection between the framer and the LIU. This function is only available on the DS21455. See the LIUC bit description in Section 14 and Table 14-1. LTS = 1: In this mode the LIUC/TPD pin along with the TPD bit in the LIC1 register (LIC1.0) controls the state of the Transmit Power-Down function. See the TPD bit description in Section 25 and Table 25-1. Signal Name: RTIP and RRING Signal Description: Receive Tip and Ring Signal Type: Input Analog inputs for clock recovery circuitry. These pins connect via a 1:1 transformer to the network. See Section 25 for details. Signal Name: TTIP and TRING Signal Description: Transmit Tip and Ring Signal Type: Output Analog line-driver outputs. These pins connect via a 1:2 step-up transformer to the network. See Section 25 for details. 27 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 5.7 Supply Pins Signal Name: DVDD Signal Description: Digital Positive Supply Signal Type: Supply 3.3V ±5%. Should be tied to the RVDD and TVDD pins. Signal Name: RVDD Signal Description: Receive Analog Positive Supply Signal Type: Supply 3.3V ±5%. Should be tied to the DVDD and TVDD pins. Signal Name: TVDD Signal Description: Transmit Analog Positive Supply Signal Type: Supply 3.3V ±5% Should be tied to the RVDD and DVDD pins. Signal Name: DVSS Signal Description: Digital Signal Ground Signal Type: Supply Should be tied to the RVSS and TVSS pins. Signal Name: RVSS Signal Description: Receive Analog Signal Ground Signal Type: Supply 0.0V. Should be tied to DVSS and TVSS. Signal Name: TVSS Signal Description: Transmit Analog Signal Ground Signal Type: Supply 0.0V. Should be tied to DVSS and RVSS. 28 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 5.8 Pin Descriptions Table 5-1. DS21455 PIN DESCRIPTION PIN U3 L17 V2 T4 V8 H4 U8 P4 M1 H17 F4 V13 P2 P3 A14 B5 K17 U11 J19 W15 U7 U9 U5 V4 U4 J3 N4 U2 V5 B12 C12 C16 D18 A9 B3 B6 C4 G20 M17 M20 P18 H3 U6 W8 A17 A20 B11 A5 NAME A0 A1 A2 A3 A4 A5 A6 A7/ALE (AS) BPCLK1 BPCLK2 BPCLK3 BPCLK4 BTS CS1 CS2 CS3 CS4 D0/AD0 D1/AD1 D2/AD2 D3/AD3 D4/AD4 D5/AD5 D6/AD6 D7/AD7 DVDD DVDD DVDD DVDD DVDD DVDD DVDD DVDD DVDD DVDD DVDD DVDD DVDD DVDD DVDD DVDD DVSS DVSS DVSS DVSS DVSS DVSS DVSS TYPE I I I I I I I I O O O O I I I I I I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — FUNCTION Address Bus Bit 0 (Lsb) Address Bus Bit 1 Address Bus Bit 2 Address Bus Bit 3 Address Bus Bit 4 Address Bus Bit 5 Address Bus Bit 6 Address Bus Bit 7 (Msb)/Address Latch Enable Backplane Clock, Transceiver 1 Backplane Clock, Transceiver 2 Backplane Clock, Transceiver 3 Backplane Clock, Transceiver 4 Bus Type Select (0 = Intel/1 = Motorola) Chip Select for Transceiver 1 Chip Select for Transceiver 2 Chip Select for Transceiver 3 Chip Select for Transceiver 4 Data Bus Bit 0/Address/Data Bus Bit 0 (Lsb) Data Bus Bit 1/Address/Data Bus Bit 1 Data Bus Bit 2/Address/Data Bus Bit 2 Data Bus Bit 3/Address/Data Bus Bit 3 Data Bus Bit 4/Address/Data Bus Bit 4 Data Bus Bit 5/Address/Data Bus Bit 5 Data Bus Bit 6/Address/Data Bus Bit 6 Data Bus Bit 7/Address/Data Bus Bit 7 (Msb) Digital Positive Supply Digital Positive Supply Digital Positive Supply Digital Positive Supply Digital Positive Supply Digital Positive Supply Digital Positive Supply Digital Positive Supply Digital Positive Supply Digital Positive Supply Digital Positive Supply Digital Positive Supply Digital Positive Supply Digital Positive Supply Digital Positive Supply Digital Positive Supply Digital Signal Ground Digital Signal Ground Digital Signal Ground Digital Signal Ground Digital Signal Ground Digital Signal Ground Digital Signal Ground 29 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers PIN B7 B9 H20 L20 N17 J4 C13 C3 U13 W6 F18 D7 T20 V9 B17 A6 J20 U1 Y15 N1 V19 W13 V18 K2 T1 W20 U10 M2 G17 G4 Y12 J1 D14 F3 U14 N3 B13 E3 M18 M4 A15 A4 R17 M3 C14 B4 T17 N2 K4 D17 A2 V14 F1 NAME DVSS DVSS DVSS DVSS DVSS ESIBRD1 ESIBRD2 ESIBRD3 ESIBRD4 ESIBS0_1 ESIBS0_2 ESIBS0_3 ESIBS0_4 ESIBS1_1 ESIBS1_2 ESIBS1_3 ESIBS1_4 INT JTCLK JTDI JTDO JTMS JTRST LIUC/TPD MCLK1 MCLK2 MUX RCHBLK1 RCHBLK2 RCHBLK3 RCHBLK4 RCHCLK1 RCHCLK2 RCHCLK3 RCHCLK4 RCLK1 RCLK2 RCLK3 RCLK4 RCLKI1 RCLKI2 RCLKI3 RCLKI4 RCLKO1 RCLKO2 RCLKO3 RCLKO4 RD (DS) RFSYNC1 RFSYNC2 RFSYNC3 RFSYNC4 RLCLK1 TYPE — — — — — I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O O I I O I I I I I I O O O O O O O O O O O O I I I I O O O O I O O O O O FUNCTION Digital Signal Ground Digital Signal Ground Digital Signal Ground Digital Signal Ground Digital Signal Ground Extended System Information Bus Read for Transceiver 1 Extended System Information Bus Read for Transceiver 2 Extended System Information Bus Read for Transceiver 3 Extended System Information Bus Read for Transceiver 4 Extended System Information Bus 0 for Transceiver 1 Extended System Information Bus 0 for Transceiver 2 Extended System Information Bus 0 for Transceiver 3 Extended System Information Bus 0 for Transceiver 4 Extended System Information Bus 1 for Transceiver 1 Extended System Information Bus 1 for Transceiver 2 Extended System Information Bus 1 for Transceiver 3 Extended System Information Bus 1 for Transceiver 4 Interrupt for All Four Transceivers JTAG Clock JTAG Data Input JTAG Data Output JTAG Test Mode Select Jtag Reset Line Interface Connect for All Four Transceivers or Transmit Power-Down Enable Master Clock for Transceiver 1 and Transceiver 3 Master Clock for Transceiver 2 and Transceiver 4 Mux Bus Select Receive Channel Block for Transceiver 1 Receive Channel Block for Transceiver 2 Receive Channel Block for Transceiver 3 Receive Channel Block for Transceiver 4 Receive Channel Clock for Transceiver 1 Receive Channel Clock for Transceiver 2 Receive Channel Clock for Transceiver 3 Receive Channel Clock for Transceiver 4 Receive Clock Output from the Framer on Transceiver 1 Receive Clock Output from the Framer on Transceiver 2 Receive Clock Output from the Framer on Transceiver 3 Receive Clock Output from the Framer on Transceiver 4 Receive Clock Input for the LIU on Transceiver 1 Receive Clock Input for the LIU on Transceiver 2 Receive Clock Input for the LIU on Transceiver 3 Receive Clock Input for the LIU on Transceiver 4 Receive Clock Output from the LIU on Transceiver 1 Receive Clock Output from the LIU on Transceiver 2 Receive Clock Output from the LIU on Transceiver 3 Receive Clock Output from the LIU On Transceiver 4 Read Input (Data Strobe) Receive Frame Sync (Before the Receive Elastic Store) for Transceiver 1 Receive Frame Sync (Before the Receive Elastic Store) for Transceiver 2 Receive Frame Sync (Before the Receive Elastic Store) for Transceiver 3 Receive Frame Sync (Before the Receive Elastic Store) for Transceiver 4 Receive Link Clock for Transceiver 1 30 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers PIN A12 D3 K18 G2 A13 A3 U12 H2 E17 E1 V11 L1 D16 F2 W16 R3 D13 A1 P17 L3 B15 C2 U17 R4 B14 B2 V15 L4 A16 B1 U15 Y11 Y14 Y17 Y20 J2 D15 E2 W17 L2 B16 C1 Y18 K1 C15 D2 V16 G1 D12 D1 V12 H1 F17 NAME RLCLK2 RLCLK3 RLCLK4 RLINK1 RLINK2 RLINK3 RLINK4 RLOS/LOTC1 RLOS/LOTC2 RLOS/LOTC3 RLOS/LOTC4 RMSYNC1 RMSYNC2 RMSYNC3 RMSYNC4 RNEGI1 RNEGI2 RNEGI3 RNEGI4 RNEGO1 RNEGO2 RNEGO3 RNEGO4 RPOSI1 RPOSI2 RPOSI3 RPOSI4 RPOSO1 RPOSO2 RPOSO3 RPOSO4 RRING1 RRING2 RRING3 RRING4 RSER1 RSER2 RSER3 RSER4 RSIG1 RSIG2 RSIG3 RSIG4 RSIGF1 RSIGF2 RSIGF3 RSIGF4 RSYNC1 RSYNC2 RSYNC3 RSYNC4 RSYSCLK1 RSYSCLK2 TYPE O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O I I I I O O O O I I I I O O O O I I I I O O O O O O O O O O O O I/O I/O I/O I/O I I FUNCTION Receive Link Clock for Transceiver 2 Receive Link Clock for Transceiver 3 Receive Link Clock for Transceiver 4 Receive Link Data for Transceiver 1 Receive Link Data for Transceiver 2 Receive Link Data for Transceiver 3 Receive Link Data for Transceiver 4 Receive Loss of Sync/Loss of Transmit Clock for Transceiver 1 Receive Loss of Sync/Loss of Transmit Clock for Transceiver 2 Receive Loss of Sync/Loss of Transmit Clock for Transceiver 3 Receive Loss of Sync/Loss of Transmit Clock For Transceiver4 Receive Multiframe Sync for Transceiver 1 Receive Multiframe Sync for Transceiver 2 Receive Multiframe Sync for Transceiver 3 Receive Multiframe Sync for Transceiver 4 Receive Negative Data for the Framer on Transceiver 1 Receive Negative Data for the Framer on Transceiver 2 Receive Negative Data for the Framer on Transceiver 3 Receive Negative Data for the Framer on Transceiver 4 Receive Negative Data from the LIU on Transceiver 1 Receive Negative Data from the LIU on Transceiver 2 Receive Negative Data from the LIU on Transceiver 3 Receive Negative Data from the LIU on Transceiver 4 Receive Positive Data for the Framer on Transceiver 1 Receive Positive Data for the Framer on Transceiver 2 Receive Positive Data for the Framer on Transceiver 3 Receive Positive Data for the Framer on Transceiver 4 Receive Positive Data from the LIU on Transceiver 1 Receive Positive Data from the LIU on Transceiver 2 Receive Positive Data from the LIU on Transceiver 3 Receive Positive Data from the LIU on Transceiver 4 Receive Analog Ring Input for Transceiver 1 Receive Analog Ring Input For Transceiver 2 Receive Analog Ring Input For Transceiver 3 Receive Analog Ring Input For Transceiver 4 Receive Serial Data for Transceiver 1 Receive Serial Data for Transceiver 2 Receive Serial Data for Transceiver 3 Receive Serial Data for Transceiver 4 Receive Signaling Output for Transceiver 1 Receive Signaling Output for Transceiver 2 Receive Signaling Output for Transceiver 3 Receive Signaling Output for Transceiver 4 Receive Signaling Freeze Output for Transceiver 1 Receive Signaling Freeze Output for Transceiver 2 Receive Signaling Freeze Output for Transceiver 3 Receive Signaling Freeze Output for Transceiver 4 Receive Sync for Transceiver 1 Receive Sync for Transceiver 2 Receive Sync for Transceiver 3 Receive Sync for Transceiver 4 Receive System Clock for Transceiver 1 Receive System Clock for Transceiver 2 31 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers PIN G3 W14 Y10 Y13 Y16 Y19 P1 J17 E4 W18 R2 T2 H19 J18 D4 D5 V20 W19 W1 F20 C11 U20 V10 A18 B8 L18 Y9 B19 B10 M19 V6 D19 C8 P20 W7 E18 A7 P19 V3 E20 D6 T18 W5 E19 C6 T19 R1 F19 D8 R20 T3 B20 D9 NAME RSYSCLK3 RSYSCLK4 RTIP1 RTIP2 RTIP3 RTIP4 RVDD RVDD RVDD RVDD RVSS RVSS RVSS RVSS RVSS RVSS RVSS RVSS TCHBLK1 TCHBLK2 TCHBLK3 TCHBLK4 TCHCLK1 TCHCLK2 TCHCLK3 TCHCLK4 TCLK1 TCLK2 TCLK3 TCLK4 TCLKI1 TCLKI2 TCLKI3 TCLKI4 TCLKO1 TCLKO2 TCLKO3 TCLKO4 TLCLK1 TLCLK2 TLCLK3 TLCLK4 TLINK1 TLINK2 TLINK3 TLINK4 TNEGI1 TNEGI2 TNEGI3 TNEGI4 TNEGO1 TNEGO2 TNEGO3 TYPE I I I I I I — — — — — — — — — — — — O O O O O O O O I I I I I I I I O O O O O O O O I I I I I I I I O O O FUNCTION Receive System Clock for Transceiver 3 Receive System Clock for Transceiver 4 Receive Analog Tip Input for Transceiver 1 Receive Analog Tip Input for Transceiver 2 Receive Analog Tip Input for Transceiver 3 Receive Analog Tip Input for Transceiver 4 Receive Analog Positive Supply Receive Analog Positive Supply Receive Analog Positive Supply Receive Analog Positive Supply Receive Analog Signal Ground Receive Analog Signal Ground Receive Analog Signal Ground Receive Analog Signal Ground Receive Analog Signal Ground Receive Analog Signal Ground Receive Analog Signal Ground Receive Analog Signal Ground Transmit Channel Block for Transceiver 1 Transmit Channel Block for Transceiver 2 Transmit Channel Block for Transceiver 3 Transmit Channel Block for Transceiver 4 Transmit Channel Clock for Transceiver 1 Transmit Channel Clock for Transceiver 2 Transmit Channel Clock for Transceiver 3 Transmit Channel Clock for Transceiver 4 Transmit Clock for Transceiver 1 Transmit Clock for Transceiver 2 Transmit Clock for Transceiver 3 Transmit Clock for Transceiver 4 Transmit Clock Input for the LIU on Transceiver 1 Transmit Clock Input for the LIU on Transceiver 2 Transmit Clock Input for the LIU on Transceiver 3 Transmit Clock Input for the LIU on Transceiver 4 Transmit Clock Output from the Framer on Transceiver 1 Transmit Clock Output from the Framer on Transceiver 2 Transmit Clock Output from the Framer on Transceiver 3 Transmit Clock Output from the Framer on Transceiver 4 Transmit Link Clock for Transceiver 1 Transmit Link Clock for Transceiver 2 Transmit Link Clock for Transceiver 3 Transmit Link Clock for Transceiver 4 Transmit Link Data for Transceiver 1 Transmit Link Data for Transceiver 2 Transmit Link Data for Transceiver 3 Transmit Link Data for Transceiver 4 Transmit Negative-Data Input for the LIU on Transceiver 1 Transmit Negative-Data Input for the LIU on Transceiver 2 Transmit Negative-Data Input for the LIU on Transceiver 3 Transmit Negative-Data Input for the LIU on Transceiver 4 Transmit Negative-Data Output from Framer on Transceiver 1 Transmit Negative-Data Output from Framer on Transceiver 2 Transmit Negative-Data Output from Framer on Transceiver 3 32 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers PIN N20 W3 C20 A8 R19 V7 C19 C9 N19 Y2 Y4 Y6 Y8 W9 C17 C10 K20 W10 C18 A10 L19 W12 B18 D10 K19 U16 V1 D20 C7 R18 W11 A19 A11 N18 Y1 Y3 Y5 Y7 W2 G19 D11 U19 W4 G18 C5 U18 K3 NAME TNEGO4 TPOSI1 TPOSI2 TPOSI3 TPOSI4 TPOSO1 TPOSO2 TPOSO3 TPOSO4 TRING1 TRING2 TRING3 TRING4 TSER1 TSER2 TSER3 TSER4 TSIG1 TSIG2 TSIG3 TSIG4 TSSYNC1 TSSYNC2 TSSYNC3 TSSYNC4 TSTRST TSYNC1 TSYNC2 TSYNC3 TSYNC4 TSYSCLK1 TSYSCLK2 TSYSCLK3 TSYSCLK4 TTIP1 TTIP2 TTIP3 TTIP4 TVDD TVDD TVDD TVDD TVSS TVSS TVSS TVSS WR (R/W) TYPE O I I I I O O O O O O O O I I I I I I I I I I I I I I/O I/O I/O I/O I I I I O O O O — — — — — — — — I FUNCTION Transmit Negative-Data Output from Framer on Transceiver 4 Transmit Positive-Data Input for the LIU on Transceiver 1 Transmit Positive-Data Input for the LIU on Transceiver 2 Transmit Positive-Data Input for the LIU on Transceiver 3 Transmit Positive-Data Input for the LIU on Transceiver 4 Transmit Positive-Data Output from Framer on Transceiver 1 Transmit Positive-Data Output from Framer on Transceiver 2 Transmit Positive-Data Output from Framer on Transceiver 3 Transmit Positive-Data Output from Framer on Transceiver 4 Transmit Analog Ring Output for Transceiver 1 Transmit Analog Ring Output for Transceiver 2 Transmit Analog Ring Output for Transceiver 3 Transmit Analog Ring Output for Transceiver 4 Transmit Serial Data for Transceiver 1 Transmit Serial Data for Transceiver 2 Transmit Serial Data for Transceiver 3 Transmit Serial Data for Transceiver 4 Transmit Signaling Input for Transceiver 1 Transmit Signaling Input for Transceiver 2 Transmit Signaling Input for Transceiver 3 Transmit Signaling Input for Transceiver 4 Transmit System Sync for Transceiver 1 Transmit System Sync for Transceiver 2 Transmit System Sync for Transceiver 3 Transmit System Sync for Transceiver 4 Test/Reset Transmit Sync for Transceiver 1 Transmit Sync for Transceiver 2 Transmit Sync for Transceiver 3 Transmit Sync for Transceiver 4 Transmit System Clock for Transceiver 1 Transmit System Clock for Transceiver 2 Transmit System Clock for Transceiver 3 Transmit System Clock for Transceiver 4 Transmit Analog Tip Output for Transceiver 1 Transmit Analog Tip Output for Transceiver 2 Transmit Analog Tip Output for Transceiver 3 Transmit Analog Tip Output for Transceiver 4 Transmit Analog Positive Supply Transmit Analog Positive Supply Transmit Analog Positive Supply Transmit Analog Positive Supply Transmit Analog Signal Ground Transmit Analog Signal Ground Transmit Analog Signal Ground Transmit Analog Signal Ground Write Input (Read/Write) 33 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Table 5-2. DS21458 PIN DESCRIPTION PIN H2 E10 H3 G4 N7 B9 T7 G2 H6 J11 J5 H13 E8 N9 B10 M8 P8 D10 N8 P7 M7 R7 G1 G3 P4 P5 P6 C11 C12 C13 D3 E3 F3 L14 M14 N14 N4 N5 N6 D11 D12 D13 D4 E4 F4 L13 M13 N13 H8 J8 NAME A0 A1 A2 A3 A4 A5 A6 A7/ALE (AS) A8 A9 BPCLK1 BPCLK2 BPCLK3 BPCLK4 BTS CS D0/AD0 D1/AD1 D2/AD2 D3/AD3 D4/AD4 D5/AD5 D6/AD6 D7/AD7 DVDD DVDD DVDD DVDD DVDD DVDD DVDD DVDD DVDD DVDD DVDD DVDD DVSS DVSS DVSS DVSS DVSS DVSS DVSS DVSS DVSS DVSS DVSS DVSS ESIBRD ESIBS0 TYPE I I I I I I I I I I O O O O I I I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — I/O I/O FUNCTION Address Bus Bit 0 (Lsb) Address Bus Bit 1 Address Bus Bit 2 Address Bus Bit 3 Address Bus Bit 4 Address Bus Bit 5 Address Bus Bit 6 Address Bus Bit 7 (Msb)/Address Latch Enable Address Bus Bit 8 Address Bus Bit 9 Backplane Clock, Transceiver 1 Backplane Clock, Transceiver 2 Backplane Clock, Transceiver 3 Backplane Clock, Transceiver 4 Bus Type Select (0 = Intel/1 = Motorola) Chip Select Data Bus Bit 0/Address/Data Bus Bit 0 (Lsb) Data Bus Bit 1/ Address/Data Bus Bit 1 Data Bus Bit 2/Address/Data Bus Bit 2 Data Bus Bit 3/Address/Data Bus Bit 3 Data Bus Bit 4/Address/Data Bus Bit 4 Data Bus Bit 5/Address/Data Bus Bit 5 Data Bus Bit 6/Address/Data Bus Bit 6 Data Bus Bit 7/Address/Data Bus Bit 7 (Msb) Digital Positive Supply Digital Positive Supply Digital Positive Supply Digital Positive Supply Digital Positive Supply Digital Positive Supply Digital Positive Supply Digital Positive Supply Digital Positive Supply Digital Positive Supply Digital Positive Supply Digital Positive Supply Digital Signal Ground Digital Signal Ground Digital Signal Ground Digital Signal Ground Digital Signal Ground Digital Signal Ground Digital Signal Ground Digital Signal Ground Digital Signal Ground Digital Signal Ground Digital Signal Ground Digital Signal Ground Extended System Information Bus Read Extended System Information Bus 0 34 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers PIN J9 H5 K16 C10 K13 J15 K14 D9 H4 J12 R8 E9 K9 P3 K3 G10 C7 R11 L2 G11 D7 M9 K8 F10 G5 K12 H9 R1 C14 A2 P14 A10 K4 G14 C6 P11 M2 F15 B6 R12 P2 C15 C3 T15 K5 E15 D6 P12 M3 G13 E6 M10 H10 NAME ESIBS1 INT JTCLK JTDI JTDO JTMS JTRST TPD MCLK1 MCLK2 MUX Unused N.C. N.C. RCHBLK1 RCHBLK2 RCHBLK3 RCHBLK4 RCHCLK1 RCHCLK2 RCHCLK3 RCHCLK4 RCLK1 RCLK2 RCLK3 RCLK4 Unused RCLKO1 RCLKO2 RCLKO3 RCLKO4 RD (DS) RFSYNC1 RFSYNC2 RFSYNC3 RFSYNC4 RLCLK1 RLCLK2 RLCLK3 RLCLK4 RLINK1 RLINK2 RLINK3 RLINK4 RLOS/LOTC1 RLOS/LOTC2 RLOS/LOTC3 RLOS/LOTC4 RMSYNC1 RMSYNC2 RMSYNC3 RMSYNC4 Unused TYPE I/O O I I O I I I I I I I — — O O O O O O O O O O O O I O O O O I O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O I FUNCTION Extended System Information Bus 1 Interrupt for All Four Transceivers JTAG Clock JTAG Data Input JTAG Data Output JTAG Test Mode Select JTAG Reset Transmit Power-Down Enable Master Clock for Transceiver 1 and Transceiver 3 Master Clock for Transceiver 2 and Transceiver 4 Mux Bus Select Connect to VSS for Proper Operation No Connection No Connection Receive Channel Block for Transceiver 1 Receive Channel Block for Transceiver 2 Receive Channel Block for Transceiver 3 Receive Channel Block for Transceiver 4 Receive Channel Clock for Transceiver 1 Receive Channel Clock for Transceiver 2 Receive Channel Clock for Transceiver 3 Receive Channel Clock for Transceiver 4 Receive Clock Output from the Framer on Transceiver 1 Receive Clock Output from the Framer on Transceiver 2 Receive Clock Output from the Framer on Transceiver 3 Receive Clock Output from the Framer on Transceiver 4 Connect to VSS for Proper Operation Receive Clock Output from the LIU on Transceiver 1 Receive Clock Output from the LIU on Transceiver 2 Receive Clock Output from the LIU on Transceiver 3 Receive Clock Output from the LIU on Transceiver 4 Read Input (Data Strobe) Receive Frame Sync (Before the Receive Elastic Store) for Transceiver 1 Receive Frame Sync (Before the Receive Elastic Store) for Transceiver 2 Receive Frame Sync (Before the Receive Elastic Store) for Transceiver 3 Receive Frame Sync (Before the Receive Elastic Store) for Transceiver 4 Receive Link Clock for Transceiver 1 Receive Link Clock for Transceiver 2 Receive Link Clock for Transceiver 3 Receive Link Clock for Transceiver 4 Receive Link Data for Transceiver 1 Receive Link Data for Transceiver 2 Receive Link Data for Transceiver 3 Receive Link Data for Transceiver 4 Receive Loss of Sync/Loss of Transmit Clock for Transceiver 1 Receive Loss of Sync/Loss of Transmit Clock for Transceiver 2 Receive Loss of Sync/Loss of Transmit Clock for Transceiver 3 Receive Loss of Sync/Loss of Transmit Clock for Transceiver 4 Receive Multiframe Sync for Transceiver 1 Receive Multiframe Sync for Transceiver 2 Receive Multiframe Sync for Transceiver 3 Receive Multiframe Sync for Transceiver 4 Connect to VSS for Proper Operation 35 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers PIN J2 H11 F8 P10 G8 J6 H12 F9 N10 L1 F16 A6 T11 J4 H14 C8 P9 K2 G15 B7 R10 L3 F14 E7 N11 K6 E14 B5 N12 J3 H15 B8 R9 K1 G16 A7 T10 H1 J16 A9 T8 N1 J1 M1 E16 H16 D16 A5 A8 A4 T12 T13 T9 NAME RNEGO1 RNEGO2 RNEGO3 RNEGO4 Unused RPOSO1 RPOSO2 RPOSO3 RPOSO4 RRING1 RRING2 RRING3 RRING4 RSER1 RSER2 RSER3 RSER4 RSIG1 RSIG2 RSIG3 RSIG4 RSIGF1 RSIGF2 RSIGF3 RSIGF4 RSYNC1 RSYNC2 RSYNC3 RSYNC4 RSYSCLK1 RSYSCLK2 RSYSCLK3 RSYSCLK4 RTIP1 RTIP2 RTIP3 RTIP4 RVDD RVDD RVDD RVDD RVSS RVSS RVSS RVSS RVSS RVSS RVSS RVSS RVSS RVSS RVSS RVSS TYPE O O O O I O O O O I I I I O O O O O O O O O O O O I/O I/O I/O I/O I I I I I I I I — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — FUNCTION Receive Negative Data from the LIU on Transceiver 1 Receive Negative Data from the LIU on Transceiver 2 Receive Negative Data from the LIU on Transceiver 3 Receive Negative Data from the LIU on Transceiver 4 Connect to VSS for Proper Operation Receive Positive Data from the LIU on Transceiver 1 Receive Positive Data from the LIU on Transceiver 2 Receive Positive Data from the LIU on Transceiver 3 Receive Positive Data from the LIU on Transceiver 4 Receive Analog Ring Input for Transceiver 1 Receive Analog Ring Input for Transceiver 2 Receive Analog Ring Input for Transceiver 3 Receive Analog Ring Input for Transceiver 4 Receive Serial Data for Transceiver 1 Receive Serial Data for Transceiver 2 Receive Serial Data for Transceiver 3 Receive Serial Data for Transceiver 4 Receive Signaling Output for Transceiver 1 Receive Signaling Output for Transceiver 2 Receive Signaling Output for Transceiver 3 Receive Signaling Output for Transceiver 4 Receive Signaling Freeze Output for Transceiver 1 Receive Signaling Freeze Output for Transceiver 2 Receive Signaling Freeze Output for Transceiver 3 Receive Signaling Freeze Output for Transceiver 4 Receive Sync for Transceiver 1 Receive Sync for Transceiver 2 Receive Sync for Transceiver 3 Receive Sync for Transceiver 4 Receive System Clock for Transceiver 1 Receive System Clock for Transceiver 2 Receive System Clock for Transceiver 3 Receive System Clock for Transceiver 4 Receive Analog Tip Input for Transceiver 1 Receive Analog Tip Input for Transceiver 2 Receive Analog Tip Input for Transceiver 3 Receive Analog Tip Input for Transceiver 4 Receive Analog Positive Supply Receive Analog Positive Supply Receive Analog Positive Supply Receive Analog Positive Supply Receive Analog Signal Ground Receive Analog Signal Ground Receive Analog Signal Ground Receive Analog Signal Ground Receive Analog Signal Ground Receive Analog Signal Ground Receive Analog Signal Ground Receive Analog Signal Ground Receive Analog Signal Ground Receive Analog Signal Ground Receive Analog Signal Ground Receive Analog Signal Ground 36 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers PIN N2 E13 C5 R13 J7 D15 B4 P13 L5 G12 F6 L9 L6 F12 F7 L11 T2 A15 B2 R16 J14 J13 P1 C16 C4 T14 K7 F11 G7 L12 M5 E12 E5 M12 T1 B15 A1 T16 L4 F13 D5 L10 R2 A16 B1 R15 R4 T4 A13 B13 D1 D2 N15 NAME TCHBLK1 TCHBLK2 TCHBLK3 TCHBLK4 TCHCLK1 TCHCLK2 TCHCLK3 TCHCLK4 TCLK1 TCLK2 TCLK3 TCLK4 Unused Unused Unused Unused TCLKO1 TCLKO2 TCLKO3 TCLKO4 TEST1 TEST2 TLCLK1 TLCLK2 TLCLK3 TLCLK4 TLINK1 TLINK2 TLINK3 TLINK4 Unused Unused Unused Unused TNEGO1 TNEGO2 TNEGO3 TNEGO4 Unused Unused Unused Unused TPOSO1 TPOSO2 TPOSO3 TPOSO4 TRING1 TRING1 TRING2 TRING2 TRING3 TRING3 TRING4 TYPE O O O O O O O O I I I I I I I I O O O O — — O O O O I I I I I I I I O O O O I I I I O O O O O O O O O O O FUNCTION Transmit Channel Block for Transceiver 1 Transmit Channel Block for Transceiver 2 Transmit Channel Block for Transceiver 3 Transmit Channel Block for Transceiver 4 Transmit Channel Clock for Transceiver 1 Transmit Channel Clock for Transceiver 2 Transmit Channel Clock for Transceiver 3 Transmit Channel Clock for Transceiver 4 Transmit Clock for Transceiver 1 Transmit Clock for Transceiver 2 Transmit Clock for Transceiver 3 Transmit Clock for Transceiver 4 Connect to VSS for Proper Operation Connect to VSS for Proper Operation Connect to VSS for Proper Operation Connect to VSS for Proper Operation Transmit Clock Output from the Framer on Transceiver 1 Transmit Clock Output from the Framer on Transceiver 2 Transmit Clock Output from the Framer on Transceiver 3 Transmit Clock Output from the Framer on Transceiver 4 Used for Factory Test – Do Not Connect Used for Factory Test – Do Not Connect Transmit Link Clock for Transceiver 1 Transmit Link Clock for Transceiver 2 Transmit Link Clock for Transceiver 3 Transmit Link Clock for Transceiver 4 Transmit Link Data for Transceiver 1 Transmit Link Data for Transceiver 2 Transmit Link Data for Transceiver 3 Transmit Link Data for Transceiver 4 Connect to VSS for Proper Operation Connect to VSS for Proper Operation Connect to VSS for Proper Operation Connect to VSS for Proper Operation Transmit Negative-Data Output from Framer on Transceiver 1 Transmit Negative-Data Output from Framer on Transceiver 2 Transmit Negative-Data Output from Framer on Transceiver 3 Transmit Negative-Data Output from Framer on Transceiver 4 Connect to VSS for Proper Operation Connect to VSS for Proper Operation Connect to VSS for Proper Operation Connect to VSS for Proper Operation Transmit Positive-Data Output from Framer on Transceiver 1 Transmit Positive-Data Output from Framer on Transceiver 2 Transmit Positive-Data Output from Framer on Transceiver 3 Transmit Positive-Data Output from Framer on Transceiver 4 Transmit Analog Ring Output for Transceiver 1 Transmit Analog Ring Output for Transceiver 1 Transmit Analog Ring Output for Transceiver 2 Transmit Analog Ring Output for Transceiver 2 Transmit Analog Ring Output for Transceiver 3 Transmit Analog Ring Output for Transceiver 3 Transmit Analog Ring Output for Transceiver 4 37 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers PIN N16 M6 G9 G6 K10 L7 E11 F5 K11 M4 D14 A3 M11 K15 N3 B16 B3 R14 H7 J10 D8 L8 R3 T3 A14 B14 C1 C2 P15 P16 R6 T6 A11 B11 F1 F2 L15 L16 R5 T5 A12 B12 E1 E2 M15 M16 C9 NAME TRING4 TSER1 TSER2 TSER3 TSER4 TSIG1 TSIG2 TSIG3 TSIG4 TSSYNC1 TSSYNC2 TSSYNC3 TSSYNC4 TSTRST TSYNC1 TSYNC2 TSYNC3 TSYNC4 TSYSCLK1 TSYSCLK2 TSYSCLK3 TSYSCLK4 TTIP1 TTIP1 TTIP2 TTIP2 TTIP3 TTIP3 TTIP4 TTIP4 TVDD TVDD TVDD TVDD TVDD TVDD TVDD TVDD TVSS TVSS TVSS TVSS TVSS TVSS TVSS TVSS WR (R/W) TYPE O I I I I I I I I I I I I I I/O I/O I/O I/O I I I I O O O O O O O O — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — I FUNCTION Transmit Analog Ring Output for Transceiver 4 Transmit Serial Data for Transceiver 1 Transmit Serial Data for Transceiver 2 Transmit Serial Data for Transceiver 3 Transmit Serial Data for Transceiver 4 Transmit Signaling Input for Transceiver 1 Transmit Signaling Input for Transceiver 2 Transmit Signaling Input for Transceiver 3 Transmit Signaling Input for Transceiver 4 Transmit System Sync for Transceiver 1 Transmit System Sync for Transceiver 2 Transmit System Sync for Transceiver 3 Transmit System Sync for Transceiver 4 Test/Reset Transmit Sync for Transceiver 1 Transmit Sync for Transceiver 2 Transmit Sync for Transceiver 3 Transmit Sync for Transceiver 4 Transmit System Clock for Transceiver 1 Transmit System Clock for Transceiver 2 Transmit System Clock for Transceiver 3 Transmit System Clock for Transceiver 4 Transmit Analog Tip Output for Transceiver 1 Transmit Analog Tip Output for Transceiver 1 Transmit Analog Tip Output for Transceiver 2 Transmit Analog Tip Output for Transceiver 2 Transmit Analog Tip Output for Transceiver 3 Transmit Analog Tip Output for Transceiver 3 Transmit Analog Tip Output for Transceiver 4 Transmit Analog Tip Output for Transceiver 4 Transmit Analog Positive Supply Transmit Analog Positive Supply Transmit Analog Positive Supply Transmit Analog Positive Supply Transmit Analog Positive Supply Transmit Analog Positive Supply Transmit Analog Positive Supply Transmit Analog Positive Supply Transmit Analog Signal Ground Transmit Analog Signal Ground Transmit Analog Signal Ground Transmit Analog Signal Ground Transmit Analog Signal Ground Transmit Analog Signal Ground Transmit Analog Signal Ground Transmit Analog Signal Ground Write Input (Read/Write) 38 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 5.9 Packages The package diagrams below show the lead pattern that will be placed on the target PC board. This is the same pattern that would be seen as viewed from the top. Figure 5-1. DS21455 Pin Diagram, 27mm BGA 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 A RNEGI3 RFSYNC3 RLINK3 RCLKI3 DVSS ESIBS13 TCLKO3 TPOSI3 DVDD TSIG3 TSYSCLK3 RLCLK2 RLINK2 CS2 RCLKI2 RPOSO2 DVSS B RPOSO3 RPOSI3 DVDD RCLKO3 CS3 DVDD DVSS TCHCLK3 DVSS TCLK3 DVSS DVDD RCLK2 RPOSI2 RNEGO2 RSIG2 ESIBS12 TSSYNC2 TCLK2 TNEGO2 C RSIG3 RNEGO3 EISBRD3 DVDD TVSS TLINK3 TSYNC3 TCLKI3 TPOSO3 TSER3 TCHBLK3 DVDD EISBRD2 RCLKO2 RSIGF2 DVDD TSER2 TSIG2 TPOSO2 TPOSI2 D RSYNC3 RSIGF3 RLCLK3 RVSS RVSS TLCLK3 ESIBS03 TNEGI3 TNEGO3 TSSYNC3 TVDD RSYNC2 RNEGI2 RCHCLK2 RSER2 DVDD TCLKI2 TSYNC2 E RLOS3 RSER3 RCLK3 RVDD RLOS2 TCLKO2 TLINK2 TLCLK2 F RLCLK1 BPCLK3 RSYSCLK2 ESIBS02 TNEGI2 TCHBLK2 G RSYNC1 RLINK1 RCHBLK2 TVSS TVDD DVDD H RSYSCLK1 RLOS1 DVSS A5 BPCLK2 N.C. RVSS DVSS J RCHCLK1 RSER1 DVDD EISBRD1 RVDD RVSS D1/AD1 ESIBS14 K RSIGF1 LIUC/TPD WR RFSYNC1 CS4 RLCLK4 TSSYNC4 TSER4 L RMSYNC1 RSIG1 RNEGO1 RPOSO1 A1 TCHCLK4 TSIG4 DVSS M BPCLK1 RCHBLK1 RCLKO1 RCLKI1 DVDD RCLK4 TCLK4 DVDD N JTDI RD RCLK1 DVDD DVSS TSYSCLK4 TPOSO4 TNEGO4 P RVDD1 BTS CS1 A7/ALE (AS) RNEGI4 DVDD TCLKO4 TCLKI4 R TNEGI1 RVSS RNEGI1 RPOSI1 RCLKI4 TSYNC4 TPOSI4 TNEGI4 T MCLK1 RVSS TNEGO1 A3 RCLKO4 TLCLK4 TLINK4 ESIBS04 U INT DVDD A0 D7/AD7 D5/AD5 DVSS D3/AD3 A6 D4/AD4 MUX D0/AD0 RLINK4 EISBRD4 RCHCLK4 RPOSO4 TSTRST RNEGO4 TVSS TVDD TCHBLK4 V TSYNC1 A2 TLCLK1 D6/AD6 DVDD TCLKI1 TPOSO1 A4 ESIBS11 TCHCLK1 RLOS4 RSYNC4 BPCLK4 RFSYNC4 RPOSI4 RSIGF4 N.C. JTRST JTDO RVSS W TCHBLK1 TVDD TPOSI1 TVSS TLINK1 ESIBS01 TCLKO1 DVSS TSER1 TSIG1 JTMS RSYSCLK4 D2/AD2 RMSYNC4 RSER4 RVDD RVSS MCLK2 Y TTIP1 TRING1 TTIP2 TRING2 TTIP3 TRING3 TTIP4 TRING4 TCLK1 RTIP1 RTIP2 RRING2 JTCLK RTIP3 RRING3 RSIG4 RTIP4 RRING4 RMSYNC3 RCHCLK3 RMSYNC2 RFSYNC2 RSYSCLK3 RCHBLK3 TSYSCLK1 TSSYNC1 RRING1 RCHBLK4 18 19 TCHCLK2 TSYSCLK2 20 DVSS NOTE: Locations C3, C13, J4, and U13 are used for the Extended System Information Bus (ESIB). These pin locations on the DS21Q352, DS21Q354, DS21Q552, and DS21Q554 are connected to ground. When replacing a DS21Qx5y with a DS21455, these signals should be routed to control logic to gain access to the ESIB. If these pins remain connected to ground, the ESIB function will be disabled. Pins labeled as “N.C.” must be unconnected. 39 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Figure 5-2. DS21458 Pin Diagram, 17mm CSBGA 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 A TNEG0 RCLKO3 TSSYNC3 RVSS RVSS RRING3 RTIP3 RVSS RVDD RD (DS) TVDD TVSS TRING2 TTIP2 TCLKO2 TPOSO2 B TPOSO3 TCLKO3 TSYNC3 TCHCLK3 RSYNC3 RLCLK3 RSIG3 RSYSCLK3 A5 BTS TVDD TVSS TRING2 TTIP2 TNEGO2 TSYNC2 C TTIP3 TTIP3 RLINK3 TLCLK3 RSER3 WR (R/W) JTDI DVDD DVDD DVDD RCLKO2 RLINK2 TLCLK2 D TRING3 TRING3 DVDD DVSS UNUSED TPD D1/AD1 DVSS DVSS DVSS TSSYNC2 TCHCLK2 E TVSS TVSS DVDD DVSS UNUSED RMSYNC3 F TVDD TVDD DVDD DVSS TSIG3 G D6/AD6 A7/ALE (AS) D7/AD7 A3 H RVDD A0 A2 J RVSS K RTIP RSIG1 L RRING1 RCHCLK1 M RVSS RLCLK1 N RVSS TCHBLK1 TSYNC1 P TLCLK1 RLINK1 R RCLKO1 T TNEGO1 TCHBLK3 RFSYNC3 RCHBLK3 RLOS/ LOTC3 RCHCLK3 TSYSCLK3 RVSS RSIGF3 BPCLK3 UNUSED A1 TSIG2 UNUSED TCHBLK2 RSYNC2 RLOS/ LOTC2 RVSS TCLK3 UNUSED RNEGO3 RPOSO3 RCLK2 TLINK3 UNUSED UNUSED RSIGF2 RLCLK2 RRING2 RCLK3 TSER3 TLINK3 UNUSED TSER2 RSIG2 RTIP2 MCLK1 INT A8 TSYSCLK1 ESIBRD UNUSED UNUSED RNEGO2 RPOSO2 BPCLK2 RSER2 RSYSCLK2 RVSS RSER1 BPCLK1 RPOSO1 TCHCLK1 ESIBS0 ESIBS1 TSYSCLK2 A9 MCLK2 TEST2 TEST1 JTMS RVDD RLOS/ LOTC1 RSYNC1 TLINK1 RCLK1 UNUSED TSER4 TSIG4 RCLK4 JTDO JTRST JSTRST JTCLK TCLK1 UNUSED TSIG1 TSYSCLK4 TCLK4 UNUSED UNUSED TLINK4 DVSS DVDD TVDD TVDD UNUSED TSER1 D4/AD4 CS UNUSED DVSS DVDD TVSS TVSS DVSS DVSS DVSS A4 D2/AD2 BPCLK4 RPOSO4 RSIGF4 RSYNC4 DVSS DVDD TRING4 TRING4 UNUSED DVDD DVDD DVDD D3/AD3 D0/AD0 RSER4 RNEGO4 RFSYNC4 RLOS/ LOTC4 TCHCLK4 RCLKO4 TTIP4 TTIP4 TPOSO1 TTIP1 TRING1 TVSS TVDD D5/AD5 MUX RSYSCLK4 RSIG4 RCHBLK4 RLCLK4 TCHBLK4 TSYNC4 TPOSO4 TCLKO4 TCLKO1 TTIP1 TRING1 TVSS TVDD A6 RVDD RVSS RTIP4 RRING4 RVSS RVSS TLCLK4 RLINK4 TNEGO4 RNEGO1 RSYSCLK1 RCHBLK1 RFSYNC1 RSIGF1 UNUSED RMSYNC1 TSSYNC1 RCHBLK2 RCHCLK2 RCHCLK4 RMSYNC4 TSSYNC4 NOTE: Pins labeled as “UNUSED” must be connected to VSS. 40 of 270 TCLK2 RMSYNC2 RFSYNC2 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 6. PARALLEL PORT The transceiver is controlled via either a nonmultiplexed (MUX = 0) or a multiplexed (MUX = 1) bus by an external microcontroller or microprocessor. The transceiver can operate with either Intel or Motorola bus timing configurations. If the BTS pin is tied low, Intel timing will be selected; if tied high, Motorola timing will be selected. All Motorola bus signals are listed in parentheses (). See the timing diagrams in the AC Electrical Characteristics for more details. 6.1 Register Map Table 6-1. REGISTER MAP SORTED BY ADDRESS ADDRESS 00 01 02 03 04 05 06 07 08 09 0A 0B 0C 0D 0E 0F 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 1A 1B 1C 1D 1E 1F 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 REGISTER NAME Master Mode Register I/O Configuration Register 1 I/O Configuration Register 2 T1 Receive Control Register 1 T1 Receive Control Register 2 T1 Transmit Control Register 1 T1 Transmit Control Register 2 T1 Common Control Register 1 Software Signaling Insertion Enable 1 Software Signaling Insertion Enable 2 Software Signaling Insertion Enable 3 Software Signaling Insertion Enable 4 T1 Receive Digital Milliwatt Enable Register 1 T1 Receive Digital Milliwatt Enable Register 2 T1 Receive Digital Milliwatt Enable Register 3 Device Identification Register Information Register 1 Information Register 2 Information Register 3 — Interrupt Information Register 1 Interrupt Information Register 2 Status Register 1 Interrupt Mask Register 1 Status Register 2 Interrupt Mask Register 2 Status Register 3 Interrupt Mask Register 3 Status Register 4 Interrupt Mask Register 4 Status Register 5 Interrupt Mask Register 5 Status Register 6 Interrupt Mask Register 6 Status Register 7 Interrupt Mask Register 7 Status Register 8 Interrupt Mask Register 8 Status Register 9 Interrupt Mask Register 9 Per-Channel Pointer Register Per-Channel Data Register 1 41 of 270 REGISTER ABBREVIATION MSTRREG IOCR1 IOCR2 T1RCR1 T1RCR2 T1TCR1 T1TCR2 T1CCR1 SSIE1 SSIE2 SSIE3 SSIE4 T1RDMR1 T1RDMR2 T1RDMR3 IDR INFO1 INFO2 INFO3 — IIR1 IIR2 SR1 IMR1 SR2 IMR2 SR3 IMR3 SR4 IMR4 SR5 IMR5 SR6 IMR6 SR7 IMR7 SR8 IMR8 SR9 IMR9 PCPR PCDR1 PAGE 49 78 79 53 53 55 56 57 104 104 105 105 61 61 61 72 62 170 69 — 51 51 171 172 72 73 74 75 76 77 118 118 150 151 150 151 125 126 190 191 46 47 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers ADDRESS 2A 2B 2C 2D 2E 2F 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 3A 3B 3C 3D 3E 3F 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 4A 4B 4C 4D 4E 4F 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 5A 5B 5C 5D 5E REGISTER NAME Per-Channel Data Register 2 Per-Channel Data Register 3 Per-Channel Data Register 4 Information Register 4 Information Register 5 Information Register 6 Information Register 7 HDLC #1 Receive Control HDLC #2 Receive Control E1 Receive Control Register 1 E1 Receive Control Register 2 E1 Transmit Control Register 1 E1 Transmit Control Register 2 BOC Control Register Receive Signaling Change Of State Information 1 Receive Signaling Change Of State Information 2 Receive Signaling Change Of State Information 3 Receive Signaling Change Of State Information 4 Receive Signaling Change Of State Interrupt Enable 1 Receive Signaling Change Of State Interrupt Enable 2 Receive Signaling Change Of State Interrupt Enable 3 Receive Signaling Change Of State Interrupt Enable 4 Signaling Control Register Error Count Configuration Register Line Code Violation Count Register 1 Line Code Violation Count Register 2 Path Code Violation Count Register 1 Path Code Violation Count Register 2 Frames Out of Sync Count Register 1 Frames Out of Sync Count Register 2 E-Bit Count Register 1 E-Bit Count Register 2 Loopback Control Register Per-Channel Loopback Enable Register 1 Per-Channel Loopback Enable Register 2 Per-Channel Loopback Enable Register 3 Per-Channel Loopback Enable Register 4 Elastic Store Control Register Transmit Signaling Register 1 Transmit Signaling Register 2 Transmit Signaling Register 3 Transmit Signaling Register 4 Transmit Signaling Register 5 Transmit Signaling Register 6 Transmit Signaling Register 7 Transmit Signaling Register 8 Transmit Signaling Register 9 Transmit Signaling Register 10 Transmit Signaling Register 11 Transmit Signaling Register 12 Transmit Signaling Register 13 Transmit Signaling Register 14 Transmit Signaling Register 15 42 of 270 REGISTER ABBREVIATION PCDR2 PCDR3 PCDR4 INFO4 INFO5 INFO6 INFO7 H1RC H2RC E1RCR1 E1RCR2 E1TCR1 E1TCR2 BOCC RSINFO1 RSINFO2 RSINFO3 RSINFO4 RSCSE1 RSCSE2 RSCSE3 RSCSE4 SIGCR ERCNT LCVCR1 LCVCR2 PCVCR1 PCVCR2 FOSCR1 FOSCR2 EBCR1 EBCR2 LBCR PCLR1 PCLR2 PCLR3 PCLR4 ESCR TS1 TS2 TS3 TS4 TS5 TS6 TS7 TS8 TS9 TS10 TS11 TS12 TS13 TS14 TS15 PAGE 47 47 47 152 152 152 69 144 144 64 65 66 67 124 99 99 99 99 99 99 99 99 96 85 87 87 88 88 90 90 90 90 80 83 83 84 84 117 102 102 102 102 102 102 102 102 102 102 102 102 102 102 102 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers ADDRESS 5F 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 6A 6B 6C 6D 6E 6F 70 71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 7A 7B 7C 7D 7E 7F 80 81 82 83 84 85 86 87 88 89 8A 8B 8C 8D 8E 8F 90 91 92 93 REGISTER NAME Transmit Signaling Register 16 Receive Signaling Register 1 Receive Signaling Register 2 Receive Signaling Register 3 Receive Signaling Register 4 Receive Signaling Register 5 Receive Signaling Register 6 Receive Signaling Register 7 Receive Signaling Register 8 Receive Signaling Register 9 Receive Signaling Register 10 Receive Signaling Register 11 Receive Signaling Register 12 Receive Signaling Register 13 Receive Signaling Register 14 Receive Signaling Register 15 Receive Signaling Register 16 Common Control Register 1 Common Control Register 2 Common Control Register 3 Common Control Register 4 Transmit Channel Monitor Select Transmit DS0 Monitor Register Receive Channel Monitor Select Receive DS0 Monitor Register Line Interface Control 1 Line Interface Control 2 Line Interface Control 3 Line Interface Control 4 Unused. Must be set = 00h for proper operation Transmit Line Build-Out Control Idle Array Address Register Per-Channel Idle Code Value Register Transmit Idle Code Enable Register 1 Transmit Idle Code Enable Register 2 Transmit Idle Code Enable Register 3 Transmit Idle Code Enable Register 4 Receive Idle Code Enable Register 1 Receive Idle Code Enable Register 2 Receive Idle Code Enable Register 3 Receive Idle Code Enable Register 4 Receive Channel Blocking Register 1 Receive Channel Blocking Register 2 Receive Channel Blocking Register 3 Receive Channel Blocking Register 4 Transmit Channel Blocking Register 1 Transmit Channel Blocking Register 2 Transmit Channel Blocking Register 3 Transmit Channel Blocking Register 4 HDLC #1 Transmit Control HDLC #1 FIFO Control HDLC #1 Receive Channel Select 1 HDLC #1 Receive Channel Select 2 43 of 270 REGISTER ABBREVIATION TS16 RS1 RS2 RS3 RS4 RS5 RS6 RS7 RS8 RS9 RS10 RS11 RS12 RS13 RS14 RS15 RS16 CCR1 CCR2 CCR3 CCR4 TDS0SEL TDS0M RDS0SEL RDS0M LIC1 LIC2 LIC3 LIC4 — TLBC IAAR PCICR TCICE1 TCICE2 TCICE3 TCICE4 RCICE1 RCICE2 RCICE3 RCICE4 RCBR1 RCBR2 RCBR3 RCBR4 TCBR1 TCBR2 TCBR3 TCBR4 H1TC H1FC H1RCS1 H1RCS2 PAGE 102 97 97 97 97 97 97 97 97 97 97 97 97 97 97 97 97 71 208 209 210 91 91 92 92 164 167 168 169 — 166 110 110 110 110 111 111 111 111 112 112 113 113 114 114 113 114 115 115 143 145 146 146 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers ADDRESS 94 95 96 97 98 99 9A 9B 9C 9D 9E 9F A0 A1 A2 A3 A4 A5 A6 A7 A8 A9 AA AB AC AD AE AF B0 B1 B2 B3 B4 B5 B6 B7 B8 B9 BA BB BC BD BE BF C0 C1 C2 C3 C4 C5 C6 C7 C8 REGISTER NAME HDLC #1 Receive Channel Select 3 HDLC #1 Receive Channel Select 4 HDLC #1 Receive Time Slot Bits/Sa Bits Select HDLC #1 Transmit Channel Select1 HDLC #1 Transmit Channel Select 2 HDLC #1 Transmit Channel Select 3 HDLC #1 Transmit Channel Select 4 HDLC #1 Transmit Time Slot Bits/Sa Bits Select HDLC #1 Receive Packet Bytes Available HDLC #1 Transmit FIFO HDLC #1 Receive FIFO HDLC #1 Transmit FIFO Buffer Available HDLC #2 Transmit Control HDLC #2 FIFO Control HDLC #2 Receive Channel Select 1 HDLC #2 Receive Channel Select 2 HDLC #2 Receive Channel Select 3 HDLC #2 Receive Channel Select 4 HDLC #2 Receive Time Slot Bits/Sa Bits Select HDLC #2 Transmit Channel Select 1 HDLC #2 Transmit Channel Select 2 HDLC #2 Transmit Channel Select 3 HDLC #2 Transmit Channel Select 4 HDLC #2 Transmit Time Slot Bits/Sa Bits Select HDLC #2 Receive Packet Bytes Available HDLC #2 Transmit FIFO HDLC #2 Receive FIFO HDLC #2 Transmit FIFO Buffer Available Extend System Information Bus Control Register 1 Extend System Information Bus Control Register 2 Extend System Information Bus Register 1 Extend System Information Bus Register 2 Extend System Information Bus Register 3 Extend System Information Bus Register 4 In-Band Code Control Register Transmit Code Definition Register 1 Transmit Code Definition Register 2 Receive Up Code Definition Register 1 Receive Up Code Definition Register 2 Receive Down Code Definition Register 1 Receive Down Code Definition Register 2 In-Band Receive Spare Control Register Receive Spare Code Definition Register 1 Receive Spare Code Definition Register 2 Receive FDL Register Transmit FDL Register Receive FDL Match Register 1 Receive FDL Match Register 2 Unused. Must be set = 00h for proper operation Interleave Bus Operation Control Register Receive Align Frame Register Receive Nonalign Frame Register Receive Si Align Frame 44 of 270 REGISTER ABBREVIATION H1RCS3 H1RCS4 H1RTSBS H1TCS1 H1TCS2 H1TCS3 H1TCS4 H1TTSBS H1RPBA H1TF H1RF H1TFBA H2TC H2FC H2RCS1 H2RCS2 H2RCS3 H2RCS4 H2RTSBS H2TCS1 H2TCS2 H2TCS3 H2TCS4 H2TTSBS H2RPBA H2TF H2RF H2TFBA ESIBCR1 ESIBCR2 ESIB1 ESIB2 ESIB3 ESIB4 IBCC TCD1 TCD2 RUPCD1 RUPCD2 RDNCD1 RDNCD2 RSCC RSCD1 RSCD2 RFDL TFDL RFDLM1 RFDLM2 — IBOC RAF RNAF RSiAF PAGE 146 146 147 148 148 148 148 149 153 154 154 153 143 145 146 146 146 146 147 148 148 148 148 149 153 154 154 153 205 206 207 207 207 207 180 181 181 182 182 183 184 184 185 185 156 157 156 156 — 200 128 128 130 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers ADDRESS C9 CA CB CC CD CE CF D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 D8 D9 DA DB DC DD DE DF E0 E1 E2 E3 E4 E5 E6 E7 E8 E9 EA EB EC ED EE EF F0 F1 F2 F3–F9, FA–FF REGISTER NAME Receive Si Nonalign Frame Receive Remote Alarm Bits Receive Sa4 Bits Receive Sa5 Bits Receive Sa6 Bits Receive Sa7 Bits Receive Sa8 Bits Transmit Align Frame Register Transmit Nonalign Frame Register Transmit Si Align Frame Transmit Si Nonalign Frame Transmit Remote Alarm Bits Transmit Sa4 Bits Transmit Sa5 Bits Transmit Sa6 Bits Transmit Sa7 Bits Transmit Sa8 Bits Transmit Sa Bit Control Register BERT Alternating Word Count Rate BERT Repetitive Pattern Set Register 1 BERT Repetitive Pattern Set Register 2 BERT Repetitive Pattern Set Register 3 BERT Repetitive Pattern Set Register 4 BERT Control Register 1 BERT Control Register 2 Unused. Must be set = 00h for proper operation BERT Bit Count Register 1 BERT Bit Count Register 2 BERT Bit Count Register 3 BERT Bit Count Register 4 BERT Error Count Register 1 BERT Error Count Register 2 BERT Error Count Register 3 BERT Interface Control Register Error Rate Control Register Number Of Errors 1 Number Of Errors 2 Number Of Errors Left 1 Number Of Errors Left 2 Unused. Must be set = 00h for proper operation Pulse Shape Adjustment 1 Pulse Shape Adjustment 2 Unused. Must be set = 00h for proper operation 45 of 270 REGISTER ABBREVIATION RSiNAF RRA RSa4 RSa5 RSa6 RSa7 RSa8 TAF TNAF TSiAF TSiNAF TRA TSa4 TSa5 TSa6 TSa7 TSa8 TSACR BAWC BRP1 BRP2 BRP3 BRP4 BC1 BC2 — BBC1 BBC2 BBC3 BBC4 BEC1 BEC2 BEC3 BIC ERC NOE1 NOE2 NOEL1 NOEL2 — PSA1 PSA2 — PAGE 131 131 132 137 133 133 134 129 129 135 136 136 137 137 138 138 139 140 191 192 192 192 192 187 188 — 193 193 193 193 194 194 194 189 196 197 197 198 198 — — — — DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 7. SPECIAL PER-CHANNEL REGISTER OPERATION Some of the features described in the data sheet that operate on a per-channel basis use a special method for channel selection. The registers involved are the per-channel pointer registers (PCPR) and per-channel data registers 1 to 4 (PCDR1–4). The user selects the function(s) that are to be applied on a per-channel basis by setting the appropriate bit(s) in the PCPR register. The user then writes to the PCDR registers to select the channels for that function. The following is an example of mapping the transmit and receive BERT function to channels 9, 10, 11, 12, 20, and 21: Write 11h to PCPR Write 00h to PCDR1 Write 0fh to PCDR2 Write 18h to PCDR3 Write 00h to PCDR4 More information about how to use these per-channel features can be found in their respective sections in the data sheet. Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 RSAOICS 0 PCPR Per-Channel Pointer Register 28h 6 RSRCS 0 5 RFCS 0 4 BRCS 0 3 THSCS 0 2 PEICS 0 Bit 0/BERT Transmit Channel Select (BTCS). Bit 1/Transmit Fractional Channel Select (TFCS). Bit 2/Payload Error Insert Channel Select (PEICS). Bit 3/Transmit Hardware Signaling Channel Select (THSCS). Bit 4/BERT Receive Channel Select (BRCS). Bit 5/Receive Fractional Channel Select (RFCS). Bit 6/Receive Signaling Reinsertion Channel Select (RSRCS). Bit 7/Receive Signaling All Ones Insertion Channel Select (RSAOICS). 46 of 270 1 TFCS 0 0 BTCS 0 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: PCDR1 Per-Channel Data Register 1 29h Bit # Name Default 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 CH8 CH7 CH6 CH5 CH4 CH3 CH2 CH1 Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: PCDR2 Per-Channel Data Register 2 2Ah Bit # Name Default 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 CH16 CH15 CH14 CH13 CH12 CH11 CH10 CH9 Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: PCDR3 Per-Channel Data Register 3 2Bh Bit # Name Default 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 CH24 CH23 CH22 CH21 CH20 CH19 CH18 CH17 Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: PCDR4 Per-Channel Data Register 4 2Ch Bit # Name Default 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 CH32 CH31 CH30 CH29 CH28 CH27 CH26 CH25 47 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 8. PROGRAMMING MODEL The DS21455/DS21458 register map is divided into three groups: T1 specific features, E1 specific features, and common features. The typical programming sequence begins with issuing a reset to the device, selecting T1 or E1 operation in the master mode register, enabling T1 or E1 functions, and enabling the common functions. The act of resetting the device automatically clears all configuration and status registers. Therefore, it is not necessary to load unused registers with zeros. Figure 8-1. Programming Sequence POWER-ON ISSUE RESET SELECT T1 OR E1 OPERATION IN MASTER MODE REGISTER PROGRAM E1 SPECIFIC REGISTERS PROGRAM T1 SPECIFIC REGISTERS PROGRAM COMMON REGISTERS DS21455/DS21458 OPERATIONAL 48 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 8.1 Power-Up Sequence The DS21455/DS21458 contain an on-chip power-up reset function, which automatically clears the writeable register space immediately after power is supplied to the device. The user can issue a chip reset at any time. Issuing a reset will disrupt traffic until the device is reprogrammed. The reset can be issued through hardware using the TSTRST pin or through software using the SFTRST function in the master mode register. The LIRST (LIC2.6) should be toggled from zero to one to reset the line interface circuitry. (It will take the DS21455/DS21458 about 40ms to recover from the LIRST bit being toggled.) Finally, after the TSYSCLK and RSYSCLK inputs are stable, the receive and transmit elastic stores should be reset (this step can be skipped if the elastic stores are disabled). 8.1.1 Master Mode Register Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: MSTRREG Master Mode Register 00h Bit # Name Default 6 — 0 7 — 0 5 — 0 4 — 0 3 TEST1 0 2 TEST0 0 1 T1/E1 0 0 SFTRST 0 Bit 0/Software Issued Reset (SFTRST). A 0 to 1 transition causes the register space to be cleared. A reset clears all configuration and status registers. The bit automatically clears itself when the reset has completed. Bit 1/Operating Mode (T1/E1). Used to select the operating mode of the framer/formatter (digital) portion of the DS21455. The operating mode of the LIU must also be programmed. 0 = T1 operation 1 = E1 operation Bits 2, 3/Test Mode Bits (TEST0, TEST1). Test modes are used to force the output pins of the DS21455 into known states. This can facilitate the checkout of assemblies during the manufacturing process and also be used to isolate devices from shared buses. TEST1 0 0 1 1 TEST0 0 1 0 1 EFFECT ON OUTPUT PINS Operate normally Force all output pins into tri-state (including all I/O pins and parallel port pins) Force all output pins low (including all I/O pins except parallel port pins) Force all output pins high (including all I/O pins except parallel port pins) Bits 4–7/Unused, must be set to zero for proper operation. 49 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 8.2 Interrupt Handling Various alarms, conditions, and events in the DS21455/DS21458 can cause interrupts. For simplicity, these are all referred to as events in this explanation. All STATUS registers can be programmed to produce interrupts. Each status register has an associated interrupt mask register. For example, SR1 (Status Register 1) has an interrupt control register called IMR1 (Interrupt Mask Register 1). Status registers are the only sources of interrupts. On power-up, all writeable registers are automatically cleared. Since bits in the IMRx registers have to be set = 1 to allow a particular event to cause an interrupt, no interrupts can occur until the host selects which events are to product interrupts. Since there are potentially many sources of interrupts, several features are available to help sort out and identify which event is causing an interrupt. When an interrupt occurs, the host should first read the IIR1, IIR2, and IIR3 registers (interrupt information registers) to identify which status register(s) is producing the interrupt. Once that is determined, the individual status register or registers can be examined to determine the exact source. In eight port configurations, two DS21455/DS21458s can be connected together via the 3-wire ESIB feature. This allows all eight transceivers to be interrogated by a single CPU port read cycle. The host can determine the synchronization status or interrupt status of eight devices with a single read. The ESIB feature also allows the user to select from various events to be examined via this method. For more information, see the ESIB section in this data sheet. Once an interrupt has occurred, the interrupt handler routine should clear the IMRx registers to stop further activity on the interrupt pin. After all interrupts have been determined and processed, the interrupt hander routine should restore the state of the IMRx registers. 8.3 Status Registers When a particular event or condition has occurred (or is still occurring in the case of conditions), the appropriate bit in a status register will be set to a one. All of the status registers operate in a latched fashion, which means that if an event or condition occurs a bit is set to a one. It will remain set until the user reads that bit. An event bit will be cleared when it is read and it will not be set again until the event has occurred again. Condition bits such as RBL, RLOS, etc., will remain set if the alarm is still present. The user will always proceed a read of any of the status registers with a write. The byte written to the register will inform the DS21455/DS21458 which bits the user wishes to read and have cleared. The user will write a byte to one of these registers, with a one in the bit positions he or she wishes to read and a zero in the bit positions he or she does not wish to obtain the latest information on. When a one is written to a bit location, the read register will be updated with the latest information. When a zero is written to a bit position, the read register will not be updated and the previous value will be held. A write to the status registers will be immediately followed by a read of the same register. This write-read scheme allows an external microcontroller or microprocessor to individually poll certain bits without disturbing the other bits in the register. This operation is key in controlling the DS21455/DS21458 with higher-order languages. Status register bits are divided into two groups, condition bits and event bits. Condition bits are typically network conditions such as loss of sync, or all ones detect. Event bits are typically markers such as the one-second timer, elastic store slip, etc. Each status register bit is labeled as a condition or event bit. Some of the status registers have bits for both the detection of a condition and the clearance of the condition. For example, SR2 has a bit that is set when the device goes into a loss of sync state (SR2.0, a condition bit) and a bit that is set (SR2.4, an event bit) when the loss of sync condition clears (goes in sync). Some of the status register bits (condition bits) do not have a separate bit for the “condition clear” event but rather the status bit can produce interrupts on both edges, setting, and clearing. These bits are marked as “double interrupt bits.” An interrupt will be produced when the condition occurs and when it clears. 50 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 8.4 Information Registers Information registers operate the same as status registers except they cannot cause interrupts. They are all latched except for INFO7 and some of the bits in INFO5 and INFO6. INFO7 register is a read only register and it reports the status of the E1 synchronizer in real time. INFO7 and some of the bits in INFO6 and INFO5 are not latched and it is not necessary to precede a read of these bits with a write. 8.5 Interrupt Information Registers The Interrupt Information Registers provide an indication of which Status Registers (SR1 through SR9) are generating an interrupt. When an interrupt occurs, the host can read IIR1 and IIR2 to quickly identify which of the 9 status registers are causing the interrupt. Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 SR8 0 IIR1 Interrupt Information Register 1 14h 6 SR7 0 5 SR6 0 4 SR5 0 Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: IIR2 Interrupt Information Register 2 15h Bit # Name Default 6 — 0 7 — 0 5 — 0 4 — 0 3 SR4 0 2 SR3 0 1 SR2 0 0 SR1 0 3 — 0 2 — 0 1 — 0 0 SR9 0 51 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 9. CLOCK MAP Figure 9-1 shows the clock map of the DS21455/DS21458. The routing for the transmit and receive clocks are shown for the various loopback modes and jitter attenuator positions. Although there is only one jitter attenuator, which can be placed in the receive or transmit path, two are shown for simplification and clarity. Figure 9-1. Clock Map MCLK PRE-SCALER LIC4.MPS0 LIC4.MPS1 2.048 TO 1.544 SYNTHESIZER LIC2.3 DJA = 1 8 x PLL LOCAL LOOPBACK RCL = 1 RXCLK JITTER ATTENUATOR SEE LIC1 REGISTER LLB = 0 LTCA RCL = 0 TO LIU JAS = 0 AND DJA = 0 DJA = 0 REMOTE LOOPBACK FRAMER LOOPBACK FLB = 0 LLB = 1 JAS = 0 OR DJA = 1 TXCLK JAS = 1 OR DJA = 1 PAYLOAD LOOPBACK (SEE NOTES) BPCLK SYNTH RECEIVE FRAMER BPCLK RCLK FLB = 1 RLB = 1 LTCA JAS = 1 AND DJA = 0 8XCLK RLB = 0 PLB = 1 TRANSMIT FORMATTER PLB = 0 TCLK MUX A B C TCLK The TCLK MUX is dependent on the state of the TCSS0 and TCSS1 bits in the LIC1 register and the state of the TCLK pin. TCSS1 0 TCSS0 0 0 1 1 0 1 1 TRANSMIT CLOCK SOURCE The TCLK pin (C) is always the source of Transmit Clock. Switch to the recovered clock (B) when the signal at the TCLK pin fails to transition after 1 channel time. Use the scaled signal (A) derived from MCLK as the Transmit Clock. The TCLK pin is ignored. Use the recovered clock (B) as the Transmit Clock. The TCLK pin is ignored. 52 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 10. T1 FRAMER/FORMATTER CONTROL REGISTERS The T1 framer portion of the DS21455/DS21458 is configured via a set of nine control registers. Typically, the control registers are only accessed when the system is first powered up. Once the device has been initialized, the control registers will only need to be accessed when there is a change in the system configuration. There are two receive-control registers (T1RCR1 and T1RCR2), two transmit control registers (T1TCR1 and T1TCR2), and a common control register (T1CCR1). Each of these registers is described in this section. 10.1 T1 Control Registers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 — 0 T1RCR1 T1 Receive Control Register 1 03h 6 ARC 0 5 OOF1 0 4 OOF2 0 3 SYNCC 0 2 SYNCT 0 1 SYNCE 0 0 RESYNC 0 Bit 0/Resynchronize (RESYNC). When toggled from low to high, a resynchronization of the receive side framer is initiated. Must be cleared and set again for a subsequent resync. Bit 1/Sync Enable (SYNCE). 0 = auto resync enabled 1 = auto resync disabled Bit 2/Sync Time (SYNCT). 0 = qualify 10 bits 1 = qualify 24 bits Bit 3/Sync Criteria (SYNCC). In D4 Framing Mode: 0 = search for Ft pattern, then search for Fs pattern 1 = cross couple Ft and Fs pattern In ESF Framing Mode: 0 = search for FPS pattern only 1 = search for FPS and verify with CRC6 Bits 4 to 5/Out-of-Frame Select Bits (OOF2, OOF1). OOF2 0 0 1 1 OOF1 0 1 0 1 OUT-OF-FRAME CRITERIA 2/4 frame bits in error 2/5 frame bits in error 2/6 frame bits in error 2/6 frame bits in error Bit 6/Auto Resync Criteria (ARC). 0 = resync on OOF or RCL event 1 = resync on OOF only Bit 7/Unused, must be set to zero for proper operation. 53 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 — 0 T1RCR2 T1 Receive Control Register 2 04h 6 RFM 0 5 RB8ZS 0 4 RSLC96 0 3 RZSE 0 2 RZBTSI 0 1 RJC 0 0 RD4YM 0 Bit 0/Receive Side D4 Yellow Alarm Select (RD4YM). 0 = zeros in bit 2 of all channels 1 = a one in the S-bit position of frame 12 (J1 Yellow Alarm Mode) Bit 1/Receive Japanese CRC6 Enable (RJC). 0 = use ANSI/AT&T/ITU CRC6 calculation (normal operation) 1 = use Japanese standard JT–G704 CRC6 calculation Bit 2/Receive Side ZBTSI Support Enable (RZBTSI). Allows ZBTSI information to be output on RLINK pin. 0 = ZBTSI disabled 1 = ZBTSI enabled Bit 3/Receive FDL Zero Destuffer Enable (RZSE). Set this bit to zero if using the internal HDLC/BOC controller instead of the legacy support for the FDL. See Legacy FDL Support (T1 Mode) for details. 0 = zero destuffer disabled 1 = zero destuffer enabled Bit 4/Receive SLC–96 Enable (RSLC96). Only set this bit to a one in SLC-96 framing applications. See D4/SLC–96 Operation for details. 0 = SLC–96 disabled 1 = SLC–96 enabled Bit 5/Receive B8ZS Enable (RB8ZS). 0 = B8ZS disabled 1 = B8ZS enabled Bit 6/Receive Frame Mode Select (RFM). 0 = D4 framing mode 1 = ESF framing mode Bit 7/Unused, must be set to zero for proper operation. 54 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 TJC 0 T1TCR1 T1 Transmit Control Register 1 05h 6 TFPT 0 5 TCPT 0 4 TSSE 0 3 GB7S 0 2 TFDLS 0 1 TBL 0 0 TYEL 0 Bit 0/Transmit Yellow Alarm (TYEL). 0 = do not transmit yellow alarm 1 = transmit yellow alarm Bit 1/Transmit Blue Alarm (TBL). 0 = transmit data normally 1 = transmit an unframed all one’s code at TPOS and TNEG Bit 2/TFDL Register Select (TFDLS). 0 = source FDL or Fs bits from the internal TFDL register (legacy FDL support mode) 1 = source FDL or Fs bits from the internal HDLC controller or the TLINK pin Bit 3/Global Bit 7 Stuffing (GB7S). 0 = allow the SSIEx registers to determine which channels containing all zeros are to be Bit 7 stuffed 1 = force Bit 7 stuffing in all zero byte channels regardless of how the SSIEx registers are programmed Bit 4/Transmit Software Signaling Enable (TSSE). 0 = do not source signaling data from the TSx registers regardless of the SSIEx registers. The SSIEx registers still define which channels are to have B7 stuffing preformed 1 = source signaling data as enabled by the SSIEx registers Bit 5/Transmit CRC Pass Through (TCPT). 0 = source CRC6 bits internally 1 = CRC6 bits sampled at TSER during F-bit time Bit 6/Transmit F-Bit Pass Through (TFPT). 0 = F bits sourced internally 1 = F bits sampled at TSER Bit 7/Transmit Japanese CRC6 Enable (TJC). 0 = use ANSI/AT&T/ITU CRC6 calculation (normal operation) 1 = use Japanese standard JT–G704 CRC6 calculation 55 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 TB8ZS 0 T1TCR2 T1 Transmit Control Register 2 06h 6 TSLC96 0 5 TZSE 0 4 FBCT2 0 3 FBCT1 0 2 TD4YM 0 1 TZBTSI 0 0 TB7ZS 0 Bit 0/Transmit Side Bit 7 Zero Suppression Enable (TB7ZS). 0 = no stuffing occurs 1 = Bit 7 force to a one in channels with all zeros Bit 1/Transmit Side ZBTSI Support Enable (TZBTSI). Allows ZBTSI information to be input on TLINK pin. 0 = ZBTSI disabled 1 = ZBTSI enabled Bit 2/Transmit Side D4 Yellow Alarm Select (TD4YM). 0 = zeros in bit 2 of all channels 1 = a one in the S-bit position of frame 12 Bit 3/F-Bit Corruption Type 1. (FBCT1). A low-to-high transition of this bit causes the next three consecutive Ft (D4 framing mode) or FPS (ESF framing mode) bits to be corrupted, causing the remote end to experience a loss of synchronization. Bit 4/F-Bit Corruption Type 2. (FBCT2). Setting this bit high enables the corruption of one Ft (D4 framing mode) or FPS (ESF framing mode) bit in every 128 Ft or FPS bits as long as the bit remains set. Bit 5/Transmit FDL Zero Stuffer Enable (TZSE). Set this bit to zero if using the internal HDLC controller instead of the legacy support for the FDL. See I/O Pin Configuration Options for details. 0 = zero stuffer disabled 1 = zero stuffer enabled Bit 6/Transmit SLC–96/Fs-Bit Insertion Enable (TSLC96). Only set this bit to a one in D4 framing and SLC-96 applications. Must be set to one to source the Fs pattern from the TFDL register. See D4/SLC–96 Operation for details. 0 = SLC–96/Fs-bit insertion disabled 1 = SLC–96/Fs-bit insertion enabled Bit 7/Transmit B8ZS Enable (TB8ZS). 0 = B8ZS disabled 1 = B8ZS enabled 56 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: T1CCR1 T1 Common Control Register 1 07h Bit # Name Default 6 — 0 7 — 0 5 — 0 4 TRAI-CI 0 3 TAIS-CI 0 2 TFM 0 1 PDE 0 0 TLOOP 0 Bit 0/Transmit Loop Code Enable (TLOOP). See Programmable In-Band Loop Codes Generation and Detection for details. 0 = transmit data normally 1 = replace normal transmitted data with repeating code as defined in registers TCD1 and TCD2 Bit 1/Pulse Density Enforcer Enable (PDE). The framer always examines both the transmit and receive data streams for violations of the following rules, which are required by ANSI T1.403: no more than 15 consecutive zeros and at least N ones in each and every time window of 8 x (N +1) bits where N = 1 through 23. Violations for the transmit and receive data streams are reported in the INFO1.6 and INFO1.7 bits respectively. When this bit is set to one, the device will force the transmitted stream to meet this requirement no matter the content of the transmitted stream. When running B8ZS, this bit should be set to zero since B8ZS encoded data streams cannot violate the pulse density requirements. 0 = disable transmit pulse density enforcer 1 = enable transmit pulse density enforcer Bit 2/Transmit Frame Mode Select (TFM). 0 = D4 framing mode 1 = ESF framing mode Bit 3/Transmit AIS-CI Enable (TAIS-CI). Setting this bit and the TBL bit (T1TCR1.1) causes the AIS-CI code to be transmitted at TPOSO and TNEGO, as defined in ANSI T1.403. 0 = do not transmit the AIS-CI code 1 = transmit the AIS-CI code (T1TCR1.1 must also be set = 1) Bit 4/Transmit RAI-CI Enable (TRAI-CI). Setting this bit causes the ESF RAI-CI code to be transmitted in the FDL bit position. 0 = do not transmit the ESF RAI-CI code 1 = transmit the ESF RAI-CI code Bit 5/Unused, must be set to zero for proper operation. Bit 6/Unused, must be set to zero for proper operation. Bit 7/Unused, must be set to zero for proper operation. 57 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 10.2 T1 Transmit Transparency The software-signaling insertion-enable registers, SSIE1–SSIE4, can be used to select signaling insertion from the transmit-signaling registers, TS1–TS12, on a per-channel basis. Setting a bit in the SSIEx register allows signaling data to be sourced from the signaling registers for that channel. In transparent mode, bit 7 stuffing and/or robbed-bit signaling is prevented from overwriting the data in the channels. If a DS0 is programmed to be clear, no robbed-bit signaling will be inserted nor will the channel have bit 7 stuffing performed. However, in the D4 framing mode, bit 2 will be overwritten by a zero when a yellow alarm is transmitted. Also, the user has the option to globally override the SSIEx registers from determining which channels are to have bit 7 stuffing performed. If the T1TCR1.3 and T1TCR2.0 bits are set to one, then all 24 T1 channels will have bit 7 stuffing performed on them, regardless of how the SSIEx registers are programmed. In this manner, the SSIEx registers are only affecting channels that are to have robbed-bit signaling inserted into them. 58 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 10.3 AIS-CI and RAI-CI Generation and Detection The DS21455/DS21458 can transmit and detect the RAI-CI and AIS-CI codes in T1 mode. These codes are compatible with and do not interfere with the standard RAI (Yellow) and AIS (Blue) alarms. These codes are defined in ANSI T1.403. The AIS-CI code (alarm indication signal-customer installation) is the same for both ESF and D4 operation. Setting the TAIS-CI bit in the T1CCR1 register and the TBL bit in the T1TCR1 register causes the DS21455/DS21458 to transmit the AIS-CI code. The RAIS-CI status bit in the SR4 register indicates the reception of an AIS-CI signal. The RAI-CI (remote alarm indication-customer installation) code for T1 ESF operation is a special form of the ESF Yellow Alarm (an unscheduled message). Setting the RAIS-CI bit in the T1CCR1 register causes the DS21455/DS21458 to transmit the RAI-CI code. The RAI-CI code causes a standard Yellow Alarm to be detected by the receiver. When the host processor detects a Yellow Alarm, it can then test the alarm for the RAI-CI state by checking the BOC detector for the RAI-CI flag. That flag is a 011111 code in the 6-bit BOC message. The RAI-CI code for T1 D4 operation is a 10001011 flag in all 24 time slots. To transmit the RAI-CI code the host sets all 24 channels to idle with a 10001011 idle code. Since this code meets the requirements for a standard T1 D4 Yellow Alarm, the host can use the receive channel monitor function to detect the 100001011 code whenever a standard Yellow Alarm is detected. 59 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 10.4 T1 Receive-Side Digital-Milliwatt Code Generation Receive-side digital-milliwatt code generation involves using the receive digital-milliwatt registers (T1RDMR1/2/3) to determine which of the 24 T1 channels of the T1 line going to the backplane should be overwritten with a digital-milliwatt pattern. The digital-milliwatt code is an 8-byte repeating pattern that represents a 1kHz sine wave (1E/0B/0B/1E/9E/8B/8B/9E). Each bit in the T1RDMRx registers represents a particular channel. If a bit is set to a one, then the receive data in that channel will be replaced with the digital-milliwatt code. If a bit is set to zero, no replacement occurs. 60 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 CH8 0 T1RDMR1 T1 Receive Digital-Milliwatt Enable Register 1 0Ch 6 CH7 0 5 CH6 0 4 CH5 0 3 CH4 0 2 CH3 0 1 CH2 0 0 CH1 0 Bits 0 to 7/Receive Digital-Milliwatt Enable for Channels 1 to 8 (CH1 to CH8). 0 = do not affect the receive data associated with this channel 1 = replace the receive data associated with this channel with digital-milliwatt code Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 CH16 0 T1RDMR2 T1 Receive Digital-Milliwatt Enable Register 2 0Dh 6 CH15 0 5 CH14 0 4 CH13 0 3 CH12 0 2 CH11 0 1 CH10 0 0 CH9 0 Bits 0 to 7/Receive Digital Milliwatt Enable for Channels 9 to 16 (CH9 to CH16). 0 = do not affect the receive data associated with this channel 1 = replace the receive data associated with this channel with digital-milliwatt code Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 CH24 0 T1RDMR3 T1 Receive Digital-Milliwatt Enable Register 3 0Eh 6 CH23 0 5 CH22 0 4 CH21 0 3 CH20 0 2 CH19 0 1 CH18 0 Bits 0 to 7/Receive Digital-Milliwatt Enable for Channels 17 to 24 (CH17 to CH24). 0 = do not affect the receive data associated with this channel 1 = replace the receive data associated with this channel with digital-milliwatt code 61 of 270 0 CH17 0 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 10.5 T1 Information Register Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 RPDV 0 INFO1 Information Register 1 10h 6 TPDV 0 5 COFA 0 4 8ZD 0 3 16ZD 0 2 SEFE 0 1 B8ZS 0 0 FBE 0 Bit 0/Frame Bit Error Event (FBE). Set when a Ft (D4) or FPS (ESF) framing bit is received in error. Bit 1/B8ZS Codeword Detect Event (B8ZS). Set when a B8ZS codeword is detected at RPOS and RNEG independent of whether the B8ZS mode is selected or not via T1TCR2.7. Useful for automatically setting the line coding. Bit 2/Severely Errored Framing Event (SEFE). Set when two out of six framing bits (Ft or FPS) are received in error. Bit 3/Sixteen Zero Detect Event (16ZD). Set when a string of at least 16 consecutive zeros (regardless of the length of the string) have been received at RPOSI and RNEGI. Bit 4/Eight Zero Detect Event (8ZD). Set when a string of at least eight consecutive zeros (regardless of the length of the string) have been received at RPOSI and RNEGI. Bit 5/Change of Frame Alignment Event (COFA). Set when the last resync resulted in a change of frame or multiframe alignment. Bit 6/Transmit Pulse Density Violation Event (TPDV). Set when the transmit data stream does not meet the ANSI T1.403 requirements for pulse density. Bit 7/Receive Pulse Density Violation Event (RPDV). Set when the receive data stream does not meet the ANSI T1.403 requirements for pulse density. 62 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Table 10-1. T1 ALARM CRITERIA ALARM Blue Alarm (AIS) (Note 1) SET CRITERIA Over a 3ms window, five or fewer zeros are received CLEAR CRITERIA Over a 3ms window, six or more zeros are received D4 Bit-2 Mode (T1RCR2.0 = 0) Bit 2 of 256 consecutive channels is set to zero for at least 254 occurrences Bit 2 of 256 consecutive channels is set to zero for less than 254 occurrences D4 12th F-bit Mode (T1RCR2.0 = 1; this mode is also referred to as the “Japanese Yellow Alarm”) 12th framing bit is set to one for two consecutive occurrences 12th framing bit is set to zero for two consecutive occurrences ESF Mode 16 consecutive patterns of 00FF appear in the FDL 192 consecutive zeros are received 14 or fewer patterns of 00FF hex out of 16 possible appear in the FDL 14 or more ones out of 112 possible bit positions are received, starting with the first one received Yellow Alarm (RAI) Red Alarm (LRCL) (Also referred to as Loss of Signal) Note 1: The definition of blue alarm (or alarm indication signal) is an unframed, all-ones signal. Blue alarm detectors should be able to operate properly in the presence of a 10E-3 error rate, and they should not falsely trigger on a framed, all-ones signal. The blue alarm criteria in the DS21455/DS21458 have been set to achieve this performance. It is recommended that the RBL bit be qualified with the RLOS bit. Note 2: ANSI specifications use a different nomenclature than this data sheet does; the following terms are equivalent: RBL = AIS RCL = LOS RLOS = LOF RYEL = RAI 63 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 11. E1 FRAMER/FORMATTER CONTROL REGISTERS The E1 framer portion of the DS21455/DS21458 is configured via a set of four control registers. Typically, the control registers are only accessed when the system is first powered up. Once the device has been initialized, the control registers will only need to be accessed when there is a change in the system configuration. There are two receive control registers (E1RCR1 and E1RCR2) and two transmit control registers (E1TCR1 and E1TCR2). There are also four status and information registers. Each of these eight registers is described in this section. 11.1 E1 Control Registers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 RSERC 0 E1RCR1 E1 Receive Control Register 1 33h 6 RSIGM 0 5 RHDB3 0 4 RG802 0 3 RCRC4 0 2 FRC 0 1 SYNCE 0 0 RESYNC 0 Bit 0/Resync (RESYNC). When toggled from low to high, a resync is initiated. Must be cleared and set again for a subsequent resync. Bit 1/Sync Enable (SYNCE). 0 = auto resync enabled 1 = auto resync disabled Bit 2/Frame Resync Criteria (FRC). 0 = resync if FAS received in error 3 consecutive times 1 = resync if FAS or bit 2 of non-FAS is received in error three consecutive times Bit 3/Receive CRC-4 Enable (RCRC4). 0 = CRC-4 disabled 1 = CRC-4 enabled Bit 4/Receive G.802 Enable (RG802). See the Signaling Operation section for details. 0 = do not force RCHBLK high during bit 1 of time slot 26 1 = force RCHBLK high during bit 1 of time slot 26 Bit 5/Receive HDB3 Enable (RHDB3). 0 = HDB3 disabled 1 = HDB3 enabled Bit 6/Receive Signaling Mode Select (RSIGM). 0 = CAS signaling mode 1 = CCS signaling mode Bit 7/RSER Control (RSERC). 0 = allow RSER to output data as received under all conditions 1 = force RSER to one under loss-of-frame alignment conditions 64 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Table 11-1. E1 SYNC/RESYNC CRITERIA FRAME OR MULTIFRAME LEVEL FAS SYNC CRITERIA RESYNC CRITERIA FAS present in frame N and N + 2, and FAS not present in frame N + 1 ITU SPEC. Three consecutive incorrect FAS received G.706 4.1.1 4.1.2 Alternate: (E1RCR1.2 = 1) The above criteria is met or three consecutive incorrect bit 2 of nonFAS received. CRC-4 CAS Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 Sa8S 0 Two valid MF alignment words found within 8ms 915 or more CRC-4 codewords out of 1000 received in error Valid MF alignment word found and previous time slot 16 contains code other than all zeros Two consecutive MF alignment words received in error G.706 4.2 and 4.3.2 G.732 5.2 E1RCR2 E1 Receive Control Register 2 34h 6 Sa7S 0 5 Sa6S 0 4 Sa5S 0 3 Sa4S 0 2 — 0 1 — 0 0 RCLA 0 Bit 0/Receive Carrier Loss (RCL) Alternate Criteria (RCLA). Defines the criteria for a Receive Carrier Loss condition for both the framer and Line Interface (LIU) 0 = RCL declared upon 255 consecutive zeros (125µs) 1 = RCL declared upon 2048 consecutive zeros (1ms) Bit 1/Unused, must be set to zero for proper operation. Bit 2/Unused, must be set to zero for proper operation. Bit 3/Sa4-Bit Select (Sa4S). Set to one to have RLCLK pulse at the Sa4-bit position; set to zero to force RLCLK low during Sa4-bit position. See the Functional Timing Diagrams section for details. Bit 4/Sa5-Bit Select (Sa5S). Set to one to have RLCLK pulse at the Sa5-bit position; set to zero to force RLCLK low during Sa5-bit position. See the Functional Timing Diagrams section for details. Bit 5/Sa6-Bit Select (Sa6S). Set to one to have RLCLK pulse at the Sa6-bit position; set to zero to force RLCLK low during Sa6-bit position. See the Functional Timing Diagrams section for details. Bit 6/Sa7-Bit Select (Sa7S). Set to one to have RLCLK pulse at the Sa7-bit position; set to zero to force RLCLK low during Sa7-bit position. See the Functional Timing Diagrams section for details. Bit 7/Sa8-Bit Select (Sa8S). Set to one to have RLCLK pulse at the Sa8-bit position; set to zero to force RLCLK low during Sa8-bit position. See the Functional Timing Diagrams section for details. 65 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 TFPT 0 E1TCR1 E1 Transmit Control Register 1 35h 6 T16S 0 5 TUA1 0 4 TSiS 0 3 TSA1 0 2 THDB3 0 1 TG802 0 0 TCRC4 0 Bit 0/Transmit CRC-4 Enable (TCRC4). 0 = CRC-4 disabled 1 = CRC-4 enabled Bit 1/Transmit G.802 Enable (TG802). See the Functional Timing Diagrams section for details. 0 = do not force TCHBLK high during bit 1 of time slot 26 1 = force TCHBLK high during bit 1 of time slot 26 Bit 2/Transmit HDB3 Enable (THDB3). 0 = HDB3 disabled 1 = HDB3 enabled Bit 3/Transmit Signaling All Ones (TSA1). 0 = normal operation 1 = force time slot 16 in every frame to all ones Bit 4/Transmit International Bit Select (TSiS). 0 = sample Si bits at TSER pin 1 = source Si bits from TAF and TNAF registers (in this mode, E1TCR1.7 must be set to zero) Bit 5/Transmit Unframed All Ones (TUA1). 0 = transmit data normally 1 = transmit an unframed all one’s code at TPOSO and TNEGO Bit 6/Transmit Time Slot 16 Data Select (T16S). See the Transmit Signaling section for details. 0 = time slot 16 determined by the SSIEx registers and the THSCS function in the PCPR register 1 = source time slot 16 from TS1 to TS16 registers Bit 7/Transmit Time Slot 0 Pass Through (TFPT). 0 = FAS bits/Sa bits/Remote Alarm sourced internally from the TAF and TNAF registers 1 = FAS bits/Sa bits/Remote Alarm sourced from TSER 66 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 Sa8S 0 E1TCR2 E1 Transmit Control Register 2 36h 6 Sa7S 0 5 Sa6S 0 4 Sa5S 0 3 Sa4S 0 2 AEBE 0 1 AAIS 0 0 ARA 0 Bit 0/Automatic Remote Alarm Generation (ARA). 0 = disabled 1 = enabled Bit 1/Automatic AIS Generation (AAIS). 0 = disabled 1 = enabled Bit 2/Automatic E-Bit Enable (AEBE). 0 = E-bits not automatically set in the transmit direction 1 = E-bits automatically set in the transmit direction Bit 3/Sa4-Bit Select (Sa4S). Set to one to source the Sa4 bit from the TLINK pin; set to zero to not source the Sa4 bit. See the Functional Timing Diagrams section for details. Bit 4/Sa5-Bit Select (Sa5S). Set to one to source the Sa5 bit from the TLINK pin; set to zero to not source the Sa5 bit. See the Functional Timing Diagrams section for details. Bit 5/Sa6-Bit Select (Sa6S). Set to one to source the Sa6 bit from the TLINK pin; set to zero to not source the Sa6 bit. See the Functional Timing Diagrams section for details. Bit 6/Sa7-Bit Select (Sa7S). Set to one to source the Sa7 bit from the TLINK pin; set to zero to not source the Sa7 bit. See the Functional Timing Diagrams section for details. Bit 7/Sa8-Bit Select (Sa8S). Set to one to source the Sa8 bit from the TLINK pin; set to zero to not source the Sa8 bit. See the Functional Timing Diagrams section for details. 67 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 11.2 Automatic Alarm Generation The device can be programmed to automatically transmit AIS or remote alarm. 11.2.1 Auto AIS When automatic AIS generation is enabled (E1TCR2.1 = 1), the device monitors the receive side framer to determine if any of the following conditions are present: loss of receive frame synchronization, AIS alarm (all ones) reception, or loss of receive carrier (or signal). If any one (or more) of the above conditions is present, then the framer will either force an AIS or remote alarm. 11.2.2 Auto RAI When automatic RAI generation is enabled (E1TCR2.0 = 1), the framer monitors the receive side to determine if any of the following conditions are present: loss of receive frame synchronization, AIS alarm (all ones) reception, or loss of receive carrier (or signal) or if CRC-4 multiframe synchronization cannot be found within 128ms of FAS synchronization (if CRC-4 is enabled). If any one (or more) of the above conditions is present, then the framer will transmit a RAI alarm. RAI generation conforms to ETS 300 011 specifications and a constant remote alarm will be transmitted if the DS21455/DS21458 cannot find CRC-4 multiframe synchronization within 400ms as per G.706. Note: It is an illegal state to have both automatic AIS generation and automatic remote alarm generation enabled at the same time. 11.2.3 Auto E-Bit When automatic E-Bit generation is enabled (E1TCR2.2 = 1), and the transmitter is in CRC-4 mode, the transmitter will automatically set the E-Bit according to the following. Table 11-2 AUTO E-BIT CONDITIONS CONDITION Receive CRC-4 disabled Receive CRC-4 enabled but not synchronized Receive CRC-4 enabled, Synchronized, with CRC Sub Multiframe codeword error Receiver synchronized in CRC-4 mode with no CRC Sub Multiframe codeword errors E-BIT STATE 0 0 0 1 11.2.4 G.706 CRC-4 Interworking G.706 Specifies a method to allow automatic interworking between equipment with and without CRC-4 capability. When basic frame alignment is established the device begins searching for the CRC-4 alignment pattern. If after 8ms the CRC-4 alignment is not found, it is assumed that frame alignment was invalid and the device returns to the basic frame alignment search to establish new frame alignment. After the new frame alignment is established the device starts a new 8ms search period for CRC-4 alignment. If CRC-4 alignment is found, the device starts CRC-4 performance monitoring and setting of the transmitted E-bits according to G.706. (See the Auto E-bit section.) If CRC-4 alignment is not achieved the device continues to return to the basic frame alignment procedure followed by an 8ms search period for CRC-4. This process continues for 400ms. At the end of this 400ms period, it is assumed that the far end equipment is non-CRC-4, the search for CRC-4 alignment is terminated and the E-bits transmitter toward the far end equipment are set continuously = 0. The DS21455/DS21458 provide a flexible method for implementing this procedure. Once the device is put into the receive CRC-4 mode, a counter begins to run. The user can access this counter via Information Register 7. 68 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 11.3 E1 Information Registers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: INFO3 Information Register 3 12h Bit # Name Default 6 — 0 7 — 0 5 — 0 4 — 0 3 — 0 2 CRCRC 0 1 FASRC 0 0 CASRC 0 Bit 0/CAS Resync Criteria Met Event (CASRC). Set when two consecutive CAS MF alignment words are received in error. (Note: During a CRC resync the FAS synchronizer is brought online to verify the FAS alignment. If during this process a FAS emulator exists, the FAS synchronizer may temporarily align to the emulator. The FASRC will go active indicating a search for a valid FAS has been activated.) Bit 1/FAS Resync Criteria Met Event (FASRC. Set when three consecutive FAS words are received in error. Bit 2/CRC Resync Criteria Met Event (CRCRC). Set when 915/1000 codewords are received in error. Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 CSC5 0 INFO7 Information Register 7 (Real Time) 30h 6 CSC4 0 5 CSC3 0 4 CSC2 0 3 CSC0 0 2 FASSA 0 1 CASSA 0 0 CRC4SA 0 Bit 0/CRC-4 MF Sync Active (CRC4SA). Set while the synchronizer is searching for the CRC-4 MF alignment word. Bit 1/CAS MF Sync Active (CASSA). Set while the synchronizer is searching for the CAS MF alignment word. Bit 2/FAS Sync Active (FASSA). Set while the synchronizer is searching for alignment at the FAS level. Bit 3 to 7/CRC-4 Sync Counter Bits (CSC0 and CSC2 to CSC4). The CRC-4 sync counter increments each time the 8msCRC-4 multiframe search times out. The counter is cleared when the framer has successfully obtained synchronization at the CRC-4 level. The counter can also be cleared by disabling the CRC-4 mode (E1RCR1.3 = 0). This counter is useful for determining the amount of time the framer has been searching for synchronization at the CRC-4 level. ITU G.706 suggests that if synchronization at the CRC-4 level cannot be obtained within 400ms, then the search should be abandoned and proper action taken. The CRC-4 sync counter will rollover. CSC0 is the LSB of the 6-bit counter. (Note: The second LSB, CSC1, is not accessible. CSC1 is omitted to allow resolution to >400ms using 5 bits.) 69 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Table 11-3. E1 ALARM CRITERIA ALARM RLOS RCL RRA SET CRITERIA An RLOS condition exists on power-up prior to initial synchronization, when a resync criteria has been met, or when a manual resync has been initiated via E1RCR1.0 255 or 2048 consecutive zeros received as determined by E1RCR2.0 Bit 3 of non-align frame set to one for three consecutive occasions RUA1 Fewer than three zeros in two frames (512 bits) RDMA Bit 6 of time slot 16 in frame 0 has been set for two consecutive multiframes V52LNK CLEAR CRITERIA ITU SPEC. In 255-bit times, at least 32 ones are received G.775/G.962 Bit 3 of nonalign frame set to zero for three consecutive occasions O.162 2.1.4 More than two zeros in two frames (512 bits) O.162 1.6.1.2 Two out of three Sa7 bits are zero G.965 70 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 12. COMMON CONTROL AND STATUS REGISTERS Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 — 0 CCR1 Common Control Register 1 70h 6 CRC4R 0 5 SIE 0 4 ODM 0 3 — 0 2 TCSS1 0 1 TCSS0 0 0 RLOSF 0 Bit 0/Function of the RLOS/LOTC Output (RLOSF). 0 = Receive Loss of Sync (RLOS) 1 = Loss of Transmit Clock (LOTC) Bit 1/Transmit Clock Source Select Bit 0 (TCSS0). Bit 2/Transmit Clock Source Select Bit 1 (TCSS1). TCSS1 TCSS0 TRANSMIT CLOCK SOURCE 0 0 The TCLK pin is always the source of transmit clock. 0 1 Switch to the clock present at RCLK when the signal at the TCLK pin fails to transition after one channel time. 1 0 Use the scaled signal present at MCLK as the transmit clock. The TCLK pin is ignored. 1 1 Use the signal present at RCLK as the transmit clock. The TCLK pin is ignored. Bit 3/Unused, must be set to zero for proper operation. Bit 4/Output Data Mode (ODM). 0 = pulses at TPOSO and TNEGO are one full TCLKO period wide 1 = pulses at TPOSO and TNEGO are 1/2 TCLKO period wide Bit 5/Signaling Integration Enable (SIE). 0 = signaling changes of state reported on any change in selected channels 1 = signaling must be stable for three multiframes for a change of state to be reported Bit 6/CRC-4 Recalculate (CRC4R) (E1 Only). 0 = transmit CRC-4 generation and insertion operates in normal mode 1 = transmit CRC-4 generation operates according to G.706 Intermediate Path Recalculation method Bit 7/ Unused, must be set to zero for proper operation. 71 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 ID7 1 IDR Device Identification Register 0Fh 6 ID6 0 5 ID5 1 4 ID4 1 3 ID3 X 2 ID2 X 1 ID1 X 0 ID0 X Bits 0 to 3/Chip Revision Bits (ID0 to ID3). The lower four bits of the IDR are used to display the die revision of the chip. IDO is the LSB of a decimal code that represents the chip revision. Bits 4 to 7/Device ID (ID4 to ID7). The upper four bits of the IDR are used to display the device ID. Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 RYELC 0 SR2 Status Register 2 18h 6 RUA1C 0 5 FRCLC 0 4 RLOSC 0 3 RYEL 0 2 RUA1 0 1 FRCL 0 0 RLOS 0 Bit 0/Receive Loss of Sync Condition (RLOS). Set when the device is not synchronized to the received data stream. Bit 1/Framer Receive Carrier Loss Condition (FRCL). Set when 255 (or 2048 if E1RCR2.0 = 1) E1 mode or 192 T1 mode consecutive zeros have been detected at RPOSI and RNEGI. Bit 2/Receive Unframed All Ones (T1, Blue Alarm, E1, AIS) Condition (RUA1). Set when an unframed all ones code is received at RPOSI and RNEGI. Bit 3/Receive Yellow Alarm Condition (RYEL) (T1 Only). Set when a yellow alarm is received at RPOSI and RNEGI. Bit 4/Receive Loss of Sync Clear Event (RLOSC). Set when the framer achieves synchronization; will remain set until read. Bit 5/Framer Receive Carrier Loss Clear Event (FRCLC). Set when carrier loss condition at RPOSI and RNEGI is no longer detected. Bit 6/Receive Unframed All Ones Clear Event (RUA1C). Set when the unframed all ones condition is no longer detected. Bit 7/Receive Yellow Alarm Clear Event (RYELC) (T1 Only). Set when the yellow alarm condition is no longer detected. 72 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 RYELC 0 IMR2 Interrupt Mask Register 2 19h 6 RUA1C 0 5 FRCLC 0 4 RLOSC 0 3 RYEL 0 Bit 0/Receive Loss of Sync Condition (RLOS). 0 = interrupt masked 1 = interrupt enabled–interrupts on rising edge only Bit 1/Framer Receive Carrier Loss Condition (FRCL). 0 = interrupt masked 1 = interrupt enabled–interrupts on rising edge only Bit 2/Receive Unframed All Ones (Blue Alarm) Condition (RUA1). 0 = interrupt masked 1 = interrupt enabled–interrupts on rising edge only Bit 3/Receive Yellow Alarm Condition (RYEL). 0 = interrupt masked 1 = interrupt enabled–interrupts on rising edge only Bit 4/Receive Loss of Sync Clear Event (RLOSC). 0 = interrupt masked 1 = interrupt enabled Bit 5/Framer Receive Carrier Loss Condition Clear (FRCLC). 0 = interrupt masked 1 = interrupt enabled Bit 6/Receive Unframed All Ones Condition Clear Event (RUA1C). 0 = interrupt masked 1 = interrupt enabled Bit 7/Receive Yellow Alarm Clear Event (RYELC). 0 = interrupt masked 1 = interrupt enabled 73 of 270 2 RUA1 0 1 FRCL 0 0 RLOS 0 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 LSPARE 0 SR3 Status Register 3 1Ah 6 LDN 0 5 LUP 0 4 LOTC 0 3 LORC 0 2 V52LNK 0 1 RDMA 0 0 RRA 0 Bit 0/Receive Remote Alarm Condition (RRA) (E1 Only). Set when a remote alarm is received at RPOSI and RNEGI Bit 1/Receive Distant MF Alarm Condition (RDMA) (E1 Only). Set when bit 6 of time slot 16 in frame 0 has been set for two consecutive multiframes. This alarm is not disabled in the CCS signaling mode. Bit 2/V5.2 Link Detected Condition (V52LNK) (E1 Only). Set on detection of a V5.2 link identification signal. (G.965). Bit 3/Loss of Receive Clock Condition (LORC). Set when the RCLKI pin has not transitioned for one channel time. Bit 4/Loss of Transmit Clock Condition (LOTC). Set when the TCLK pin has not transitioned for one channel time. Will force the LOTC pin high if enabled via CCR1.0. Bit 5/Loop-Up Code Detected Condition (LUP) (T1 Only). Set when the loop up code as defined in the RUPCD1/2 register is being received. See the Programmable In-Band Loop Code Generation and Detection section for details. Bit 6/Loop-Down Code Detected Condition (LDN). (T1 only) Set when the loop down code as defined in the RDNCD1/2 register is being received. See the Programmable In-Band Loop Code Generation and Detection section for details. Bit 7/Spare Code Detected Condition (LSPARE). (T1 only) Set when the spare code as defined in the RSCD1/2 registers is being received. See the Programmable In-Band Loop Code Generation and Detection section for details. 74 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 LSPARE 0 IMR3 Interrupt Mask Register 3 1Bh 6 LDN 0 5 LUP 0 4 LOTC 0 3 LORC 0 Bit 0/Receive Remote Alarm Condition (RRA). 0 = interrupt masked 1 = interrupt enabled—interrupts on rising and falling edges Bit 1/Receive Distant MF Alarm Condition (RDMA). 0 = interrupt masked 1 = interrupt enabled—interrupts on rising and falling edges Bit 2/V5.2 Link Detected Condition (V52LNK). 0 = interrupt masked 1 = interrupt enabled—interrupts on rising and falling edges Bit 3/Loss of Receive Clock Condition (LORC). 0 = interrupt masked 1 = interrupt enabled—interrupts on rising and falling edges Bit 4/Loss of Transmit Clock Condition (LOTC). 0 = interrupt masked 1 = interrupt enabled—interrupts on rising and falling edges Bit 5/Loop-Up Code Detected Condition (LUP). 0 = interrupt masked 1 = interrupt enabled—interrupts on rising and falling edges Bit 6/Loop-Down Code Detected Condition (LDN). 0 = interrupt masked 1 = interrupt enabled–interrupts on rising and falling edges Bit 7/Spare Code Detected Condition (LSPARE). 0 = interrupt masked 1 = interrupt enabled–interrupts on rising and falling edges 75 of 270 2 V52LNK 0 1 RDMA 0 0 RRA 0 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 RAIS-CI 0 SR4 Status Register 4 1Ch 6 RSA1 0 5 RSA0 0 4 TMF 0 3 TAF 0 2 RMF 0 1 RCMF 0 0 RAF 0 Bit 0/Receive Align Frame Event (RAF) (E1 Only). Set every 250ms at the beginning of align frames. Used to alert the host that Si and Sa bits are available in the RAF and RNAF registers. Bit 1/Receive CRC-4 Multiframe Event (RCMF) (E1 Only). Set on CRC-4 multiframe boundaries; will continue to be set every 2ms on an arbitrary boundary if CRC-4 is disabled. Bit 2/Receive Multiframe Event (RMF). E1 Mode: Set every 2ms (regardless if CAS signaling is enabled or not) on receive multiframe boundaries. Used to alert the host that signaling data is available. T1 Mode: Set every 1.5ms on D4 MF boundaries or every 3ms on ESF MF boundaries. Bit 3/Transmit Align Frame Event (TAF) (E1 Only). Set every 250ms at the beginning of align frames. Used to alert the host that the TAF and TNAF registers need to be updated. Bit 4/Transmit Multiframe Event (TMF). E1 Mode: Set every 2ms (regardless if CRC-4 is enabled) on transmit multiframe boundaries. Used to alert the host that signaling data needs to be updated. T1 Mode: Set every 1.5ms on D4 MF boundaries or every 3ms on ESF MF boundaries. Bit 5/Receive Signaling All Zeros Event (RSA0) (E1 Only). Set when over a full MF time slot 16 contains all zeros. Bit 6/Receive Signaling All Ones Event (RSA1) (E1 Only). Set when the contents of time slot 16 contains fewer than three zeros over 16 consecutive frames. This alarm is not disabled in the CCS signaling mode. Bit 7/Receive AIS-CI Event (RAIS-CI) (T1 Only). Set when the receiver detects the AIS-CI pattern as defined in ANSI T1.403. 76 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 RAIS-CI 0 IMR4 Interrupt Mask Register 4 1Dh 6 RSA1 0 5 RSA0 0 4 TMF 0 3 TAF 0 Bit 0/Receive Align Frame Event (RAF). 0 = interrupt masked 1 = interrupt enabled Bit 1/Receive CRC-4 Multiframe Event (RCMF). 0 = interrupt masked 1 = interrupt enabled Bit 2/Receive Multiframe Event (RMF). 0 = interrupt masked 1 = interrupt enabled Bit 3/Transmit Align Frame Event (TAF). 0 = interrupt masked 1 = interrupt enabled Bit 4/Transmit Multiframe Event (TMF). 0 = interrupt masked 1 = interrupt enabled Bit 5/Receive Signaling All-Zeros Event (RSA0). 0 = interrupt masked 1 = interrupt enabled Bit 6/Receive Signaling All-Ones Event (RSA1). 0 = interrupt masked 1 = interrupt enabled Bit 7/Receive AIS-CI Event (RAIS-CI) 0 = interrupt masked 1 = interrupt enabled 77 of 270 2 RMF 0 1 RCMF 0 0 RAF 0 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 13. I/O PIN CONFIGURATION OPTIONS Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 RSMS 0 IOCR1 I/O Configuration Register 1 01h 6 RSMS2 0 5 RSMS1 0 4 RSIO 0 3 TSDW 0 2 TSM 0 1 TSIO 0 0 ODF 0 Bit 0/Output Data Format (ODF). 0 = bipolar data at TPOSO and TNEGO 1 = NRZ data at TPOSO; TNEGO = 0 Bit 1/TSYNC I/O Select (TSIO). 0 = TSYNC is an input 1 = TSYNC is an output Bit 2/TSYNC Mode Select (TSM). Selects frame or multiframe mode for the TSYNC pin. 0 = frame mode 1 = multiframe mode Bit 3/TSYNC Double-Wide (TSDW) (T1 Only). (Note: This bit must be set to zero when IOCR1.2 = 1 or when IOCR1.1 = 0.) 0 = do not pulse double-wide in signaling frames 1 = do pulse double-wide in signaling frames Bit 4/RSYNC I/O Select (RSIO). (Note: this bit must be set to zero when ESCR.0 = 0.) 0 = RSYNC is an output 1 = RSYNC is an input (only valid if elastic store enabled) Bit 5/RSYNC Mode Select 1 (RSMS1). Selects frame or multiframe pulse when RSYNC pin is in output mode. In input mode (elastic store must be enabled) multiframe mode is only useful when receive signaling re-insertion is enabled. 0 = frame mode 1 = multiframe mode Bit 6/RSYNC Mode Select 2 (RSMS2). T1 Mode: RSYNC pin must be programmed in the output frame mode (IOCR1.5 = 0, IOCR1.4 = 0). 0 = do not pulse double-wide in signaling frames 1 = do pulse double-wide in signaling frames E1 Mode: RSYNC pin must be programmed in the output multiframe mode (IOCR1.5 = 1, IOCR1.4 = 0). 0 = RSYNC outputs CAS multiframe boundaries 1 = RSYNC outputs CRC-4 multiframe boundaries Bit 7/RSYNC Multiframe Skip Control (RSMS). Useful in framing format conversions from D4 to ESF. This function is not available when the receive-side elastic store is enabled. RSYNC must be set to output multiframe pulses (IOCR1.5 = 1 and IOCR1.4 = 0). 0 = RSYNC will output a pulse at every multiframe 1 = RSYNC will output a pulse at every other multiframe 78 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: IOCR2 I/O Configuration Register 2 02h Bit # Name Default 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RCLKINV TCLKINV RSYNCINV TSYNCINV TSSYNCINV H100EN TSCLKM RSCLKM 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bit 0/RSYSCLK Mode Select (RSCLKM). 0 = if RSYSCLK is 1.544MHz 1 = if RSYSCLK is 2.048MHz or IBO enabled (See the Interleaved PCM Bus Operation section.) Bit 1/TSYSCLK Mode Select (TSCLKM). 0 = if TSYSCLK is 1.544MHz 1 = if TSYSCLK is 2.048/4.096/8.192MHz or IBO enabled (See the Interleaved PCM Bus Operation section.) Bit 2/H.100 SYNC Mode (H100EN). 0 = normal operation 1 = SYNC shift Bit 3/TSSYNC Invert (TSSYNCINV). 0 = no inversion 1 = invert Bit 4/TSYNC Invert (TSYNCINV). 0 = no inversion 1 = invert Bit 5/RSYNC Invert (RSYNCINV). 0 = no inversion 1 = invert Bit 6/TCLK Invert (TCLKINV). 0 = no inversion 1 = invert Bit 7/RCLK Invert (RCLKINV). 0 = no inversion 1 = invert 79 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 14. LOOPBACK CONFIGURATIONS The DS21455/DS21458 have four loopback configurations including Framer, Payload, Local, and Remote loopback. Figure 14-1 depicts a normal signal flow without any loopbacks enabled. Payload loopback may be done on a per-channel basis if both the transmit and receive paths are synchronous (RCLK = TCLK and RSYNC = TSYNC). See Section 14.1. Figure 14-1. Normal Signal Flow Diagram RECEIVE LIU JITTER ATTENUATOR RECEIVE FRAMER BACKPLANE I/F TRANSMIT LIU JITTER ATTENUATOR TRANSMIT FRAMER BACKPLANE I/F NORMAL MODE Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: LBCR Loopback Control Register 4Ah Bit # Name Default 6 — 0 7 LTS 0 5 — 0 4 LIUC 0 3 LLB 0 2 RLB 0 1 PLB 0 0 FLB 0 Bit 0/Framer Loopback (FLB). 0 = loopback disabled 1 = loopback enabled RECEIVE LIU JITTER ATTENUATOR RECEIVE FRAMER BACKPLANE I/F TRANSMIT LIU JITTER ATTENUATOR TRANSMIT FRAMER BACKPLANE I/F FRAMER LOOPBACK 80 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers This loopback is useful in testing and debugging applications. In FLB, the device will loop data from the transmit side back to the receive side. When FLB is enabled, the following will occur: 1) T1 Mode: An unframed all ones code will be transmitted at TPOSO and TNEGO. E1 Mode: Normal data will be transmitted at TPOSO and TNEGO. 2) Data at RPOSI and RNEGI will be ignored. 3) All receive-side signals will take on timing synchronous with TCLK instead of RCLKI. 4) Please note that it is not acceptable to have RCLK tied to TCLK during this loopback because this will cause an unstable condition. Bit 1/Payload Loopback (PLB). 0 = loopback disabled 1 = loopback enabled RECEIVE LIU JITTER ATTENUATOR RECEIVE FRAMER BACKPLANE I/F TRANSMIT LIU JITTER ATTENUATOR TRANSMIT FRAMER BACKPLANE I/F PAYLOAD LOOPBACK (CAN BE DONE ON A PER-CHANNEL BASIS) When PLB is enabled, the following will occur: 1) 2) 3) 4) 5) Data will be transmitted from the TPOSO and TNEGO pins synchronous with RCLK instead of TCLK. All of the receive side signals will continue to operate normally. The TCHCLK and TCHBLK signals are forced low. Data at the TSER, TDATA, and TSIG pins is ignored. The TLCLK signal will become synchronous with RCLK instead of TCLK. T1 Mode: Normally, this loopback is only enabled when ESF framing is being performed but can be enabled also in D4 framing applications. In a PLB situation, the device will loop the 192 bits of payload data (with BPVs corrected) from the receive section back to the transmit section. The FPS framing pattern, CRC6 calculation, and the FDL bits are not looped back, they are reinserted by the device. E1 Mode: In a PLB situation, the device will loop the 248 bits of payload data (with BPVs corrected) from the receive section back to the transmit section. The transmit section will modify the payload as if it was input at TSER. The FAS word, Si, Sa and E bits, and CRC-4 are not looped back, they are reinserted by the device. Bit 2/Remote Loopback (RLB). In this loopback, data input via the RPOSI and RNEGI pins will be transmitted back to the TPOSO and TNEGO pins. Data will continue to pass through the receive side framer of the device as it would normally and the data from the transmit side formatter will be ignored. 0 = loopback disabled 1 = loopback enabled RECEIVE LIU JITTER ATTENUATOR RECEIVE FRAMER BACKPLANE I/F TRANSMIT LIU JITTER ATTENUATOR TRANSMIT FRAMER BACKPLANE I/F REMOTE LOOPBACK 81 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Bit 3/Local Loopback (LLB). In this loopback, data will continue to be transmitted as normal through the transmit side of the transceiver. Data being received at RTIP and RRING will be replaced with the data being transmitted. Data in this loopback will pass through the jitter attenuator. 0 = loopback disabled 1 = loopback enabled RECEIVE LIU JITTER ATTENUATOR RECEIVE FRAMER BACKPLANE I/F TRANSMIT LIU JITTER ATTENUATOR TRANSMIT FRAMER BACKPLANE I/F LOCAL LOOPBACK Bit 4/Line Interface Unit Mux Control (LIUC). This bit along with the LIUC/TPD pin and LBCR.7 controls the connection between the LIU and the Framer. See the LTS (LBCR.7) description below. When the LIUC/TPD pin is connected high or LBCR.7 = 1, the LIUC bit has control. When the LIUC/TPD pin is connected low the framer and LIU are separated and the LIUC bit has no effect. For the DS21458 this bit should always be set = 0. Table 14-1. LIUC CONTROL LBCR.7 (LTS) LIUC/TPD PIN LBCR.4 (LIUC) 0 0 0 0 0 1 0 1 0 0 1 1 1 x 0 1 x 1 FUNCTION LIU and Framer Separated TPOSI/TNEGI/TCLKI/RPOSI/RNEGI/RCLKI pins active (This function not available on the DS21458) LIU and Framer Separated TPOSI/TNEGI/TCLKI/RPOSI/RNEGI/RCLKI pins active (This function not available on the DS21458) LIU and Framer Connected TPOSI/TNEGI/TCLKI/RPOSI/RNEGI/RCLKI pins ignored (This function not available on the DS21458) LIU and Framer Separated TPOSI/TNEGI/TCLKI/RPOSI/RNEGI/RCLKI pins active (This function not available on the DS21458) LIU and Framer Connected TPOSI/TNEGI/TCLKI/RPOSI/RNEGI/RCLKI pins ignored LIU and Framer Separated TPOSI/TNEGI/TCLKI/RPOSI/RNEGI/RCLKI pins active (This function not available on the DS21458) Bit 5/Unused, must be set to zero for proper operation. Bit 6/Unused, must be set to zero for proper operation. Bit 7/LIUC/TPD Pin Function Select (LTS). This bit selects the function the of the LIUC/TPD pin. On the DS21458, this bit should always be set = 1. 0 = LIUC/TPD pin functions as the LIUC control (This function is not available on the DS21458) 1 = LIUC/TPD pin functions as the TPD control 82 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 14.1 Per-Channel Payload Loopback The per-channel loopback registers (PCLRs) determine which channels (if any) from the backplane should be replaced with the data from the receive side or in other words, off of the T1 or E1 line. If this loopback is enabled, then transmit and receive clocks and frame syncs must be synchronized. One method to accomplish this would be to tie RCLK to TCLK and RFSYNC to TSYNC. There are no restrictions on which channels can be looped back or on how many channels can be looped back. Each of the bit position in the PCLRs (PCLR1/PCLR2/PCLR3/PCLR4) represent a DS0 channel in the outgoing frame. When these bits are set to a one, data from the corresponding receive channel will replace the data from the TSER pin for that channel. Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 CH8 0 PCLR1 Per-Channel Loopback Enable Register 1 4Bh 6 CH7 0 5 CH6 0 4 CH5 0 3 CH4 0 2 CH3 0 1 CH2 0 0 CH1 0 1 CH10 0 0 CH9 0 Bits 0 to 7/Per-Channel Loopback Enable for Channels 1 to 8 (CH1 to CH8). 0 = loopback disabled 1 = enable loopback. Source data from the corresponding receive channel Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 CH16 0 PCLR2 Per-Channel Loopback Enable Register 2 4Ch 6 CH15 0 5 CH14 0 4 CH13 0 3 CH12 0 2 CH11 0 Bits 0 to 7/Per-Channel Loopback Enable for Channels 9 to 16 (CH9 to CH16). 0 = loopback disabled 1 = enable loopback. Source data from the corresponding receive channel 83 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 CH24 0 PCLR3 Per-Channel Loopback Enable Register 3 4Dh 6 CH23 0 5 CH22 0 4 CH21 0 3 CH20 0 2 CH19 0 1 CH18 0 0 CH17 0 1 CH26 0 0 CH25 0 Bits 0 to 7/Per-Channel Loopback Enable for Channels 17 to 24 (CH17 to CH24). 0 = loopback disabled 1 = enable loopback. Source data from the corresponding receive channel Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 CH32 0 PCLR4 Per-Channel Loopback Enable Register 4 4Eh 6 CH31 0 5 CH30 0 4 CH29 0 3 CH28 0 2 CH27 0 Bits 0 to 7/Per-Channel Loopback Enable for Channels 25 to 32 (CH25 to CH32). 0 = loopback disabled 1 = enable loopback. Source data from the corresponding receive channel 84 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 15. ERROR COUNT REGISTERS The DS21455/DS21458 contain four counters that are used to accumulate line coding errors, path errors, and synchronization errors. Counter update options include one second boundaries, 42ms (T1 mode only), 62ms (E1 mode only) or manually. See Error Counter Configuration Register (ERCNT). When updated automatically, the user can use the interrupt from the timer to determine when to read these registers. All four counters will saturate at their respective maximum counts and they will not rollover (Note: Only the line-code violation count register has the potential to overflow but the bit error would have to exceed 10E-2 before this would occur). Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 — 0 ERCNT Error Counter Configuration Register 41h 6 MECU 0 5 ECUS 0 4 EAMS 0 3 VCRFS 0 2 FSBE 0 1 MOSCRF 0 0 LCVCRF 0 Bit 0/T1 Line Code Violation Count Register Function Select (LCVCRF). 0 = do not count excessive zeros 1 = count excessive zeros Bit 1/Multiframe Out-of-Sync Count Register Function Select (MOSCRF). 0 = count errors in the framing bit position 1 = count the number of multiframes out of sync Bit 2/PCVCR Fs-Bit Error Report Enable (FSBE). 0 = do not report bit errors in Fs-bit position; only Ft-bit position 1 = report bit errors in Fs-bit position as well as Ft-bit position Bit 3/E1 Line Code Violation Count Register Function Select (VCRFS). 0 = count Bipolar Violations (BPVs) 1 = count Code Violations (CVs) Bit 4/Error Accumulation Mode Select (EAMS). 0 = ERCNT.5 determines accumulation time 1 = ERCNT.6 determines accumulation time Bit 5/Error Counter Update Select (ECUS). T1 Mode: 0 = Update error counters once a second 1 = Update error counters every 42ms (333 frames) E1 Mode: 0 = Update error counters once a second 1 = Update error counters every 62.5ms (500 frames) Bit 6/Manual Error Counter Update (MECU). When enabled by ERCNT.4, the changing of this bit from a zero to a one allows the next clock cycle to load the error counter registers with the latest counts and reset the counters. The user must wait a minimum of 1.5 RCLK clock periods before reading the error count registers to allow for proper update. Bit 7/Unused, must be set to zero for proper operation. 85 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 15.1 Line Code Violation Count Register (LCVCR) 15.1.1 T1 Operation T1 code violations are defined as bipolar violations (BPVs) or excessive zeros. If the B8ZS mode is set for the receive side, then B8ZS codewords are not counted. This counter is always enabled; it is not disabled during receive loss of synchronization (RLOS = 1) conditions. Table 15-1. T1 LINE CODE VIOLATION COUNTING OPTIONS COUNT EXCESSIVE ZEROS? (ERCNT.0) No Yes No Yes B8ZS ENABLED? (T1RCR2.5) No No Yes Yes WHAT IS COUNTED IN THE LCVCRs BPVs BPVs + 16 Consecutive Zeros BPVs (B8ZS Codewords Not Counted) BPVs + 8 Consecutive Zeros 15.1.2 E1 Operation Either bipolar violations or code violations can be counted. Bipolar violations are defined as consecutive marks of the same polarity. In this mode, if the HDB3 mode is set for the receive side, then HDB3 codewords are not counted as BPVs. If ERCNT.3 is set, then the LVC counts code violations as defined in ITU O.161. Code violations are defined as consecutive bipolar violations of the same polarity. In most applications, the framer should be programmed to count BPVs when receiving AMI code and to count CVs when receiving HDB3 code. This counter increments at all times and is not disabled by loss of sync conditions. The counter saturates at 65,535 and will not rollover. The bit error rate on an E1 line would have to be greater than 10** -2 before the VCR would saturate. Table 15-2. E1 LINE CODE VIOLATION COUNTING OPTIONS E1 CODE VIOLATION SELECT (ERCNT.3) 0 1 WHAT IS COUNTED IN THE LCVCRs BPVs CVs 86 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 LCVC15 0 LCVCR1 Line Code Violation Count Register 1 42h 6 LCVC14 0 5 LCVC13 0 4 LCVC12 0 3 LCVC11 0 2 LCVC10 0 1 LCVC9 0 0 LCCV8 0 Bits 0 to 7/Line Code Violation Counter Bits 8 to 15 (LCVC8 to LCVC15). LCV15 is the MSB of the 16-bit code violation count. Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 LCVC7 0 LCVCR2 Line Code Violation Count Register 2 43h 6 LCVC6 0 5 LCVC5 0 4 LCVC4 0 3 LCVC3 0 2 LCVC2 0 1 LCVC1 0 0 LCVC0 0 Bits 0 to 7/Line Code Violation Counter Bits 0 to 7 (LCVC0 to LCVC7). LCV0 is the LSB of the 16-bit code violation count. 87 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 15.2 Path Code Violation Count Register (PCVCR) 15.2.1 T1 Operation The path code violation count register records either Ft, Fs, or CRC6 errors in T1 frames. When the receive side of a framer is set to operate in the T1 ESF framing mode, PCVCR will record errors in the CRC6 codewords. When set to operate in the T1 D4 framing mode, PCVCR will count errors in the Ft framing bit position. Via the ERCNT.2 bit, a framer can be programmed to also report errors in the Fs framing bit position. The PCVCR will be disabled during receive loss of synchronization (RLOS = 1) conditions. See Table 15-3 for a detailed description of exactly what errors the PCVCR counts. Table 15-3. T1 PATH CODE VIOLATION COUNTING ARRANGEMENTS FRAMING MODE D4 D4 ESF COUNT Fs ERRORS? No Yes Don’t Care WHAT IS COUNTED IN THE PCVCRs Errors in the Ft Pattern Errors in Both the Ft and Fs Patterns Errors in the CRC6 Codewords 15.2.2 E1 Operation The PCVCR records CRC-4 errors. Since the maximum CRC-4 count in a one-second period is 1000, this counter cannot saturate. The counter is disabled during loss of sync at either the FAS or CRC-4 level; it will continue to count if loss of multiframe sync occurs at the CAS level. The PCVCR1 is the most significant word and PCVCR2 is the least significant word of a 16-bit counter that records path violations (PVs). Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 PCVC15 0 PCVCR1 Path Code Violation Count Register 1 44h 6 PCVC14 0 5 PCVC13 0 4 PCVC12 0 3 PCVC11 0 2 PCVC10 0 1 PCVC9 0 0 PCVC8 0 Bits 0 to 7/Path Code Violation Counter Bits 8 to 15 (PCVC8 to PCVC15). PCVC15 is the MSB of the 16-bit path code violation count. Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 PCVC7 0 PCVCR2 Path Code Violation Count Register 2 45h 6 PCVC6 0 5 PCVC5 0 4 PCVC4 0 3 PCVC3 0 2 PCVC2 0 1 PCVC1 0 0 PCVC0 0 Bits 0 to 7/Path Code Violation Counter Bits 0 to 7 (PCVC0 to PCVC7). PCVC0 is the LSB of the 16-bit path code violation count. 88 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 15.3 Frames Out Of Sync Count Register (FOSCR) 15.3.1 T1 Operation The FOSCR is used to count the number of multiframes that the receive synchronizer is out of sync. This number is useful in ESF applications needing to measure the parameters loss of frame count (LOFC) and ESF error events as described in AT&T publication TR54016. When the FOSCR is operated in this mode, it is not disabled during receive loss of synchronization (RLOS = 1) conditions. The FOSCR has alternate operating mode whereby it will count either errors in the Ft framing pattern (in the D4 mode) or errors in the FPS framing pattern (in the ESF mode). When the FOSCR is operated in this mode, it is disabled during receive loss of synchronization (RLOS = 1) conditions. See Table 15-4 for a detailed description of what the FOSCR is capable of counting. Table 15-4. T1 FRAMES OUT OF SYNC COUNTING ARRANGEMENTS FRAMING MODE (T1RCR1.3) D4 D4 ESF ESF COUNT MOS OR F-BIT ERRORS (ERCNT.1) MOS F-Bit MOS F-Bit WHAT IS COUNTED IN THE FOSCRs Number of Multiframes Out of Sync Errors in the Ft Pattern Number of Multiframes Out of Sync Errors in the FPS Pattern 15.3.2 E1 Operation The FOSCR counts word errors in the frame alignment signal in time slot 0. This counter is disabled when RLOS is high. FAS errors will not be counted when the framer is searching for FAS alignment and/or synchronization at either the CAS or CRC-4 multiframe level. Since the maximum FAS word error count in a one-second period is 4000, this counter cannot saturate. The FOSCR1 (FOSCR1) is the most significant word and FOSCR2 is the least significant word of a 16bit counter that records frames out of sync. 89 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 FOS15 0 FOSCR1 Frames Out Of Sync Count Register 1 46h 6 FOS14 0 5 FOS13 0 4 FOS12 0 3 FOS11 0 2 FOS10 0 1 FOS9 0 0 FOS8 0 Bits 0 to 7/Frames Out of Sync Counter Bits 8 to 15 (FOS8 to FOS15). FOS15 is the MSB of the 16-bit frames out of sync count. Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 FOS7 0 FOSCR2 Frames Out Of Sync Count Register 2 47h 6 FOS6 0 5 FOS5 0 4 FOS4 0 3 FOS3 0 2 FOS2 0 1 FOS1 0 0 FOS0 0 Bits 0 to 7/Frames Out of Sync Counter Bits 0 to 7 (FOS0 to FOS7). FOS0 is the LSB of the 16-bit frames out of sync count. 15.4 E-Bit Counter Register (EBCR) This counter is only available in the E1 mode. EBCR1 (EBCR1) is the most significant word and EBCR2 is the least significant word of a 16-bit counter that records far end block errors (FEBE), as reported in the first bit of frames 13 and 15 on E1 lines running with CRC-4 multiframe. These count registers will increment once each time the received E-bit is set to zero. Since the maximum E-bit count in a onesecond period is 1000, this counter cannot saturate. The counter is disabled during loss of sync at either the FAS or CRC-4 level; it will continue to count if loss of multiframe sync occurs at the CAS level. Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 EB15 0 EBCR1 E-Bit Count Register 1 48h 6 EB14 0 5 EB13 0 4 EB12 0 3 EB11 0 2 EB10 0 1 EB9 0 0 EB8 0 Bits 0 to 7/E-Bit Counter Bits 8 to 15 (EB8 to EB15). EB15 is the MSB of the 16-bit E-bit count. Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 EB7 0 EBCR2 E-Bit Count Register 2 49h 6 EB6 0 5 EB5 0 4 EB4 0 3 EB3 0 2 EB2 0 1 EB1 0 Bits 0 to 7/E-Bit Counter Bits 0 to 7 (EB0 to EB7). EB0 is the LSB of the 16-bit E-bit count. 90 of 270 0 EB0 0 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 16. DS0 MONITORING FUNCTION The DS21455/DS21458 can monitor one DS0 64kbps channel in the transmit direction and one DS0 channel in the receive direction at the same time. In the transmit direction the user will determine which channel is to be monitored by properly setting the TCM0 to TCM4 bits in the TDS0SEL register. In the receive direction, the RCM0 to RCM4 bits in the RDS0SEL register need to be properly set. The DS0 channel pointed to by the TCM0 to TCM4 bits will appear in the transmit DS0 monitor (TDS0M) register and the DS0 channel pointed to by the RCM0 to RCM4 bits will appear in the receive DS0 (RDS0M) register. The TCM4 to TCM0 and RCM4 to RCM0 bits should be programmed with the decimal decode of the appropriate T1 or E1 channel. T1 channels 1 through 24 map to register values 0 through 23. E1 channels 1 through 32 map to register values 0 through 31. For example, if DS0 channel 6 in the transmit direction and DS0 channel 15 in the receive direction needed to be monitored, then the following values would be programmed into TDS0SEL and RDS0SEL: TCM4 = 0 TCM3 = 0 TCM2 = 1 TCM1 = 0 TCM0 = 1 RCM4 = 0 RCM3 = 1 RCM2 = 1 RCM1 = 1 RCM0 = 0 16.1 Transmit DS0 Monitor Registers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: TDS0SEL Transmit Channel Monitor Select 74h Bit # Name Default 6 — 0 7 — 0 5 — 0 4 TCM4 0 3 TCM3 0 2 TCM2 0 1 TCM1 0 0 TCM0 0 Bits 0 to 4 Transmit Channel Monitor Bits (TCM0 to TCM4). TCM0 is the LSB of a 5-bit channel select that determines which transmit channel data will appear in the TDS0M register. Bits 5 to 7/Unused, must be set to zero for proper operation. Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: TDS0M Transmit DS0 Monitor Register 75h Bit # Name Default 6 B2 0 7 B1 0 5 B3 0 4 B4 0 3 B5 0 2 B6 0 1 B7 0 0 B8 0 Bits 0 to 7/Transmit DS0 Channel Bits (B1 to B8). Transmit channel data that has been selected by the transmit channel monitor select register. B8 is the LSB of the DS0 channel (last bit to be transmitted). 91 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 16.2 Receive DS0 Monitor Registers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: RDS0SEL Receive Channel Monitor Select 76h Bit # Name Default 6 — 0 7 — 0 5 — 0 4 RCM4 0 3 RCM3 0 2 RCM2 0 1 RCM1 0 0 RCM0 0 Bits 0 to 4/Receive Channel Monitor Bits (RCM0 to RCM4). RCM0 is the LSB of a 5-bit channel-select that determines which receive DS0 channel data will appear in the RDS0M register. Bits 5 to 7/Unused, must be set to zero for proper operation. Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: RDS0M Receive DS0 Monitor Register 77h Bit # Name Default 6 B2 0 7 B1 0 5 B3 0 4 B4 0 3 B5 0 2 B6 0 1 B7 0 0 B8 0 Bits 0 to 7/Receive DS0 Channel Bits (B1 to B8). Receive-channel data that has been selected by the receive-channel monitor-select register. B8 is the LSB of the DS0 channel (last bit to be received). 92 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 17. SIGNALING OPERATION There are two methods to access receive signaling data and provide transmit signaling data: processorbased (i.e., software-based) or hardware-based. Processor-based refers to access through the transmit and receive signaling registers, RS1–RS16 and TS1–TS16. Hardware-based refers to the TSIG and RSIG pins. Both methods can be used simultaneously. 17.1 Receive Signaling Figure 17-1. Simplified Diagram of Receive Signaling Path PER-CHANNEL CONTROL T1/E1 DATA STREAM SIGNALING EXTRACTION RECEIVE SIGNALING REGISTERS CHANGE OF STATE INDICATION REGISTERS ALL ONES RE-INSERTION CONTROL SIGNALING BUFFERS 93 of 270 RSER RSYNC RSIG DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 17.1.1 Processor-Based Receive Signaling The robbed-bit signaling (T1) or TS16 CAS signaling (E1) is sampled in the receive data stream and copied into the receive signaling registers, RS1 through RS16. In T1 mode, only RS1 through RS12 are used. The signaling information in these registers is always updated on multiframe boundaries. This function is always enabled. 17.1.1.1 Change Of State In order to avoid constant monitoring of the receive signaling registers, the DS21455/DS21458 can be programmed to alert the host when any specific channel or channels undergo a change of their signaling state. RSCSE1 through RSCSE4 for E1 and RSCSE1 through RSCSE3 for T1 are used to select which channels can cause a change of state indication. The change of state is indicated in Status Register 5 (SR1.5). If signaling integration, CCR1.5, is enabled then the new signaling state must be constant for three multiframes before a change of state indication is indicated. The user can enable the INT pin to toggle low upon detection of a change in signaling by setting the IMR1.5 bit. The signaling integration mode is global and cannot be enabled on a channel-by-channel basis. The user can identity which channels have undergone a signaling change of state by reading the RSINFO1 through RSINFO4 registers. The information from this registers will tell the user which RSx register to read for the new signaling data. All changes are indicated in the RSINFO1–RSINFO4 register regardless of the RSCSE1–RSCSE4 registers. 17.1.2 Hardware-Based Receive Signaling In hardware-based signaling the signaling data can be obtained from the RSER pin or the RSIG pin. RSIG is a signaling PCM-stream output on a channel-by-channel basis from the signaling buffer. The signaling data, T1 robbed bit or E1 TS16, is still present in the original data stream at RSER. The signaling buffer provides signaling data to the RSIG pin and also allows signaling data to be reinserted into the original data stream in a different alignment that is determined by a multiframe signal from the RSYNC pin. In this mode, the receive elastic store can be enabled or disabled. If the receive elastic store is enabled, then the backplane clock (RSYSCLK) can be either 1.544MHz or 2.048MHz. In the ESF framing mode, the ABCD signaling bits are output on RSIG in the lower nibble of each channel. The RSIG data is updated once a multiframe (3ms) unless a freeze is in effect. In the D4 framing mode, the AB signaling bits are output twice on RSIG in the lower nibble of each channel. Hence, bits 5 and 6 contain the same data as bits 7 and 8 respectively in each channel. The RSIG data is updated once a multiframe (1.5ms) unless a freeze is in effect. See the Functional Timing Diagrams for some examples. 17.1.2.1 Receive-Signaling Reinsertion at RSER In this mode, the user will provide a multiframe sync at the RSYNC pin and the signaling data will be reinserted based on this alignment. In T1 mode, this results in two copies of the signaling data in the RSER data stream. The original signaling data based on the Fs/ESF frame positions and the realigned data based on the user supplied multiframe sync applied at RSYNC. In voice channels this extra copy of signaling data is of little consequence. Reinsertion can be avoided in data channels since this feature is activated on a per-channel basis. For reinsertion, the elastic store must be enabled; however, the backplane clock can be either 1.544MHz or 2.048MHz. Signaling reinsertion mode is enabled, on a per-channel basis by setting the RSRCS bit high in the PCPR register. The channels that are to have signaling reinserted are selected by writing to the PCDR1-PCDR3 registers for T1 mode and PCDR1–PCDR4 registers for E1 mode. In E1 mode, the user will generally select all channels when doing reinsertion. 94 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 17.1.2.2 Force Receive Signaling All Ones In T1 mode, the user can, on a per-channel basis, force the robbed-bit signaling-bit positions to a one. This is done by using the per-channel register, which is described in the Special Per-Channel Operation section. The user sets the BTCS bit in the PCPR register. The channels that are to be forced to one are selected by writing to the PCDR1–PCDR3 registers. 17.1.2.3 Receive-Signaling Freeze The signaling data in the four-multiframe signaling buffer will be frozen in a known good state upon either a loss of synchronization (OOF event), carrier loss, or frame slip. This action meets the requirements of BellCore TR–TSY–000170 for signaling freezing. To allow this freeze action to occur, the RFE control bit (SIGCR.4) should be set high. The user can force a freeze by setting the RFF control bit (SIGCR.3) high. The RSIGF output pin provides a hardware indication that a freeze is in effect. The four multiframe buffer provides a three-multiframe delay in the signaling bits provided at the RSIG pin (and at the RSER pin if receive signaling reinsertion is enabled). When freezing is enabled (RFE = 1), the signaling data will be held in the last known good state until the corrupting error condition subsides. When the error condition subsides, the signaling data will be held in the old state for at least an additional 9ms (or 4.5ms in D4 framing mode) before being allowed to be updated with new signaling data. 95 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: SIGCR Signaling Control Register 40h Bit # Name Default 6 — 0 7 GRSRE 0 5 — 0 4 RFE 0 3 RFF 0 2 RCCS 0 1 TCCS 0 0 FRSAO 0 Bit 0/Force Receive Signaling All Ones (FRSAO). In T1 mode, this bit forces all signaling data at the RSIG and RSER pin to all ones. This bit has no effect in E1 mode. 0 = normal signaling data at RSIG and RSER 1 = force signaling data at RSIG and RSER to all ones Bit 1/Transmit Time Slot Control for CAS Signaling (TCCS). Controls the order that signaling is transmitted from the transmit signaling registers. This bit should be set = 0 in T1 mode. 0 = signaling data is CAS format 1 = signaling data is CCS format Bit 2/Receive Time Slot Control for CAS Signaling (RCCS). Controls the order that signaling is placed into the receive signaling registers. This bit should be set = 0 in T1 mode. 0 = signaling data is CAS format 1 = signaling data is CCS format Bit 3/Receive Force Freeze (RFF). Freezes receive-side signaling at RSIG (and RSER if receive signaling reinsertion is enabled); will override receive-freeze enable (RFE). See the Receive Signaling Freeze section. 0 = do not force a freeze event 1 = force a freeze event Bit 4/Receive Freeze Enable (RFE). See the Receive Signaling Freeze section. 0 = no freezing of receive signaling data will occur 1 = allow freezing of receive signaling data at RSIG (and RSER if receive signaling reinsertion is enabled). Bit 5/Unused, must be set to zero for proper operation. Bit 6/Unused, must be set to zero for proper operation. Bit 7/Global Receive Signaling Reinsertion Enable (GRSRE). This bit allows the user to reinsert all signaling channels without programming all channels through the per-channel function. 0 = do not reinsert all signaling 1 = reinsert all signaling 96 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: (MSB) CH2-A CH4-A CH6-A CH8-A CH10-A CH12-A CH14-A CH16-A CH18-A CH20-A CH22-A CH24-A CH2-B CH4-B CH6-B CH8-B CH10-B CH12-B CH14-B CH16-B CH18-B CH20-B CH22-B CH24-B Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: (MSB) CH2-A CH4-A CH6-A CH8-A CH10-A CH12-A CH14-A CH16-A CH18-A CH20-A CH22-A CH24-A CH2-B CH4-B CH6-B CH8-B CH10-B CH12-B CH14-B CH16-B CH18-B CH20-B CH22-B CH24-B RS1 to RS12 Receive Signaling Registers (T1 Mode, ESF Format) 60h to 6Bh CH2-C CH4-C CH6-C CH8-C CH10-C CH12-C CH14-C CH16-C CH18-C CH20-C CH22-C CH24-C CH2-D CH4-D CH6-D CH8-D CH10-D CH12-D CH14-D CH16-D CH18-D CH20-D CH22-D CH24-D CH1-A CH3-A CH5-A CH7-A CH9-A CH11-A CH13-A CH15-A CH17-A CH19-A CH21-A CH23-A CH1-B CH3-B CH5-B CH7-B CH9-B CH11-B CH13-B CH15-B CH17-B CH19-B CH21-B CH23-B CH1-C CH3-C CH5-C CH7-C CH9-C CH11-C CH13-C CH15-C CH17-C CH19-C CH21-C CH23-C (LSB) CH1-D CH3-D CH5-D CH7-D CH9-D CH11-D CH13-D CH15-D CH17-D CH19-D CH21-D CH23-D RS1 RS2 RS3 RS4 RS5 RS6 RS7 RS8 RS9 RS10 RS11 RS12 RS1 to RS12 Receive Signaling Registers (T1 Mode, D4 Format) 60h to 6Bh CH2-A CH4-A CH6-A CH8-A CH10-A CH12-A CH14-A CH16-A CH18-A CH20-A CH22-A CH24-A CH2-B CH4-B CH6-B CH8-B CH10-B CH12-B CH14-B CH16-B CH18-B CH20-B CH22-B CH24-B CH1-A CH3-A CH5-A CH7-A CH9-A CH11-A CH13-A CH15-A CH17-A CH19-A CH21-A CH23-A CH1-B CH3-B CH5-B CH7-B CH9-B CH11-B CH13-B CH15-B CH17-B CH19-B CH21-B CH23-B CH1-A CH3-A CH5-A CH7-A CH9-A CH11-A CH13-A CH15-A CH17-A CH19-A CH21-A CH23-A (LSB) CH1-B CH3-B CH5-B CH7-B CH9-B CH11-B CH13-B CH15-B CH17-B CH19-B CH21-B CH23-B Note: In D4 format, TS1–TS12 contain signaling data for two frames. Bold type indicates data for second frame. 97 of 270 RS1 RS2 RS3 RS4 RS5 RS6 RS7 RS8 RS9 RS10 RS11 RS12 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: (MSB) 0 CH2-A CH4-A CH6-A CH8-A CH10-A CH12-A CH14-A CH16-A CH18-A CH20-A CH22-A CH24-A CH26-A CH28-A CH30-A 0 CH2-B CH4-B CH6-B CH8-B CH10-B CH12-B CH14-B CH16-B CH18-B CH20-B CH22-B CH24-B CH26-B CH28-B CH30-B Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: (MSB) 1 9 17 25 33 41 49 57 65 73 81 89 97 105 113 121 2 10 18 26 34 42 50 58 66 74 82 90 98 106 114 122 RS1 to RS16 Receive Signaling Registers (E1 Mode, CAS Format) 60h to 6Fh 0 CH2-C CH4-C CH6-C CH8-C CH10-C CH12-C CH14-C CH16-C CH18-C CH20-C CH22-C CH24-C CH26-C CH28-C CH30-C 0 CH2-D CH4-D CH6-D CH8-D CH10-D CH12-D CH14-D CH16-D CH18-D CH20-D CH22-D CH24-D CH26-D CH28-D CH30-D X CH1-A CH3-A CH5-A CH7-A CH9-A CH11-A CH13-A CH15-A CH17-A CH19-A CH21-A CH23-A CH25-A CH27-A CH29-A Y CH1-B CH3-B CH5-B CH7-B CH9-B CH11-B CH13-B CH15-B CH17-B CH19-B CH21-B CH23-B CH25-B CH27-B CH29-B X CH1-C CH3-C CH5-C CH7-C CH9-C CH11-C CH13-C CH15-C CH17-C CH19-C CH21-C CH23-C CH25-C CH27-C CH29-C (LSB) X CH1-D CH3-D CH5-D CH7-D CH9-D CH11-D CH13-D CH15-D CH17-D CH19-D CH21-D CH23-D CH25-D CH27-D CH29-D RS1 RS2 RS3 RS4 RS5 RS6 RS7 RS8 RS9 RS10 RS11 RS12 RS13 RS14 RS15 RS16 (LSB) 8 16 24 32 40 48 56 64 72 80 88 96 104 112 120 128 RS1 RS2 RS3 RS4 RS5 RS6 RS7 RS8 RS9 RS10 RS11 RS12 RS13 RS14 RS15 RS16 RS1 to RS16 Receive Signaling Registers (E1 Mode, CCS Format) 60h to 6Fh 3 11 19 27 35 43 51 59 67 75 83 91 99 107 115 123 4 12 20 28 36 44 52 60 68 76 84 92 100 108 116 124 5 13 21 29 37 45 53 61 69 77 85 93 101 109 117 125 6 14 22 30 38 46 54 62 70 78 86 94 102 110 118 126 98 of 270 7 15 23 31 39 47 55 63 71 79 87 95 103 111 119 127 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: (MSB) CH8 CH16 CH24 CH7 CH15 CH23 RSCSE1, RSCSE2, RSCSE3, RSCSE4 Receive Signaling Change Of State Interrupt Enable 3Ch, 3Dh, 3Eh, 3Fh CH6 CH14 CH22 CH30 CH5 CH13 CH21 CH29 CH4 CH12 CH20 CH28 CH3 CH11 CH19 CH27 CH2 CH10 CH18 CH26 (LSB) CH1 CH9 CH17 CH25 RSCSE1 RSCSE2 RSCSE3 RSCSE4 Setting any of the CH1 through CH30 bits in the RSCSE1 through RSCSE4 registers will cause an interrupt when that channel’s signaling data changes state. Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: (MSB) CH8 CH16 CH24 CH7 CH15 CH23 RSINFO1, RSINFO2, RSINFO3, RSINFO4 Receive Signaling Change Of State Information 38h, 39h, 3Ah, 3Bh CH6 CH14 CH22 CH30 CH5 CH13 CH21 CH29 CH4 CH12 CH20 CH28 CH3 CH11 CH19 CH27 CH2 CH10 CH18 CH26 (LSB) CH1 CH9 CH17 CH25 RSINFO1 RSINFO2 RSINFO3 RSINFO4 When a channel’s signaling data changes state, the respective bit in registers RSINFO1-4 will be set. If the channel was also enabled as an interrupt source by setting the appropriate bit in RSCSE1–4, an interrupt is generated. The bit will remain set until read. 99 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 17.2 Transmit Signaling Figure 17-2.Simplified Diagram of Transmit Signaling Path TRANSMIT SIGNALING REGISTERS 1 0 0 T1/E1 DATA STREAM TSER 0 1 1 B7 SIGNALING BUFFERS TSIG T1TCR1.4 PER-CHANNEL CONTROL PER-CHANNEL CONTROL PCPR.3 SSIE1 - SSIE4 ONLY APPLIES TO T1 MODE 17.2.1 Processor-Based Transmit Signaling In processor-based mode, signaling data is loaded into the transmit-signaling registers (TS1–TS16) via the host interface. On multiframe boundaries, the contents of these registers are loaded into a shift register for placement in the appropriate bit position in the outgoing data stream. The user can utilize the transmit multiframe interrupt in status register 4 (SR4.4) to know when to update the signaling bits. The user need not update any transmit signaling register for which there is no change of state for that register. Each transmit signaling register contains the robbed-bit signaling (T1) or TS16 CAS signaling (E1) for two time slots that will be inserted into the outgoing stream if enabled to do so via T1TCR1.4 (T1 Mode) or E1TCR1.6 (E1 Mode). In T1 mode, only TS1 through TS12 are used. Signaling data can be sourced from the TS registers on a per-channel basis by utilizing the softwaresignaling insertion-enable registers, SSIE1 through SSIE4. 100 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 17.2.1.1 T1 Mode In T1 ESF framing mode, there are four signaling bits per channel (A, B, C, and D). TS1–TS12 contain a full multiframe of signaling data. In T1 D4 framing mode, there are only two signaling bits per channel (A and B). In T1 D4 framing mode, the framer uses the C and D bit positions as the A and B bit positions for the next multiframe. In D4 mode, two multiframes of signaling data can be loaded into TS1–TS12. The framer will load the contents of TS1–TS12 into the outgoing shift register every other D4 multiframe. In D4 mode the host should load new contents into TS1–TS12 on every other multiframe boundary and no later than 120µs after the boundary. 17.2.1.2 E1 Mode In E1 mode, TS16 carries the signaling information. This information can be in either CCS (common channel signaling) or CAS (channel associated signaling) format. The 32 time slots are referenced by two different channel number schemes in E1. In channel numbering, TS0 through TS31 are labeled channels 1 through 32. In phone-channel numbering, TS1 through TS15 are labeled channel 1 through channel 15, and TS17 through TS31 are labeled channel 15 through channel 30. Table 17-1. TIME SLOT NUMBERING SCHEMES 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 TS Channel 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 Phone Channel 101 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: (MSB) 0 CH2-A CH4-A CH6-A CH8-A CH10-A CH12-A CH14-A CH16-A CH18-A CH20-A CH22-A CH24-A CH26-A CH28-A CH30-A 0 CH2-B CH4-B CH6-B CH8-B CH10-B CH12-B CH14-B CH16-B CH18-B CH20-B CH22-B CH24-B CH26-B CH28-B CH30-B Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: (MSB) 1 17 33 49 65 81 97 113 13 29 45 61 77 93 109 125 2 18 34 50 66 82 98 114 14 30 46 62 78 94 110 126 TS1 to TS16 Transmit Signaling Registers (E1 Mode, CAS Format) 50h to 5Fh 0 CH2-C CH4-C CH6-C CH8-C CH10-C CH12-C CH14-C CH16-C CH18-C CH20-C CH22-C CH24-C CH26-C CH28-C CH30-C 0 CH2-D CH4-D CH6-D CH8-D CH10-D CH12-D CH14-D CH16-D CH18-D CH20-D CH22-D CH24-D CH26-D CH28-D CH30-D X CH1-A CH3-A CH5-A CH7-A CH9-A CH11-A CH13-A CH15-A CH17-A CH19-A CH21-A CH23-A CH25-A CH27-A CH29-A Y CH1-B CH3-B CH5-B CH7-B CH9-B CH11-B CH13-B CH15-B CH17-B CH19-B CH21-B CH23-B CH25-B CH27-B CH29-B X CH1-C CH3-C CH5-C CH7-C CH9-C CH11-C CH13-C CH15-C CH17-C CH19-C CH21-C CH23-C CH25-C CH27-C CH29-C (LSB) X CH1-D CH3-D CH5-D CH7-D CH9-D CH11-D CH13-D CH15-D CH17-D CH19-D CH21-D CH23-D CH25-D CH27-D CH29-D TS1 TS2 TS3 TS4 TS5 TS6 TS7 TS8 TS9 TS10 TS11 TS12 TS13 TS14 TS15 TS16 TS1 to TS16 Transmit Signaling Registers (E1 Mode, CCS Format) 50h to 5Fh 3 19 35 51 67 83 99 115 15 31 47 63 89 95 111 127 4 20 36 52 68 84 100 116 16 32 48 64 80 96 112 128 5 9 25 41 57 73 89 105 121 21 37 53 69 85 101 117 6 10 26 42 58 74 90 106 122 22 38 54 70 86 102 118 102 of 270 7 11 27 43 59 75 91 107 123 23 39 55 71 87 103 119 (LSB) 8 12 28 44 60 76 92 108 124 24 40 56 72 88 104 120 TS1 TS2 TS3 TS4 TS5 TS6 TS7 TS8 TS9 TS10 TS11 TS12 TS13 TS14 TS15 TS16 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: (MSB) CH2-A CH4-A CH6-A CH8-A CH10-A CH12-A CH14-A CH16-A CH18-A CH20-A CH22-A CH24-A CH2-B CH4-B CH6-B CH8-B CH10-B CH12-B CH14-B CH16-B CH18-B CH20-B CH22-B CH24-B Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: (MSB) CH2-A CH4-A CH6-A CH8-A CH10-A CH12-A CH14-A CH16-A CH18-A CH20-A CH22-A CH24-A CH2-B CH4-B CH6-B CH8-B CH10-B CH12-B CH14-B CH16-B CH18-B CH20-B CH22-B CH24-B TS1 to TS16 Transmit Signaling Registers (T1 Mode, ESF Format) 50h to 5Bh CH2-C CH4-C CH6-C CH8-C CH10-C CH12-C CH14-C CH16-C CH18-C CH20-C CH22-C CH24-C CH2-D CH4-D CH6-D CH8-D CH10-D CH12-D CH14-D CH16-D CH18-D CH20-D CH22-D CH24-D CH1-A CH3-A CH5-A CH7-A CH9-A CH11-A CH13-A CH15-A CH17-A CH19-A CH21-A CH23-A CH1-B CH3-B CH5-B CH7-B CH9-B CH11-B CH13-B CH15-B CH17-B CH19-B CH21-B CH23-B CH1-C CH3-C CH5-C CH7-C CH9-C CH11-C CH13-C CH15-C CH17-C CH19-C CH21-C CH23-C (LSB) CH1-D CH3-D CH5-D CH7-D CH9-D CH11-D CH13-D CH15-D CH17-D CH19-D CH21-D CH23-D TS1 TS2 TS3 TS4 TS5 TS6 TS7 TS8 TS9 TS10 TS11 TS12 (LSB) CH1-B CH3-B CH5-B CH7-B CH9-B CH11-B CH13-B CH15-B CH17-B CH19-B CH21-B CH23-B TS1 TS2 TS3 TS4 TS5 TS6 TS7 TS8 TS9 TS10 TS11 TS12 TS1 to TS16 Transmit Signaling Registers (T1 Mode, D4 Format) 50h to 5Bh CH2-A CH4-A CH6-A CH8-A CH10-A CH12-A CH14-A CH16-A CH18-A CH20-A CH22-A CH24-A CH2-B CH4-B CH6-B CH8-B CH10-B CH12-B CH14-B CH16-B CH18-B CH20-B CH22-B CH24-B CH1-A CH3-A CH5-A CH7-A CH9-A CH11-A CH13-A CH15-A CH17-A CH19-A CH21-A CH23-A CH1-B CH3-B CH5-B CH7-B CH9-B CH11-B CH13-B CH15-B CH17-B CH19-B CH21-B CH23-B CH1-A CH3-A CH5-A CH7-A CH9-A CH11-A CH13-A CH15-A CH17-A CH19-A CH21-A CH23-A Note: In D4 format, TS1–TS12 contain signaling data for two frames. Bold type indicates data for second frame. 103 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 17.2.2 Software Signaling Insertion Enable Registers, E1 CAS Mode In E1 CAS mode, the CAS signaling alignment/alarm byte can be sourced from the transmit signaling registers along with the signaling data. Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 CH7 0 SSIE1 Software Signaling Insertion Enable 1 08h 6 CH6 0 5 CH5 0 4 CH4 0 3 CH3 0 2 CH2 0 1 CH1 0 0 UCAW 0 Bit 0/Upper CAS Align/Alarm Word (UCAW). Selects the upper CAS align/alarm pattern (0000) to be sourced from the upper 4 bits of the TS1 register. 0 = do not source the upper CAS align/alarm pattern from the TS1 register 1 = source the upper CAS align/alarm pattern from the TS1 register Bits 1 to 7/Software Signaling Insertion Enable for Channels 1 to 7 (CH1 to CH7). These bits determine which channels are to have signaling inserted form the Transmit Signaling registers. 0 = do not source signaling data from the TSx registers for this channel 1 = source signaling data from the TSx registers for this channel Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 CH15 0 SSIE2 Software Signaling Insertion Enable 2 09h 6 CH14 0 5 CH13 0 4 CH12 0 3 CH11 0 2 CH10 0 1 CH9 0 0 CH8 0 Bits 0 to 7/Software Signaling Insertion Enable for Channels 8 to 15 (CH8 to CH15). These bits determine which channels are to have signaling inserted form the transmit signaling registers. 0 = do not source signaling data from the TS registers for this channel 1 = source signaling data from the TS registers for this channel 104 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 CH22 0 SSIE3 Software Signaling Insertion Enable 3 0Ah 6 CH21 0 5 CH20 0 4 CH19 0 3 CH18 0 2 CH17 0 1 CH16 0 0 LCAW 0 Bit 0/Lower CAS Align/Alarm Word (LCAW). Selects the lower CAS align/alarm bits (xyxx) to be sourced from the lower 4 bits of the TS1 register. 0 = do not source the lower CAS align/alarm bits from the TS1 register 1 = source the lower CAS alarm align/bits from the TS1 register Bits 1 to 7/Software Signaling Insertion Enable for LCAW and Channels 16 to 22 (CH16 to CH22). These bits determine which channels are to have signaling inserted form the Transmit Signaling registers. 0 = do not source signaling data from the TSx registers for this channel 1 = source signaling data from the TSx registers for this channel Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 CH30 0 SSIE4 Software Signaling Insertion Enable 4 0Bh 6 CH29 0 5 CH28 0 4 CH27 0 3 CH26 0 2 CH25 0 1 CH24 0 0 CH23 0 Bits 0 to 7/Software Signaling Insertion Enable for Channels 23 to 30 (CH23 to CH30). These bits determine which channels are to have signaling inserted form the transmit signaling registers. 0 = do not source signaling data from the TS registers for this channel 1 = source signaling data from the TS registers for this channel 105 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 17.2.3 Software Signaling Insertion Enable Registers, T1 Mode In T1 mode, only registers SSIE1 through SSIE3 are used since there are only 24 channels in a T1 frame. Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 CH8 0 SSIE1 Software Signaling Insertion Enable 1 08h 6 CH7 0 5 CH6 0 4 CH5 0 3 CH4 0 2 CH3 0 1 CH2 0 0 CH1 0 Bits 0 to 7/Software Signaling Insertion Enable for and Channels 1 to 8 (CH1 to CH8). These bits determine what channels are to have signaling inserted form the transmit signaling registers. 0 = do not source signaling data from the TSx registers for this channel 1 = source signaling data from the TSx registers for this channel Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 CH16 0 SSIE2 Software Signaling Insertion Enable 2 09h 6 CH15 0 5 CH14 0 4 CH13 0 3 CH12 0 2 CH11 0 1 CH10 0 0 CH9 0 Bits 0 to 7/Software Signaling Insertion Enable for Channels 9 to 16 (CH9 to CH16). These bits determine what channels are to have signaling inserted form the transmit signaling registers. 0 = do not source signaling data from the TSx registers for this channel 1 = source signaling data from the TSx registers for this channel Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 CH24 0 SSIE3 Software Signaling Insertion Enable 3 0Ah 6 CH23 0 5 CH22 0 4 CH21 0 3 CH20 0 2 CH19 0 1 CH18 0 0 CH17 0 Bits 0 to 7/Software Signaling Insertion Enable for and Channels 17 to 24 (CH17 to CH24). These bits determine what channels are to have signaling inserted form the transmit signaling registers. 0 = do not source signaling data from the TSx registers for this channel 1 = source signaling data from the TSx registers for this channel 106 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 17.2.4 Hardware-Based Transmit Signaling In hardware-based mode, signaling data is input via the TSIG pin. This signaling PCM stream is buffered and inserted to the data stream being input at the TSER pin. Signaling data can be input on a per-channel basis via the transmit-hardware signaling-channel select (THSCS) function. The framer can be set up to take the signaling data presented at the TSIG pin and insert the signaling data into the PCM data stream that is being input at the TSER pin. The user has the ability to control what channels are to have signaling data from the TSIG pin inserted into them on a perchannel basis. See the Special Per-Channel Operation section. The signaling insertion capabilities of the framer are available whether the transmit-side elastic store is enabled or disabled. If the elastic store is enabled, the backplane clock (TSYSCLK) can be either 1.544MHz or 2.048MHz. 107 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 18. PER-CHANNEL IDLE CODE GENERATION Channel data can be replaced by an idle code on a per-channel basis in the transmit and receive directions. When operated in the T1 mode, only the first 24 channels are used; the remaining channels, CH25–CH32 are not used. The DS21455/DS21458 contain a 64-byte idle code array accessed by the idle array address register (IAAR) and the per-channel idle code register (PCICR). The contents of the array contain the idle codes to be substituted into the appropriate transmit or receive channels. This substitution can be enabled and disabled on a per-channel basis by the transmit-channel idle-code enable registers (TCICE1–4) and receive-channel idle-code enable registers (RCICE1–4). To program idle codes, first select a channel by writing to the IAAR register. Then write the idle code to the PCICR register. Bits 6 and 7 (GTIC, GRIC) of the IAAR register can be used to block write a common idle code to all transmit or receive positions in the array with a single write to the PCICR register. The user can use the block write feature to set a common idle code for all transmit and receive channels in the IAAR by setting both GTIC and GRIC = 1. When a block write is enabled by GTIC or GRIC, the value placed in the PCICR register will be written to all addresses in the transmit or receive idle array and to whatever address is in the lower 6 bits of the IAAR register. Therefore, when enabling only one of the block functions, GTIC or GRIC, the user must set the lower 6 bits of the IAAR register to any address in that block. Bits 6 and 7 of the IAAR register must be set = 0 for read operations. The TCICE1–4 and RCICE1–4 are used to enable idle-code replacement on a per-channel basis. Table 18-1. IDLE CODE ARRAY ADDRESS MAPPING BITS 0–5 OF IAAR REGISTER 0 1 2 MAPS TO CHANNEL Transmit Channel 1 Transmit Channel 2 Transmit Channel 3 … … 30 31 32 33 34 Transmit Channel 31 Transmit Channel 32 Receive Channel 1 Receive Channel 2 Receive Channel 3 … … 62 63 Receive Channel 31 Receive Channel 32 108 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 18.1 Idle Code Programming Examples The following example sets transmit channel 3 idle code to 7Eh: Write IAAR = 02h Write PCICR = 7Eh ;select channel 3 in the array ;set idle code to 7Eh The following example sets transmit channels 3, 4, 5, and 6 idle code to 7Eh and enables transmission of idle codes for those channels: Write IAAR = 02h Write PCICR = 7Eh Write PCICR = 7Eh Write PCICR = 7Eh Write PCICR = 7Eh Write TCICE1 = 3Ch ;select channel 3 in the array ;set channel 3 idle code to 7Eh ;set channel 4 idle code to 7Eh ;set channel 5 idle code to 7Eh ;set channel 6 idle code to 7Eh ;enable transmission of idle codes for channels 3, 4, 5, and 6 The following example sets transmit channels 3, 4, 5, and 6 idle code to 7Eh, EEh, FFh, and 7Eh respectively: Write IAAR = 02h Write PCICR = 7Eh Write PCICR = EEh Write PCICR = FFh Write PCICR = 7Eh The following example sets all transmit idle codes to 7Eh: Write IAAR = 40h Write PCICR = 7Eh The following example sets all receive and transmit idle codes to 7Eh and enables idle code substitution in all E1 transmit and receive channels: Write IAAR = C0h Write PCICR = 7Eh Write TCICE1 = FEh Write TCICE2 = FFh Write TCICE3 = FEh Write TCICE4 = FFh Write RCICE1 = FEh Write RCICE2 = FFh Write RCICE3 = FEh Write RCICE4 = FFh ;enable block write to all transmit and receive positions in the array ;7Eh is idle code ;enable idle code substitution for transmit channels 2 through 8 ;Although an idle code was programmed for channel 1 by the block write ;function above, enabling it for channel 1 would step on the frame ;alignment, alarms, and Sa bits ;enable idle code substitution for transmit channels 9 through 16 ;enable idle code substitution for transmit channels 18 through 24 ;Although an idle code was programmed for channel 17 by the block write ;function above, enabling it for channel 17 would step on the CAS frame ;alignment, and signaling information ;enable idle code substitution for transmit channels 25 through 32 ;enable idle code substitution for receive channels 2 through 8 ;enable idle code substitution for receive channels 9 through 16 ;enable idle code substitution for receive channels 18 through 24 ;enable idle code substitution for receive channels 25 through 32 109 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 GRIC 0 IAAR Idle Array Address Register 7Eh 6 GTIC 0 5 IAA5 0 4 IAA4 0 3 IAA3 0 2 IAA2 0 1 IAA1 0 0 IAA0 0 Bits 0 to 5/Channel Pointer Address Bits (IAA0 to IAA5). IAA0 is the LSB of the 5-bit Channel Code. Bit 6/Global Transmit Idle Code (GTIC). Setting this bit will cause all transmit idle codes to be set to the value written to the PCICR register. When using this bit, the user must place any transmit address in the IAA0 through IAA5 bits (00h–1Fh). This bit must be set = 0 for read operations. Bit 7/Global Receive Idle Code (GRIC). Setting this bit will cause all receive idle codes to be set to the value written to the PCICR register. When using this bit, the user must place any receive address in the IAA0 through IAA5 bits (20h–3Fh). This bit must be set = 0 for read operations. Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: PCICR Per-Channel Idle Code Register 7Fh Bit # Name Default 6 C6 0 7 C7 0 5 C5 0 4 C4 0 3 C3 0 2 C2 0 1 C1 0 0 C0 0 Bits 0 to 7/Per-Channel Idle Code Bits (C0 to C7). C0 is the LSB of the code (this bit is transmitted last). The TCICE1/2/3/4 are used to determine which of the 24 T1 or 32 E1 channels from the backplane to the T1 or E1 line should be overwritten with the code placed in the per-channel code array. Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 CH8 0 TCICE1 Transmit Channel Idle Code Enable Register 1 80h 6 CH7 0 5 CH6 0 4 CH5 0 3 CH4 0 2 CH3 0 1 CH2 0 0 CH1 0 1 CH10 0 0 CH9 0 Bits 0 to 7/Transmit Channels 1 to 8 Code Insertion Control Bits (CH1 to CH8). 0 = do not insert data from the idle code array into the transmit data stream 1 = insert data from the idle code array into the transmit data stream Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 CH16 0 TCICE2 Transmit Channel Idle Code Enable Register 2 81h 6 CH15 0 5 CH14 0 4 CH13 0 3 CH12 0 2 CH11 0 Bits 0 to 7/Transmit Channels 9 to 16 Code Insertion Control Bits (CH9 to CH16). 0 = do not insert data from the idle code array into the transmit data stream 1 = insert data from the idle code array into the transmit data stream 110 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 CH24 0 TCICE3 Transmit Channel Idle Code Enable Register 3 82h 6 CH23 0 5 CH22 0 4 CH21 0 3 CH20 0 2 CH19 0 1 CH18 0 0 CH17 0 Bits 0 to 7/Transmit Channels 17 to 24 Code Insertion Control Bits (CH17 to CH24). 0 = do not insert data from the idle code array into the transmit data stream 1 = insert data from the idle code array into the transmit data stream Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 CH32 0 TCICE4 Transmit Channel Idle Code Enable Register 4 83h 6 CH31 0 5 CH30 0 4 CH29 0 3 CH28 0 2 CH27 0 1 CH26 0 0 CH25 0 Bits 0 to 7/Transmit Channels 25 to 32 Code Insertion Control Bits (CH25 to CH32). 0 = do not insert data from the idle code array into the transmit data stream 1 = insert data from the idle code array into the transmit data stream The receive-channel idle-code enable registers (RCICE1/2/3/4) are used to determine which of the 24 T1 or 32 E1 channels from the backplane to the T1 or E1 line should be overwritten with the code placed in the per-channel code array. Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 CH8 0 RCICE1 Receive Channel Idle Code Enable Register 1 84h 6 CH7 0 5 CH6 0 4 CH5 0 3 CH4 0 2 CH3 0 1 CH2 0 0 CH1 0 1 CH10 0 0 CH9 0 Bits 0 to 7/Receive Channels 1 to 8 Code Insertion Control Bits (CH1 to CH8). 0 = do not insert data from the idle code array into the receive data stream 1 = insert data from the idle code array into the receive data stream Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 CH16 0 RCICE2 Receive Channel Idle Code Enable Register 2 85h 6 CH15 0 5 CH14 0 4 CH13 0 3 CH12 0 2 CH11 0 Bits 0 to 7/Receive Channels 9 to 16 Code Insertion Control Bits (CH9 to CH16). 0 = do not insert data from the idle code array into the receive data stream 1 = insert data from the idle code array into the receive data stream 111 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 CH24 0 RCICE3 Receive Channel Idle Code Enable Register 3 86h 6 CH23 0 5 CH22 0 4 CH21 0 3 CH20 0 2 CH19 0 1 CH18 0 0 CH17 0 Bits 0 to 7/Receive Channels 17 to 24 Code Insertion Control Bits (CH17 to CH24). 0 = do not insert data from the idle code array into the receive data stream 1 = insert data from the idle code array into the receive data stream Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 CH32 0 RCICE4 Receive Channel Idle Code Enable Register 4 87h 6 CH31 0 5 CH30 0 4 CH29 0 3 CH28 0 2 CH27 0 1 CH26 0 Bits 0 to 7/Receive Channels 25 to 32 Code Insertion Control Bits (CH25 to CH32). 0 = do not insert data from the idle code array into the receive data stream 1 = insert data from the idle code array into the receive data stream 112 of 270 0 CH25 0 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 19. CHANNEL BLOCKING REGISTERS The receive-channel blocking registers (RCBR1/RCBR2/RCBR3/RCBR4) and the transmit-channel blocking registers (TCBR1/TCBR2/TCBR3/TCBR4) control the RCHBLK and TCHBLK pins, respectively. The RCHBLK and TCHBLK pins are user-programmable outputs that can be forced high or low during individual channels. These outputs can be used to block clocks to a USART or LAPD controller in ISDN–PRI applications. When the appropriate bits are set to a one, the RCHBLK and TCHBLK pin will be held high during the entire corresponding channel time. Channels 25 through 32 are ignored when the device is operated in the T1 mode. Also, the DS21455/DS21458 can internally generate and output a bursty clock on a per-channel basis (N x 64kbps / 56kbps). See the Fractional T1/E1 Support section. Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 CH8 0 RCBR1 Receive Channel Blocking Register 1 88h 6 CH7 0 5 CH6 0 4 CH5 0 3 CH4 0 2 CH3 0 1 CH2 0 0 CH1 0 1 CH10 0 0 CH9 0 Bits 0 to 7/Receive Channels 1 to 8 Channel Blocking Control Bits (CH1 to CH8). 0 = force the RCHBLK pin to remain low during this channel time 1 = force the RCHBLK pin high during this channel time Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 CH16 0 RCBR2 Receive Channel Blocking Register 2 89h 6 CH15 0 5 CH14 0 4 CH13 0 3 CH12 0 2 CH11 0 Bits 0 to 7/Receive Channels 9 to 16 Channel Blocking Control Bits (CH9 to CH16). 0 = force the RCHBLK pin to remain low during this channel time 1 = force the RCHBLK pin high during this channel time 113 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 CH24 0 RCBR3 Receive Channel Blocking Register 3 8Ah 6 CH23 0 5 CH22 0 4 CH21 0 3 CH20 0 2 CH19 0 1 CH18 0 0 CH17 0 Bits 0 to 7/Receive Channels 17 to 24 Channel Blocking Control Bits (CH17 to CH24). 0 = force the RCHBLK pin to remain low during this channel time 1 = force the RCHBLK pin high during this channel time Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 CH32 0 RCBR4 Receive Channel Blocking Register 4 8Bh 6 CH31 0 5 CH30 0 4 CH29 0 3 CH28 0 2 CH27 0 1 CH26 0 0 CH25 0 Bits 0 to 7/Receive Channels 25 to 32 Channel Blocking Control Bits (CH25 to CH32). 0 = force the RCHBLK pin to remain low during this channel time 1 = force the RCHBLK pin high during this channel time Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 CH8 0 TCBR1 Transmit Channel Blocking Register 1 8Ch 6 CH7 0 5 CH6 0 4 CH5 0 3 CH4 0 2 CH3 0 1 CH2 0 0 CH1 0 Bits 0 to 7/Transmit Channels 1 to 8 Channel Blocking Control Bits (CH1 to CH8). 0 = force the TCHBLK pin to remain low during this channel time 1 = force the TCHBLK pin high during this channel time Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 CH16 0 TCBR2 Transmit Channel Blocking Register 2 8Dh 6 CH15 0 5 CH14 0 4 CH13 0 3 CH12 0 2 CH11 0 1 CH10 0 Bits 0 to 7/Transmit Channels 9 to 16 Channel Blocking Control Bits (CH9 to CH16). 0 = force the TCHBLK pin to remain low during this channel time 1 = force the TCHBLK pin high during this channel time 114 of 270 0 CH9 0 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 CH24 0 TCBR3 Transmit Channel Blocking Register 3 8Eh 6 CH23 0 5 CH22 0 4 CH21 0 3 CH20 0 2 CH19 0 1 CH18 0 0 CH17 0 Bits 0 to 7/Transmit Channels 17 to 24 Channel Blocking Control Bits (CH17 to CH24). 0 = force the TCHBLK pin to remain low during this channel time 1 = force the TCHBLK pin high during this channel time Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 CH32 0 TCBR4 Transmit Channel Blocking Register 4 8Fh 6 CH31 0 5 CH30 0 4 CH29 0 3 CH28 0 2 CH27 0 1 CH26 0 Bits 0 to 7/Transmit Channels 25 to 32 Channel Blocking Control Bits (CH25 to CH32). 0 = force the TCHBLK pin to remain low during this channel time 1 = force the TCHBLK pin high during this channel time 115 of 270 0 CH25 0 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 20. ELASTIC STORES OPERATION The DS21455/DS21458 contain dual two-frame, fully independent elastic stores, one for the receive direction and one for the transmit direction. The transmit- and receive-side elastic stores can be enabled/disabled independent of each other. Also, each elastic store can interface to either a 1.544MHz or 2.048MHz/4.096MHz/8.192MHz/16.384MHz backplane without regard to the backplane rate to which the other elastic store is interfacing. The elastic stores have two main purposes. First, they can be used for rate conversion. When the device is in the T1 mode, the elastic stores can rate-convert the T1 data stream to a 2.048MHz backplane. In E1 mode, the elastic store can rate-convert the E1 data stream to a 1.544MHz backplane. Second, they can be used to absorb the differences in frequency and phase between the T1 or E1 data stream and an asynchronous (not locked) backplane clock (which can be 1.544MHz or 2.048MHz). In this mode, the elastic stores will manage the rate difference and perform controlled slips, deleting or repeating frames of data in order to manage the difference between the network and the backplane. The elastic stores can also be used to multiplex T1 or E1 data streams into higher backplane rates. See the Interleaved PCM Bus Operation section. 116 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: ESCR Elastic Store Control Register 4Fh Bit # Name Default 6 TESR 0 7 TESALGN 0 5 TESMDM 0 4 TESE 0 3 RESALGN 0 2 RESR 0 1 RESMDM 0 0 RESE 0 Bit 0/Receive Elastic Store Enable (RESE). 0 = elastic store is bypassed 1 = elastic store is enabled Bit 1/Receive Elastic Store Minimum Delay Mode (RESMDM). See the Minimum Delay Mode section for details. 0 = elastic stores operate at full two frame depth 1 = elastic stores operate at 32-bit depth Bit 2/Receive Elastic Store Reset (RESR). Setting this bit from a zero to a one forces the read and write pointers into opposite frames, maximizing the delay through the receive elastic store. Should be toggled after RSYSCLK has been applied and is stable. See the Elastic Stores Initialization section for details. Do not leave this bit set HIGH. Bit 3/Receive Elastic Store Align (RESALGN). Setting this bit from a zero to a one will force the receive elastic store’s write/read pointers to a minimum separation of half a frame. No action will be taken if the pointer separation is already greater or equal to half a frame. If pointer separation is less than half a frame, the command will be executed and the data will be disrupted. Should be toggled after RSYSCLK has been applied and is stable. Must be cleared and set again for a subsequent align. See the Elastic Stores Initialization section for details. Bit 4/Transmit Elastic Store Enable (TESE). 0 = elastic store is bypassed 1 = elastic store is enabled Bit 5/Transmit Elastic Store Minimum Delay Mode (TESMDM). See the Minimum Delay Mode section for details. 0 = elastic stores operate at full two frame depth 1 = elastic stores operate at 32-bit depth Bit 6/Transmit Elastic Store Reset (TESR). Setting this bit from a zero to a one forces the read and write pointers into opposite frames, maximizing the delay through the transmit elastic store. Transmit data is lost during the reset. Should be toggled after TSYSCLK has been applied and is stable. See the Elastic Stores Initialization section for details. Do not leave this bit set HIGH. Bit 7/Transmit Elastic Store Align (TESALGN). Setting this bit from a zero to a one will force the transmit elastic store’s write/read pointers to a minimum separation of half a frame. No action will be taken if the pointer separation is already greater or equal to half a frame. If pointer separation is less than half a frame, the command will be executed and the data will be disrupted. Should be toggled after TSYSCLK has been applied and is stable. Must be cleared and set again for a subsequent align. See the Elastic Stores Initialization section for details. 117 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: SR5 Status Register 5 1Eh Bit # Name Default 6 — 0 7 — 0 5 TESF 0 4 TESEM 0 3 TSLIP 0 2 RESF 0 1 RESEM 0 0 RSLIP 0 Bit 0/Receive Elastic Store Slip Occurrence Event (RSLIP). Set when the receive elastic store has either repeated or deleted a frame. Bit 1/Receive Elastic Store Empty Event (RESEM). Set when the receive elastic store buffer empties and a frame is repeated. Bit 2/Receive Elastic Store Full Event (RESF). Set when the receive elastic store buffer fills and a frame is deleted. Bit 3/Transmit Elastic Store Slip Occurrence Event (TSLIP). Set when the transmit elastic store has either repeated or deleted a frame. Bit 4/Transmit Elastic Store Empty Event (TESEM). Set when the transmit elastic store buffer empties and a frame is repeated. Bit 5/Transmit Elastic Store Full Event (TESF). Set when the transmit elastic store buffer fills and a frame is deleted. Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: IMR5 Interrupt Mask Register 5 1Fh Bit # Name Default 6 — 0 7 — 0 5 TESF 0 4 TESEM 0 3 TSLIP 0 Bit 0/Receive Elastic Store Slip Occurrence Event (RSLIP). 0 = interrupt masked 1 = interrupt enabled Bit 1/Receive Elastic Store Empty Event (RESEM). 0 = interrupt masked 1 = interrupt enabled Bit 2/Receive Elastic Store Full Event (RESF). 0 = interrupt masked 1 = interrupt enabled Bit 3/Transmit Elastic Store Slip Occurrence Event (TSLIP). 0 = interrupt masked 1 = interrupt enabled Bit 4/Transmit Elastic Store Empty Event (TESEM). 0 = interrupt masked 1 = interrupt enabled Bit 5/Transmit Elastic Store Full Event (TESF). 0 = interrupt masked 1 = interrupt enabled 118 of 270 2 RESF 0 1 RESEM 0 0 RSLIP 0 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 20.1 Receive Side See the IOCR1 and IOCR2 registers for information on clock and I/O configurations. If the receive-side elastic store is enabled, then the user must provide either a 1.544MHz or 2.048MHz clock at the RSYSCLK pin. For higher rate system-clock applications, see the Interleaved PCM Bus Operation section. The user has the option of either providing a frame/multiframe sync at the RSYNC pin or having the RSYNC pin provide a pulse on frame/multiframe boundaries. If signaling reinsertion is enabled, signaling data in TS16 is realigned to the multiframe-sync input on RSYNC. Otherwise, a multiframe-sync input on RSYNC is treated as a simple frame boundary by the elastic store. The framer will always indicate frame boundaries on the network side of the elastic store via the RFSYNC output whether the elastic store is enabled or not. Multiframe boundaries will always be indicated via the RMSYNC output. If the elastic store is enabled, then RMSYNC will output the multiframe boundary on the backplane side of the elastic store. 20.1.1 T1 Mode If the user selects to apply a 2.048MHz clock to the RSYSCLK pin, then the data output at RSER will be forced to all ones every fourth channel and the F-bit will be passed into the MSB of TS0. Hence, channels 1 (bits 1–7), 5, 9, 13, 17, 21, 25, and 29 (time slots 0 (bits 1–7), 4, 8, 12, 16, 20, 24, and 28) will be forced to a one. Also, in 2.048MHz applications, the RCHBLK output will be forced high during the same channels as the RSER pin. This is useful in T1 to E1 conversion applications. If the two-frame elastic buffer either fills or empties, a controlled slip will occur. If the buffer empties, then a full frame of data will be repeated at RSER and the SR5.0 and SR5.1 bits will be set to a one. If the buffer fills, then a full frame of data will be deleted and the SR5.0 and SR5.2 bits will be set to a one. 20.1.2 E1 Mode If the elastic store is enabled, then either CAS or CRC-4 multiframe boundaries will be indicated via the RMSYNC output. If the user selects to apply a 1.544MHz clock to the RSYSCLK pin, then every fourth channel of the received E1 data will be deleted and a F-bit position (which will be forced to one) will be inserted. Hence, channels 1, 5, 9, 13, 17, 21, 25, and 29 (time slots 0, 4, 8, 12, 16, 20, 24, and 28) will be deleted from the received E1 data stream. Also, in 1.544MHz applications, the RCHBLK output will not be active in channels 25 through 32 (or in other words, RCBR4 is not active). If the two-frame elastic buffer either fills or empties, a controlled slip will occur. If the buffer empties, then a full frame of data will be repeated at RSER and the SR5.0 and SR5.1 bits will be set to a one. If the buffer fills, then a full frame of data will be deleted and the SR5.0 and SR5.2 bits will be set to a one. 119 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 20.2 Transmit Side See the IOCR1 and IOCR2 registers for information on clock and I/O configurations. The operation of the transmit elastic store is very similar to the receive side. If the transmit-side elastic store is enabled a 1.544MHz or 2.048MHz clock can be applied to the TSYSCLK input. For higher-rate system clock applications, see the Interleaved PCM Bus Operation section. Controlled slips in the transmit elastic store are reported in the SR5.3 bit and the direction of the slip is reported in the SR5.4 and SR5.5 bits. 20.2.1 T1 Mode If the user selects to apply a 2.048MHz clock to the TSYSCLK pin, then the data input at TSER will be ignored every fourth channel. Hence, channels 1, 5, 9, 13, 17, 21, 25, and 29 (time slots 0, 4, 8, 12, 16, 20, 24, and 28) will be ignored. The user can supply frame or multiframe sync pulse to the TSSYNC input. Also, in 2.048MHz applications, the TCHBLK output will be forced high during the channels ignored by the framer. 20.2.2 E1 Mode A 1.544MHz or 2.048MHz clock can be applied to the TSYSCLK input. The user must supply a framesync pulse or a multiframe-sync pulse to the TSSYNC input. 20.3 Elastic Stores Initialization There are two elastic-store initializations that can be used to improve performance in certain applications: elastic store reset and elastic store align. Both of these involve the manipulation of the elastic store’s read and write pointers and are useful primarily in synchronous applications (RSYSCLK/TSYSCLK are locked to RCLK/TCLK, respectively). See Table 20-1 for details. Table 20-1. ELASTIC STORE DELAY AFTER INITIALIZATION INITIALIZATION Receive Elastic Store Reset Transmit Elastic Store Reset Receive Elastic Store Align Transmit Elastic Store Align REGISTER BIT ESCR.2 ESCR.6 ESCR.3 ESCR.7 DELAY 8 Clocks < Delay < 1 Frame 1 Frame < Delay < 2 Frames ½ Frame < Delay < 1 ½ Frames ½ Frame < Delay < 1 ½ Frames 120 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 20.4 Minimum-Delay Mode When minimum delay mode is enabled the elastic stores will be forced to a maximum depth of 32 bits instead of the normal two-frame depth. ESCR.5 and ESCR.1 enable the transmit and receive elastic store minimum-delay modes. This feature is useful primarily in applications that interface T1 to a 2.048MHz bus without adding the latency that would be associated with using the elastic store in full buffer mode. Certain restrictions apply when minimum delay mode is used. Minimum-delay mode can only be used when the elastic store’s system clock is locked to its network clock (e.g., RCLK locked to RSYSCLK for the receive side and TCLK locked to TSYSCLK for the transmit side). RSYNC must be configured as an output. In E1 operation TSYNC must be configured as an input when transmit minimum delay mode is enabled. In T1 operation TSYNC can be configured as an input or output when transmit minimum delay mode is enabled. In a typical application RSYSCLK and TSYSCLK are locked to RCLK, and RSYNC (frame output mode) is connected to TSSYNC (frame input mode). All of the slip contention logic in the framer is disabled (since slips cannot occur). On power-up, after the RSYSCLK and TSYSCLK signals have locked to their respective network clock signals, the elastic store reset bits (ESCR.2 and ESCR.6) should be toggled from a zero to a one to ensure proper operation. 121 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 21. G.706 INTERMEDIATE CRC-4 UPDATING (E1 MODE ONLY) The DS21455/DS21458 can implement the G.706 CRC-4 recalculation at intermediate path points. When this mode is enabled, the data stream presented at TSER will already have the FAS/NFAS, CRC multiframe alignment word, and CRC-4 checksum in time slot 0. The user can modify the Sa bit positions; this change in data content will be used to modify the CRC-4 checksum. The modification, however, will not corrupt any error information the original CRC-4 checksum might contain. In this mode of operation, TSYNC must be configured to multiframe mode. The data at TSER must be aligned to the TSYNC signal. If TSYNC is an input then the user must assert TSYNC aligned at the beginning of the multiframe relative to TSER. If TSYNC is an output, the user must multiframe-align the data presented to TSER. Figure 21-1. CRC-4 Recalculate Method TPOSO/TNEGO INSERT NEW CRC-4 CODE EXTRACT OLD CRC-4 CODE TSER + CRC-4 CALCULATOR XOR MODIFY Sa BIT POSITIONS NEW Sa BIT DATA 122 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 22. T1 BIT ORIENTED CODE (BOC) CONTROLLER The DS21455/DS21458 contain a BOC generator on the transmit side and a BOC detector on the receive side. The BOC function is available only in T1 mode. 22.1 Transmit BOC Bits 0 through 5 in the TFDL register contain the BOC message to be transmitted. Setting BOCC.0 = 1 causes the transmit BOC controller to immediately begin inserting the BOC sequence into the FDL bit position. The transmit BOC controller automatically provides the abort sequence. BOC messages will be transmitted as long as BOCC.0 is set. To transmit a BOC, use the following: 1) Write 6-bit code into the TFDL register. 2) Set SBOC bit in BOCC register = 1. 22.2 Receive BOC The receive BOC function is enabled by setting BOCC.4 = 1. The RFDL register will now operate as the receive BOC message and information register. The lower six bits of the RFDL register (BOC message bits) are preset to all ones. When the BOC bits change state, the BOC change of state indicator, SR8.0 will alert the host. The host will then read the RFDL register to get the BOC message. A change of state will occur when either a new BOC code has been present for time determined by the receive BOC filter bits, RBF0 and RBF1, in the BOCC register. To receive a BOC, use the following: 1) 2) 3) 4) 5) 6) Set integration time via BOCC.1 and BOCC.2. Enable the receive BOC function (BOCC.4 = 1). Enable interrupt (IMR8.0 = 1). Wait for interrupt to occur. Read the RFDL register. The lower six bits of the RFDL register is the message. 123 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: BOCC BOC Control Register 37h Bit # Name Default 6 — 0 7 — 0 5 — 0 4 RBOCE 0 3 RBR 0 2 RBF1 0 1 RBF0 0 0 SBOC 0 Bit 0/Send BOC (SBOC). Set = 1 to transmit the BOC code placed in bits 0 to 5 of the TFDL register. Bits 1 to 2/Receive BOC Filter Bits (RBF0, RBF1). The BOC filter sets the number of consecutive patterns that must be received without error prior to an indication of a valid message. RBF1 RBF0 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 CONSECUTIVE BOC CODES FOR VALID SEQUENCE IDENTIFICATION None 3 5 7 Bit 3/Receive BOC Reset (RBR). A 0 to 1 transition will reset the BOC circuitry. Must be cleared and set again for a subsequent reset. Bit 4/Receive BOC Enable (RBOCE). Enables the receive BOC function. The RFDL register will report the received BOC code. 0 = receive BOC function disabled 1 = receive BOC function enabled. The RFDL register will report BOC messages Bit 5/Unused, must be set to zero for proper operation. Bit 6/Unused, must be set to zero for proper operation. Bit 7/Unused, must be set to zero for proper operation. 124 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: RFDL (RFDL register bit usage when BOCC.4 = 1) Receive FDL Register C0h Bit # Name Default 6 — 0 7 — 0 5 RBOC5 0 4 RBOC4 0 3 RBOC3 0 2 RBOC2 0 1 RBOC1 0 0 RBOC0 0 3 RFDLF 0 2 TFDLE 0 1 RMTCH 0 0 RBOC 0 Bit 0/BOC Bit 0 (RBOC0). Bit 1/BOC Bit 1 (RBOC1). Bit 2/BOC Bit 2 (RBOC2). Bit 3/BOC Bit 3 (RBOC3). Bit 4/BOC Bit 4 (RBOC4). Bit 5/BOC Bit 5 (RBOC5). Bit 6/This bit position is unused when BOCC.4 = 1. Bit 7/This bit position is unused when BOCC.4 = 1. Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: SR8 Status Register 8 24h Bit # Name Default 6 — 0 7 — 0 5 BOCC 0 4 RFDLAD 0 Bit 0/Receive BOC Detector Change of State Event (RBOC). Set whenever the BOC detector sees a change of state to a valid BOC. The setting of this bit prompts the user to read the RFDL register. Bit 1/Receive FDL Match Event (RMTCH). Set whenever the contents of the RFDL register matches RFDLM1 or RFDLM2. Bit 2/TFDL Register Empty Event(TFDLE). Set when the transmit FDL buffer (TFDL) empties. Bit 3/RFDL Register Full Event (RFDLF). Set when the receive FDL buffer (RFDL) fills to capacity. Bit 4/RFDL Abort Detect Event (RFDLAD). Set when eight consecutive ones are received on the FDL. Bit 5/BOC Clear Event (BOCC). Set when 30 FDL bits occur without an abort sequence. 125 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: IMR8 Interrupt Mask Register 8 25h Bit # Name Default 6 — 0 7 — 0 5 BOCC 0 4 RFDLAD 0 3 RFDLF 0 Bit 0/Receive BOC Detector Change of State Event (RBOC). 0 = interrupt masked 1 = interrupt enabled Bit 1/Receive FDL Match Event (RMTCH). 0 = interrupt masked 1 = interrupt enabled Bit 2/TFDL Register Empty Event (TFDLE). 0 = interrupt masked 1 = interrupt enabled Bit 3/RFDL Register Full Event (RFDLF). 0 = interrupt masked 1 = interrupt enabled Bit 4/RFDL Abort Detect Event (RFDLAD). 0 = interrupt masked 1 = interrupt enabled Bit 5/BOC Clear Event (BOCC). 0 = interrupt masked 1 = interrupt enabled 126 of 270 2 TFDLE 0 1 RMTCH 0 0 RBOC 0 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 23. ADDITIONAL (Sa) AND INTERNATIONAL (Si) BIT OPERATION (E1 ONLY) The DS21455/DS21458, when operated in the E1 mode, provide for access to both the Sa and the Si bits via three different methods. The first method is via a hardware scheme using the RLINK/RLCLK and TLINK/TLCLK pins. The second method involves using the internal RAF/RNAF and TAF/TNAF registers. The third method involves an expanded version of the second method. 23.1 Hardware Scheme (Method 1) On the receive side, all of the received data is reported at the RLINK pin. Using the E1RCR2 register the user can control the RLCLK pin to pulse during any combination of Sa bits. This allows the user to create a clock that can be used to capture the needed Sa bits. If RSYNC is programmed to output a frame boundary, it will identify the Si bits. On the transmit side, the individual Sa bits can be either sourced from the internal TNAF register or externally from the TLINK pin. Using the E1TCR2 register the framer can be programmed to source any combination of the Sa bits from the TLINK pin. Si bits can be sampled through the TSER pin if by setting E1TCR1.4 = 0. 23.2 Internal Register Scheme Based On Double-Frame (Method 2) On the receive side, the RAF and RNAF registers will always report the data as it received in the Sa and Si bit locations. The RAF and RNAF registers are updated on align frame boundaries. The setting of the receive align frame bit in status register 4 (SR4.0) will indicate that the contents of the RAF and RNAF have been updated. The host can use the SR4.0 bit to know when to read the RAF and RNAF registers. The host has 250ms to retrieve the data before it is lost. On the transmit side, data is sampled from the TAF and TNAF registers with the setting of the transmit align frame bit in status register 4 (SR4.3). The host can use the SR4.3 bit to know when to update the TAF and TNAF registers. It has 250ms to update the data or else the old data will be retransmitted. If the TAF an TNAF registers are only being used to source the align frame and nonalign frame-sync patterns, then the host need only write once to these registers. Data in the Si bit position will be overwritten if the framer is programmed: (1) to source the Si bits from the TSER pin, (2) in the CRC-4 mode, or (3) with automatic E-bit insertion enabled. Data in the Sa bit position will be overwritten if any of the E1TCR2.3 to E1TCR2.7 bits are set to one. 127 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: RAF Receive Align Frame Register C6h Bit # Name Default 6 0 0 7 Si 0 5 0 0 4 1 0 3 1 0 2 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 0 3 Sa5 0 2 Sa6 0 1 Sa7 0 0 Sa8 0 Bit 0/Frame Alignment Signal Bit (1). Bit 1/Frame Alignment Signal Bit (1). Bit 2/Frame Alignment Signal Bit (0). Bit 3/Frame Alignment Signal Bit (1). Bit 4/Frame Alignment Signal Bit (1). Bit 5/Frame Alignment Signal Bit (0). Bit 6/Frame Alignment Signal Bit (0). Bit 7/International Bit (Si). Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: RNAF Receive Nonalign Frame Register C7h Bit # Name Default 6 1 0 7 Si 0 5 A 0 4 Sa4 0 Bit 0/Additional Bit 8 (Sa8). Bit 1/Additional Bit 7 (Sa7). Bit 2/Additional Bit 6 (Sa6). Bit 3/Additional Bit 5 (Sa5). Bit 4/Additional Bit 4 (Sa4). Bit 5 / Remote Alarm (A). Bit 6/Frame Nonalignment Signal Bit (1). Bit 7/International Bit (Si). 128 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: TAF Transmit Align Frame Register D0h Bit # Name Default 6 0 0 7 Si 0 5 0 0 4 1 1 3 1 1 2 0 0 1 1 1 0 1 1 2 Sa6 0 1 Sa7 0 0 Sa8 0 Bit 0/Frame Alignment Signal Bit (1). Bit 1/Frame Alignment Signal Bit (1). Bit 2/Frame Alignment Signal Bit (0). Bit 3/Frame Alignment Signal Bit (1). Bit 4/Frame Alignment Signal Bit (1). Bit 5/Frame Alignment Signal Bit (0). Bit 6/Frame Alignment Signal Bit (0). Bit 7/International Bit (Si). Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: TNAF Transmit Nonalign Frame Register D1h Bit # Name Default 6 1 1 7 Si 0 5 A 0 4 Sa4 0 3 Sa5 0 Bit 0/Additional Bit 8 (Sa8). Bit 1/Additional Bit 7 (Sa7). Bit 2/Additional Bit 6 (Sa6). Bit 3/Additional Bit 5 (Sa5). Bit 4/Additional Bit 4 (Sa4). Bit 5/Remote Alarm (used to transmit the alarm A). Bit 6/Frame Nonalignment Signal Bit (1). Bit 7/International Bit (Si). 129 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 23.3 Internal Register Scheme Based On CRC-4 Multiframe (Method 3) On the receive side, there is a set of eight registers (RSiAF, RSiNAF, RRA, RSa4 to RSa8) that report the Si and Sa bits as they are received. These registers are updated with the setting of the receive CRC-4 multiframe bit in status register 2 (SR4.1). The host can use the SR4.1 bit to know when to read these registers. The user has 2ms to retrieve the data before it is lost. The MSB of each register is the first received. Please see the following register descriptions for more details. On the transmit side, there is also a set of eight registers (TSiAF, TSiNAF, TRA, TSa4 to TSa8) that via the transmit Sa bit control register (TSaCR), can be programmed to insert both Si and Sa data. Data is sampled from these registers with the setting of the transmit multiframe bit in status register 2 (SR4.4). The host can use the SR4.4 bit to know when to update these registers. It has 2ms to update the data or else the old data will be retransmitted. The MSB of each register is the first bit transmitted. See the following register descriptions for details. Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 SiF0 0 RSiAF Receive Si Bits of the Align Frame C8h 6 SiF2 0 5 SiF4 0 4 SiF6 0 3 SiF8 0 Bit 0/Si Bit of Frame 14(SiF14). Bit 1/Si Bit of Frame 12(SiF12). Bit 2/Si Bit of Frame 10(SiF10). Bit 3/Si Bit of Frame 8(SiF8). Bit 4/Si Bit of Frame 6(SiF6). Bit 5/Si Bit of Frame 4(SiF4). Bit 6/Si Bit of Frame 2(SiF2). Bit 7/Si Bit of Frame 0(SiF0). 130 of 270 2 SiF10 0 1 SiF12 0 0 SiF14 0 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 SiF1 0 RSiNAF Receive Si Bits of the Nonalign Frame C9h 6 SiF3 0 5 SiF5 0 4 SiF7 0 3 SiF9 0 2 SiF11 0 1 SiF13 0 0 SiF15 0 3 RRAF9 0 2 RRAF11 0 1 RRAF13 0 0 RRAF15 0 Bit 0/Si Bit of Frame 15(SiF15). Bit 1/Si Bit of Frame 13(SiF13). Bit 2/Si Bit of Frame 11(SiF11). Bit 3/Si Bit of Frame 9(SiF9). Bit 4/Si Bit of Frame 7(SiF7). Bit 5/Si Bit of Frame 5(SiF5). Bit 6/Si Bit of Frame 3(SiF3). Bit 7/Si Bit of Frame 1(SiF1). Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 RRAF1 0 RRA Receive Remote Alarm CAh 6 RRAF3 0 5 RRAF5 0 4 RRAF7 0 Bit 0/Remote Alarm Bit of Frame 15(RRAF15). Bit 1/Remote Alarm Bit of Frame 13(RRAF13). Bit 2/Remote Alarm Bit of Frame 11(RRAF11). Bit 3/Remote Alarm Bit of Frame 9(RRAF9). Bit 4/Remote Alarm Bit of Frame 7(RRAF7). Bit 5/Remote Alarm Bit of Frame 5(RRAF5). Bit 6/Remote Alarm Bit of Frame 3(RRAF3). Bit 7/Remote Alarm Bit of Frame 1(RRAF1). 131 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 RSa4F1 0 RSa4 Receive Sa4 Bits CBh 6 RSa4F3 0 5 RSa4F5 0 4 RSa4F7 0 3 RSa4F9 0 2 RSa4F11 0 1 RSa4F13 0 0 RSa4F15 0 4 RSa5F7 0 3 RSa5F9 0 2 RSa5F11 0 1 RSa5F13 0 0 RSa5F15 0 Bit 0/Sa4 Bit of Frame 15(RSa4F15). Bit 1/Sa4 Bit of Frame 13(RSa4F13). Bit 2/Sa4 Bit of Frame 11(RSa4F11). Bit 3/Sa4 Bit of Frame 9(RSa4F9). Bit 4/Sa4 Bit of Frame 7(RSa4F7). Bit 5/Sa4 Bit of Frame 5(RSa4F5). Bit 6/Sa4 Bit of Frame 3(RSa4F3). Bit 7/Sa4 Bit of Frame 1(RSa4F1). Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 RSa5F1 0 RSa5 Receive Sa5 Bits CCh 6 RSa5F3 0 5 RSa5F5 0 Bit 0/Sa5 Bit of Frame 15(RSa5F15). Bit 1/Sa5 Bit of Frame 13(RSa5F13). Bit 2/Sa5 Bit of Frame 11(RSa5F11). Bit 3/Sa5 Bit of Frame 9(RSa5F9). Bit 4/Sa5 Bit of Frame 7(RSa5F7). Bit 5/Sa5 Bit of Frame 5(RSa5F5). Bit 6/Sa5 Bit of Frame 3(RSa5F3). Bit 7/Sa5 Bit of Frame 1(RSa5F1). 132 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 RSa6F1 0 RSa6 Receive Sa6 Bits CDh 6 RSa6F3 0 5 RSa6F5 0 4 RSa6F7 0 3 RSa6F9 0 2 RSa6F11 0 1 RSa6F13 0 0 RSa6F15 0 4 RSa7F7 0 3 RSa7F9 0 2 RSa7F11 0 1 RSa7F13 0 0 RSa7F15 0 Bit 0/Sa6 Bit of Frame 15(RSa6F15). Bit 1/Sa6 Bit of Frame 13(RSa6F13). Bit 2/Sa6 Bit of Frame 11(RSa6F11). Bit 3/Sa6 Bit of Frame 9(RSa6F9). Bit 4/Sa6 Bit of Frame 7(RSa6F7). Bit 5/Sa6 Bit of Frame 5(RSa6F5). Bit 6/Sa6 Bit of Frame 3(RSa6F3). Bit 7/Sa6 Bit of Frame 1(RSa6F1). Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 RSa7F1 0 RSa7 Receive Sa7 Bits CEh 6 RSa7F3 0 5 RSa7F5 0 Bit 0/Sa7 Bit of Frame 15(RSa7F15). Bit 1/Sa7 Bit of Frame 13(RSa7F13). Bit 2/Sa7 Bit of Frame 11(RSa7F11). Bit 3/Sa7 Bit of Frame 9(RSa7F9). Bit 4/Sa7 Bit of Frame 7(RSa7F7). Bit 5/Sa7 Bit of Frame 5(RSa7F5). Bit 6/Sa7 Bit of Frame 3(RSa7F3). Bit 7/Sa7 Bit of Frame 1(RSa4F1). 133 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 RSa8F1 0 RSa8 Receive Sa8 Bits CFh 6 RSa8F3 0 5 RSa8F5 0 4 RSa8F7 0 3 RSa8F9 0 Bit 0/Sa8 Bit of Frame 15(RSa8F15). Bit 1/Sa8 Bit of Frame 13(RSa8F13). Bit 2/Sa8 Bit of Frame 11(RSa8F11). Bit 3/Sa8 Bit of Frame 9(RSa8F9). Bit 4/Sa8 Bit of Frame 7(RSa8F7). Bit 5/Sa8 Bit of Frame 5(RSa8F5). Bit 6/Sa8 Bit of Frame 3(RSa8F3). Bit 7/Sa8 Bit of Frame 1(RSa8F1). 134 of 270 2 RSa8F11 0 1 RSa8F13 0 0 RSa8F15 0 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 TsiF0 0 TSiAF Transmit Si Bits of the Align Frame D2h 6 TsiF2 0 5 TsiF4 0 4 TsiF6 0 3 TsiF8 0 Bit 0/Si Bit of Frame 14(TsiF14). Bit 1/Si Bit of Frame 12(TsiF12). Bit 2/Si Bit of Frame 10(TsiF10). Bit 3/Si Bit of Frame 8(TsiF8). Bit 4/Si Bit of Frame 6(TsiF6). Bit 5/Si Bit of Frame 4(TsiF4). Bit 6/Si Bit of Frame 2(TsiF2). Bit 7/Si Bit of Frame 0(TsiF0). 135 of 270 2 TsiF10 0 1 TsiF12 0 0 TsiF14 0 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 TsiF1 0 TSiNAF Transmit Si Bits of the Nonalign Frame D3h 6 TsiF3 0 5 TsiF5 0 4 TsiF7 0 3 TsiF9 0 2 TsiF11 0 1 TsiF13 0 0 TSiF15 0 3 TRAF9 0 2 TRAF11 0 1 TRAF13 0 0 TRAF15 0 Bit 0/Si Bit of Frame 15(TSiF15). Bit 1/Si Bit of Frame 13(TsiF13). Bit 2/Si Bit of Frame 11(TsiF11). Bit 3/Si Bit of Frame 9(TsiF9). Bit 4/Si Bit of Frame 7(TsiF7). Bit 5/Si Bit of Frame 5(TsiF5). Bit 6/Si Bit of Frame 3(TsiF3). Bit 7/Si Bit of Frame 1(TsiF1). Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 TRAF1 0 TRA Transmit Remote Alarm D4h 6 TRAF3 0 5 TRAF5 0 4 TRAF7 0 Bit 0/Remote Alarm Bit of Frame 15(TRAF15). Bit 1/Remote Alarm Bit of Frame 13(TRAF13). Bit 2/Remote Alarm Bit of Frame 11(TRAF11). Bit 3/Remote Alarm Bit of Frame 9(TRAF9). Bit 4/Remote Alarm Bit of Frame 7(TRAF7). Bit 5/Remote Alarm Bit of Frame 5(TRAF5). Bit 6/Remote Alarm Bit of Frame 3(TRAF3). Bit 7/Remote Alarm Bit of Frame 1(TRAF1). 136 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 TSa4F1 0 TSa4 Transmit Sa4 Bits D5h 6 TSa4F3 0 5 TSa4F5 0 4 TSa4F7 0 3 TSa4F9 0 2 TSa4F11 0 1 TSa4F13 0 0 TSa4F15 0 4 TSa5F7 0 3 TSa5F9 0 2 TSa5F11 0 1 TSa5F13 0 0 TSa5F15 0 Bit 0/Sa4 Bit of Frame 15(TSa4F15). Bit 1/Sa4 Bit of Frame 13(TSa4F13). Bit 2/Sa4 Bit of Frame 11(TSa4F11). Bit 3/Sa4 Bit of Frame 9(TSa4F9). Bit 4/Sa4 Bit of Frame 7(TSa4F7). Bit 5/Sa4 Bit of Frame 5(TSa4F5). Bit 6/Sa4 Bit of Frame 3(TSa4F3). Bit 7/Sa4 Bit of Frame 1(TSa4F1). Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 TSa5F1 0 TSa5 Transmit Sa5 Bits D6h 6 TSa5F3 0 5 TSa5F5 0 Bit 0/Sa5 Bit of Frame 15(TSa5F15). Bit 1/Sa5 Bit of Frame 13(TSa5F13). Bit 2/Sa5 Bit of Frame 11(TSa5F11). Bit 3/Sa5 Bit of Frame 9(TSa5F9). Bit 4/Sa5 Bit of Frame 7(TSa5F7). Bit 5/Sa5 Bit of Frame 5(TSa5F5). Bit 6/Sa5 Bit of Frame 3(TSa5F3). Bit 7/Sa5 Bit of Frame 1(TSa5F1). 137 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 TSa6F1 0 TSa6 Transmit Sa6 Bits D7h 6 TSa6F3 0 5 TSa6F5 0 4 TSa6F7 0 3 TSa6F9 0 2 TSa6F11 0 1 TSa6F13 0 0 TSa6F15 0 4 TSa7F7 0 3 TSa7F9 0 2 TSa7F11 0 1 TSa7F13 0 0 TSa7F15 0 Bit 0/Sa6 Bit of Frame 15(TSa6F15). Bit 1/Sa6 Bit of Frame 13(TSa6F13). Bit 2/Sa6 Bit of Frame 11(TSa6F11). Bit 3/Sa6 Bit of Frame 9(TSa6F9). Bit 4/Sa6 Bit of Frame 7(TSa6F7). Bit 5/Sa6 Bit of Frame 5(TSa6F5). Bit 6/Sa6 Bit of Frame 3(TSa6F3). Bit 7/Sa6 Bit of Frame 1(TSa6F1). Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 TSa7F1 0 TSa7 Transmit Sa7 Bits D8h 6 TSa7F3 0 5 TSa7F5 0 Bit 0/Sa7 Bit of Frame 15(TSa7F15). Bit 1/Sa7 Bit of Frame 13(TSa7F13). Bit 2/Sa7 Bit of Frame 11(TSa7F11). Bit 3/Sa7 Bit of Frame 9(TSa7F9). Bit 4/Sa7 Bit of Frame 7(TSa7F7). Bit 5/Sa7 Bit of Frame 5(TSa7F5). Bit 6/Sa7 Bit of Frame 3(TSa7F3). Bit 7/Sa7 Bit of Frame 1(TSa4F1). 138 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 TSa8F1 0 TSa8 Transmit Sa8 Bits D9h 6 TSa8F3 0 5 TSa8F5 0 4 TSa8F7 0 3 TSa8F9 0 Bit 0/Sa8 Bit of Frame 15(TSa8F15). Bit 1/Sa8 Bit of Frame 13(TSa8F13). Bit 2/Sa8 Bit of Frame 11(TSa8F11). Bit 3/Sa8 Bit of Frame 9(TSa8F9). Bit 4/Sa8 Bit of Frame 7(TSa8F7). Bit 5/Sa8 Bit of Frame 5(TSa8F5). Bit 6/Sa8 Bit of Frame 3(TSa8F3). Bit 7/Sa8 Bit of Frame 1(TSa8F1). 139 of 270 2 TSa8F11 0 1 TSa8F13 0 0 TSa8F15 0 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 SiAF 0 TSACR Transmit Sa Bit Control Register DAh 6 SiNAF 0 5 RA 0 4 Sa4 0 3 Sa5 0 2 Sa6 0 Bit 0/Additional Bit 8 Insertion Control Bit (Sa8). 0 = do not insert data from the TSa8 register into the transmit data stream 1 = insert data from the TSa8 register into the transmit data stream Bit 1/Additional Bit 7 Insertion Control Bit (Sa7). 0 = do not insert data from the TSa7 register into the transmit data stream 1 = insert data from the TSa7 register into the transmit data stream Bit 2/Additional Bit 6 Insertion Control Bit (Sa6). 0 = do not insert data from the TSa6 register into the transmit data stream 1 = insert data from the TSa6 register into the transmit data stream Bit 3/Additional Bit 5 Insertion Control Bit (Sa5). 0 = do not insert data from the TSa5 register into the transmit data stream 1 = insert data from the TSa5 register into the transmit data stream Bit 4/Additional Bit 4 Insertion Control Bit (Sa4). 0 = do not insert data from the TSa4 register into the transmit data stream 1 = insert data from the TSa4 register into the transmit data stream Bit 5/Remote Alarm Insertion Control Bit (RA). 0 = do not insert data from the TRA register into the transmit data stream 1 = insert data from the TRA register into the transmit data stream Bit 6/International Bit in Nonalign Frame Insertion Control Bit (SiNAF). 0 = do not insert data from the TSiNAF register into the transmit data stream 1 = insert data from the TSiNAF register into the transmit data stream Bit 7/International Bit in Align Frame Insertion Control Bit (SiAF). 0 = do not insert data from the TSiAF register into the transmit data stream 1 = insert data from the TSiAF register into the transmit data stream 140 of 270 1 Sa7 0 0 Sa8 0 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 24. HDLC CONTROLLERS This device has two enhanced HDLC controllers, HDLC #1 and HDLC #2. Each controller is configurable for use with time slots, or Sa4 to Sa8 bits (E1 Mode) or the FDL (T1 Mode). Each HDLC controller has 128 byte buffers in both the transmit and receive paths. When used with time slots, the user can select any time slot or multiple time slots, contiguous or noncontiguous, as well as any specific bits within the time slot(s) to assign to the HDLC controllers. HxRC.3 (HDLCD) is used to disable the HDLC controllers. Disabling the HDLC controllers when unused will reduce the power consumption by the device. Although this bit is in the receive HDLC control register, it disables both the transmit and receive function. The user must take care to not map both transmit HDLC controllers to the same Sa bits, time slots or, in T1 mode, map both controllers to the FDL. HDLC #1 and HDLC #2 are identical in operation and therefore the following operational description refers only to a singular controller. The HDLC controller performs all the necessary overhead for generating and receiving Performance Report Messages (PRM) as described in ANSI T1.403 and the messages as described in AT&T TR54016. The HDLC controller automatically generates and detects flags, generates and checks the CRC check sum, generates and detects abort sequences, stuffs and de-stuffs zeros, and byte aligns to the data stream. The 128-byte buffers in the HDLC controller are large enough to allow a full PRM to be received or transmitted without host intervention. 24.1 Basic Operation Details To allow the framer to properly source/receive data from/to the HDLC controllers, the legacy FDL circuitry (See the Legacy FDL Support (T1 Mode) section.) should be disabled. The HDLC registers are divided into four groups: control/configuration, status/information, mapping, and FIFOs. Table 24-1 lists these registers by group. 141 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Table 24-1. HDLC CONTROLLER REGISTERS NAME FUNCTION CONTROL/CONFIGURATION H1TC, HDLC #1 Transmit Control Register H2TC, HDLC #2 Transmit Control Register H1RC, HDLC #1 Receive Control Register H2RC, HDLC #2 Receive Control Register H1FC, HDLC #1 FIFO Control Register H2FC, HDLC #2 FIFO Control Register General control over the transmit HDLC controllers General control over the receive HDLC controllers Sets high watermark for receiver and low watermark for transmitter STATUS/INFORMATION SR6, HDLC #1 Status Register SR7, HDLC #2 Status Register IMR6, HDLC #1 Interrupt Mask Register IMR7, HDLC #2 Interrupt Mask Register INFO4, HDLC #1 & #2 Information Register INFO5, HDLC #1 Information Register INFO6, HDLC #2 Information Register H1RPBA, HDLC #1 Receive Packet Bytes Available Register H2RPBA, HDLC #2 Receive Packet Bytes Available Register H1TFBA, HDLC #1 Transmit FIFO Buffer Available Register H2TFBA, HDLC #2 Transmit FIFO Buffer Available Register Key status information for both transmit and receive directions Selects which bits in Status Registers (SR7 and SR8) will cause interrupts Information on HDLC controller Indicates the number of bytes that can be read from the receive FIFO Indicates the number of bytes that can be written to the transmit FIFO MAPPING H1RCS1, H1RCS2, H1RCS3, H1RCS4, HDLC #1 Receive Channel Select Registers H2RCS1, H2RCS2, H2RCS3, H2RCS4, HDLC #2 Receive Channel Select Registers H1RTSBS, HDLC #1 Receive TS/Sa Bit Select Register H2RTSBS, HDLC #2 Receive TS/Sa Bit Select Register H1TCS1, H1TCS2, H1TCS3, H1TCS4, HDLC #1 Transmit Channel Select Registers H2TCS1, H2TCS2, H2TCS3, H2TCS4, HDLC #2 Transmit Channel Select Registers H1TTSBS, HDLC # 1 Transmit TS/Sa Bit Select Register H2TTSBS, HDLC # 2 Transmit TS/Sa Bit Select Register Selects which channels will be mapped to the receive HDLC controller Selects which bits in a channel will be used or which Sa bits will be used by the receive HDLC controller Selects which channels will be mapped to the transmit HDLC controller Selects which bits in a channel will be used or which Sa bits will be used by the transmit HDLC controller FIFOs H1RF, HDLC #1 Receive FIFO Register H2RF, HDLC #2 Receive FIFO Register H1TF, HDLC #1 Transmit FIFO Register H2TF, HDLC #2 Transmit FIFO Register Access to 128-byte receive FIFO Access to 128-byte transmit FIFO 142 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 24.2 HDLC Configuration Basic configuration of the HDLC controllers is accomplished via the HxTC and HxRC registers. Operating features such as CRC generation, zero stuffer, transmit and receive HDLC mapping options, and idle flags are selected here. Also, the HDLC controllers are reset via these registers. Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 NOFS 0 H1TC, H2TC HDLC #1 Transmit Control, HDLC #2 Transmit Control 90h, A0h 6 TEOML 0 5 THR 0 4 THMS 0 3 TFS 0 2 TEOM 0 1 TZSD 0 0 TCRCD 0 Bit 0/Transmit CRC Defeat (TCRCD). A 2-byte CRC code is automatically appended to the outbound message. This bit can be used to disable the CRC function. 0 = enable CRC generation (normal operation) 1 = disable CRC generation Bit 1/Transmit Zero Stuffer Defeat (TZSD). The zero stuffer function automatically inserts a zero in the message field (between the flags) after five consecutive ones to prevent the emulation of a flag or abort sequence by the data pattern. The receiver automatically removes (de-stuffs) any zero after five ones in the message field. 0 = enable the zero stuffer (normal operation) 1 = disable the zero stuffer Bit 2/Transmit End of Message (TEOM). Should be set to a one just before the last data byte of an HDLC packet is written into the transmit FIFO at HxTF. If not disabled via TCRCD, the transmitter will automatically append a 2-byte CRC code to the end of the message. Bit 3/Transmit Flag/Idle Select (TFS). This bit selects the inter-message fill character after the closing and before the opening flags (7Eh). 0 = 7Eh 1 = FFh Bit 4/Transmit HDLC Mapping Select (THMS). 0 = transmit HDLC assigned to channels 1 = transmit HDLC assigned to FDL (T1 mode), Sa Bits (E1 mode) Bit 5/Transmit HDLC Reset (THR). Will reset the transmit HDLC controller and flush the transmit FIFO. An abort followed by 7Eh or FFh flags/idle will be transmitted until a new packet is initiated by writing new data into the FIFO. Must be cleared and set again for a subsequent reset. 0 = normal operation 1 = reset transmit HDLC controller and flush the transmit FIFO Bit 6/Transmit End of Message and Loop (TEOML). To loop on a message, should be set to a one just before the last data byte of an HDLC packet is written into the transmit FIFO. The message will repeat until the user clears this bit or a new message is written to the transmit FIFO. If the host clears the bit, the looping message will complete then flags will be transmitted until new message is written to the FIFO. If the host terminates the loop by writing a new message to the FIFO the loop will terminate, one or two flags will be transmitted and the new message will start. If not disabled via TCRCD, the transmitter will automatically append a 2-byte CRC code to the end of all messages. This is useful for transmitting consecutive SS7 FISUs without host intervention. Bit 7/Number Of Flags Select (NOFS). 0 = send one flag between consecutive messages 1 = send two flags between consecutive messages 143 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 RHR 0 H1RC, H2RC HDLC #1 Receive Control, HDLC #2 Receive Control 31h, 32h 6 RHMS 0 5 — 0 4 — 0 3 HDLCD 0 2 — 0 1 — 0 0 RSFD 0 Bit 0/Receive SS7 Fill In Signal Unit Delete (RSFD). 0 = normal operation. All FISUs are stored in the receive FIFO and reported to the host. 1 = When a consecutive FISU having the same BSN the previous FISU is detected, it is deleted without host intervention. Bit 1/Unused, must be set to zero for proper operation. Bit 2/Unused, must be set to zero for proper operation. Bit 3/HDLC Disable. (HDLCD) Setting this bit will disable the transmit and receive HDLC function. 0 = transmit and receive HDLC enabled 1 = transmit and receive HDLC disabled Bit 4/Unused, must be set to zero for proper operation. Bit 5/Unused, must be set to zero for proper operation. Bit 6/Receive HDLC Mapping Select (RHMS). 0 = receive HDLC assigned to channels 1 = receive HDLC assigned to FDL (T1 mode), Sa Bits (E1 mode) Bit 7/Receive HDLC Reset (RHR). Will reset the receive HDLC controller and flush the receive FIFO. Must be cleared and set again for a subsequent reset. 0 = normal operation 1 = reset receive HDLC controller and flush the receive FIFO 144 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 24.2.1 FIFO Control Control of the transmit and receive FIFOs is accomplished via the FIFO control (HxFC). The FIFO control register sets the watermarks for both the transmit and receive FIFO. Bits 3–5 set the transmit low watermark and the lower 3 bits set the receive high watermark. When the transmit FIFO empties below the low watermark, the TLWM bit in the appropriate HDLC status register SR6 or SR7 will be set. TLWM is a real-time bit and will remain set as long as the transmit FIFO’s read pointer is below the watermark. If enabled, this condition can also cause an interrupt via the INT pin. When the receive FIFO fills above the high watermark, the RHWM bit in the appropriate HDLC status register will be set. RHWM is a real-time bit and will remain set as long as the receive FIFO’s write pointer is above the watermark. If enabled, this condition can also cause an interrupt via the INT pin. Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: H1FC, H2FC HDLC # 1 FIFO Control, HDLC # 2 FIFO Control 91h, A1h Bit # Name Default 6 — 0 7 — 0 5 TFLWM2 0 4 TFLWM1 0 3 TFLWM0 0 2 RFHWM2 0 1 RFHWM1 0 Bits 0 to 2/Receive FIFO High Watermark Select (RFHWM0 to RFHWM2). RFHWM2 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 RFHWM1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 RFHWM0 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 RECEIVE FIFO WATERMARK (BYTES) 4 16 32 48 64 80 96 112 Bits 3 to 5/Transmit FIFO Low Watermark Select (TFLWM0 to TFLWM2). TFLWM2 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 TFLWM1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 TFLWM0 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 TRANSMIT FIFO WATERMARK (BYTES) 4 16 32 48 64 80 96 112 Bit 6/Unused, must be set to zero for proper operation. Bit 7/Unused, must be set to zero for proper operation. 145 of 270 0 RFHWM0 0 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 24.3 HDLC Mapping 24.3.1 Receive The HDLC controllers need to be assigned a space in the T1/E1 bandwidth in which they will transmit and receive data. The controllers can be mapped to either the FDL (T1), Sa bits (E1), or to channels. If mapped to channels, then any channel or combination of channels, contiguous or not, can be assigned to an HDLC controller. When assigned to a channel(s) any combination of bits within the channel(s) can be avoided. The HxRCS1–HxRCS4 registers are used to assign the receive controllers to channels 1–24 (T1) or 1–32 (E1) according to the following table. REGISTER HxRCS1 HxRCS2 HxRCS3 HxRCS4 Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 RHCS7 0 CHANNELS 1–8 9–16 17–24 25–32 H1RCS1, H1RCS2, H1RCS3, H1RCS4 H2RCS1, H2RCS2, H2RCS3, H2RCS4 HDLC # 1 Receive Channel Select x HDLC # 2 Receive Channel Select x 92h, 93h, 94h, 95h A2h, A3h, A4h, A5h 6 RHCS6 0 5 RHCS5 0 4 RHCS4 0 3 RHCS3 0 2 RHCS2 0 1 RHCS1 0 Bit 0/Receive HDLC Channel Select Bit 0 (RHCS0). Select Channel 1, 9, 17, or 25. Bit 1/Receive HDLC Channel Select Bit 1 (RHCS1). Select Channel 2, 10, 18, or 26. Bit 2/Receive HDLC Channel Select Bit 2 (RHCS2). Select Channel 3, 11, 19, or 27. Bit 3/Receive HDLC Channel Select Bit 3 (RHCS3). Select Channel 4, 12, 20, or 28. Bit 4/Receive HDLC Channel Select Bit 4 (RHCS4). Select Channel 5, 13, 21, or 29. Bit 5/Receive HDLC Channel Select Bit 5 (RHCS5). Select Channel 6, 14, 22, or 30. Bit 6/Receive HDLC Channel Select Bit 6 (RHCS6). Select Channel 7, 15, 23, or 31. Bit 7/Receive HDLC Channel Select Bit 7 (RHCS7). Select Channel 8, 16, 24, or 32. 146 of 270 0 RHCS0 0 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 RCB8SE 0 H1RTSBS, H2RTSBS HDLC # 1 Receive Time Slot Bits/Sa Bits Select HDLC # 2 Receive Time Slot Bits/Sa Bits Select 96h, A6h 6 RCB7SE 0 5 RCB6SE 0 4 RCB5SE 0 3 RCB4SE 0 2 RCB3SE 0 1 RCB2SE 0 0 RCB1SE 0 Bit 0/Receive Channel Bit 1 Suppress Enable/Sa8 Bit Enable (RCB1SE ). LSB of the channel. Set to one to stop this bit from being used when the HDLC is mapped to time slots. Set to one to enable the use of Sa8 bit when HDLC mapped is Sa bits. Bit 1/Receive Channel Bit 2 Suppress Enable/Sa7 Bit Enable (RCB2SE). Set to one to stop this bit from being used when the HDLC is mapped to time slots. Set to one to enable the use of Sa8 bit when HDLC mapped is Sa bits. Bit 2/Receive Channel Bit 3 Suppress Enable/Sa6 Bit Enable (RCB3SE). Set to one to stop this bit from being used when the HDLC is mapped to time slots. Set to one to enable the use of Sa8 bit when HDLC mapped is Sa bits. Bit 3/Receive Channel Bit 4 Suppress Enable/Sa5 Bit Enable (RCB4SE). Set to one to stop this bit from being used when the HDLC is mapped to time slots. Set to one to enable the use of Sa8 bit when HDLC mapped is Sa bits. Bit 4/Receive Channel Bit 5 Suppress Enable/Sa4 Bit Enable (RCB5SE). Set to one to stop this bit from being used when the HDLC is mapped to time slots. Set to one to enable the use of Sa8 bit when HDLC mapped is Sa bits. Bit 5/Receive Channel Bit 6 Suppress Enable (RCB6SE). Set to one to stop this bit from being used. Bit 6/Receive Channel Bit 7 Suppress Enable (RCB7SE). Set to one to stop this bit from being used. Bit 7/Receive Channel Bit 8 Suppress Enable (RCB8SE). MSB of the channel. Set to one to stop this bit from being used. 147 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 24.3.2 Transmit The HxTCS1–HxTCS4 registers are used to assign the transmit controllers to channels 1–24 (T1) or 1–32 (E1), according to the following table. REGISTER HxTCS1 HxTCS2 HxTCS3 HxTCS4 Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 THCS7 0 CHANNELS 1–8 9–16 17–24 25–32 H1TCS1, H1TCS2, H1TCS3, H1TCS4 H2TCS1, H2TCS2, H2TCS3, H2TCS4 HDLC # 1 Transmit Channel Select HDLC # 2 Transmit Channel Select 97h, 98h, 99h, 9Ah A7h, A8h, A9h, AAh 6 THCS6 0 5 THCS5 0 4 THCS4 0 3 THCS3 0 2 THCS2 0 1 THCS1 0 Bit 0/Transmit HDLC Channel Select Bit 0 (THCS0). Select Channel 1, 9, 17, or 25. Bit 1/Transmit HDLC Channel Select Bit 1 (THCS1). Select Channel 2, 10, 18, or 26. Bit 2/Transmit HDLC Channel Select Bit 2 (THCS2). Select Channel 3, 11, 19, or 27. Bit 3/Transmit HDLC Channel Select Bit 3 (THCS3). Select Channel 4, 12, 20, or 28. Bit 4/Transmit HDLC Channel Select Bit 4 (THCS4). Select Channel 5, 13, 21, or 29. Bit 5/Transmit HDLC Channel Select Bit 5 (THCS5). Select Channel 6, 14, 22, or 30. Bit 6/Transmit HDLC Channel Select Bit 6 (THCS6). Select Channel 7, 15, 23, or 31. Bit 7/Transmit HDLC Channel Select Bit 7 (THCS7). Select Channel 8, 16, 24, or 32. 148 of 270 0 THCS0 0 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 TCB8SE 0 H1TTSBS, H2TTSBS HDLC # 1 Transmit Time Slot Bits/Sa Bits Select HDLC # 2 Transmit Time Slot Bits/Sa Bits Select 9Bh, Abh 6 TCB7SE 0 5 TCB6SE 0 4 TCB5SE 0 3 TCB4SE 0 2 TCB3SE 0 1 TCB2SE 0 0 TCB1SE 0 Bit 0/Transmit Channel Bit 1 Suppress Enable / Sa8 Bit Enable (TCB1SE). LSB of the channel. Set to one to stop this bit from being used. Bit 1/Transmit Channel Bit 2 Suppress Enable/ Sa7 Bit Enable (TCB1SE). Set to one to stop this bit from being used. Bit 2/Transmit Channel Bit 3 Suppress Enable/Sa6 Bit Enable (TCB1SE). Set to one to stop this bit from being used. Bit 3/Transmit Channel Bit 4 Suppress Enable/Sa5 Bit Enable (TCB1SE). Set to one to stop this bit from being used. Bit 4/Transmit Channel Bit 5 Suppress Enable/Sa4 Bit Enable (TCB1SE). Set to one to stop this bit from being used. Bit 5/Transmit Channel Bit 6 Suppress Enable (TCB1SE). Set to one to stop this bit from being used. Bit 6/Transmit Channel Bit 7 Suppress Enable (TCB1SE). Set to one to stop this bit from being used. Bit 7/Transmit Channel Bit 8 Suppress Enable (TCB1SE). MSB of the channel. Set to one to stop this bit from being used. 149 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 — 0 SR6, SR7 HDLC #1 Status Register 6 HDLC #2 Status Register 7 20h, 22h 6 TMEND 0 5 RPE 0 4 RPS 0 3 RHWM 0 2 RNE 0 1 TLWM 0 0 TNF 0 Bit 0/Transmit FIFO Not Full Condition (TNF). Set when the transmit 128-byte FIFO has at least one byte available. Bit 1/Transmit FIFO Below Low Watermark Condition (TLWM). Set when the transmit 128-byte FIFO empties beyond the low watermark as defined by the Transmit Low Watermark Register (TLWMR). Bit 2/Receive FIFO Not Empty Condition (RNE). Set when the receive 128-byte FIFO has at least one byte available for a read. Bit 3/Receive FIFO Above High Watermark Condition (RHWM). Set when the receive 128-byte FIFO fills beyond the high watermark as defined by the receive high-watermark register (RHWMR). Bit 4/Receive Packet Start Event (RPS). Set when the HDLC controller detects an opening byte. This is a latched bit and will be cleared when read. Bit 5/Receive Packet End Event (RPE). Set when the HDLC controller detects either the finish of a valid message (i.e., CRC check complete) or when the controller has experienced a message fault such as a CRC checking error, or an overrun condition, or an abort has been seen. This is a latched bit and will be cleared when read. Bit 6/Transmit Message End Event (TMEND). Set when the transmit HDLC controller has finished sending a message. This is a latched bit and will be cleared when read. 150 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 — 0 IMR6, IMR7 HDLC # 1 Interrupt Mask Register 6 HDLC # 2 Interrupt Mask Register 7 21h, 23h 6 TMEND 0 5 RPE 0 4 RPS 0 3 RHWM 0 Bit 0/Transmit FIFO Not Full Condition (TNF). 0 = interrupt masked 1 = interrupt enabled–interrupts on rising edge only Bit 1/Transmit FIFO Below Low Watermark Condition (TLWM). 0 = interrupt masked 1 = interrupt enabled–interrupts on rising edge only Bit 2/Receive FIFO Not Empty Condition (RNE). 0 = interrupt masked 1 = interrupt enabled–interrupts on rising edge only Bit 3/Receive FIFO Above High Watermark Condition (RHWM). 0 = interrupt masked 1 = interrupt enabled–interrupts on rising edge only Bit 4/Receive Packet Start Event (RPS). 0 = interrupt masked 1 = interrupt enabled Bit 5/Receive Packet End Event (RPE). 0 = interrupt masked 1 = interrupt enabled Bit 6/Transmit Message End Event (TMEND). 0 = interrupt masked 1 = interrupt enabled 151 of 270 2 RNE 0 1 TLWM 0 0 TNF 0 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 — 0 INFO5, INFO6 HDLC #1 Information Register HDLC #2 Information Register 2Eh, 2Fh 6 — 0 5 TEMPTY 0 4 TFULL 0 3 REMPTY 0 2 PS2 0 1 PS1 0 0 PS0 0 Bits 0 to 2/Receive Packet Status (PS0 to PS2). These are real-time bits indicating the status as of the last read of the receive FIFO. PS2 0 0 0 0 1 1 PS1 0 0 1 1 0 0 PS0 0 1 0 1 0 1 PACKET STATUS In Progress: End of message has not yet been reached. Packet OK: Packet ended with correct CRC codeword. CRC Error: A closing flag was detected, preceded by a corrupt CRC codeword. Abort: Packet ended because an abort signal was detected (seven or more ones in a row). Overrun: HDLC controller terminated reception of packet because receive FIFO is full. Message Too Short: Three or fewer bytes including CRC. Bit 3/Receive FIFO Empty (REMPTY). A real-time bit that is set high when the receive FIFO is empty. Bit 4/Transmit FIFO Full (TFULL). A real-time bit that is set high when the FIFO is full. Bit 5/Transmit FIFO Empty (TEMPTY). A real-time bit that is set high when the FIFO is empty. Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: INFO4 HDLC Event Information Register #4 2Dh Bit # Name Default 6 — 0 7 — 0 5 — 0 4 — 0 3 H2UDR 0 2 H2OBT 0 1 H1UDR 0 0 H1OBT 0 Bit 0/HDLC #1 Opening Byte Event (H1OBT). Set when the next byte available in the receive FIFO is the first byte of a message. Bit 1/HDLC #1 Transmit FIFO Underrun Event (H1UDR). Set when the transmit FIFO empties out without having seen the TMEND bit set. An abort is automatically sent. This bit is latched and will be cleared when read. Bit 2/HDLC #2 Opening Byte Event (H2OBT). Set when the next byte available in the receive FIFO is the first byte of a message. Bit 3/HDLC #2 Transmit FIFO Underrun Event (H2UDR). Set when the transmit FIFO empties out without having seen the TMEND bit set. An abort is automatically sent. This bit is latched and will be cleared when read. 152 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 24.3.3 FIFO Information The transmit FIFO buffer-available register indicates the number of bytes that can be written into the transmit FIFO. The count from this register informs the host as to how many bytes can be written into the transmit FIFO without overflowing the buffer. Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 TFBA7 0 H1TFBA, H2TFBA HDLC # 1 Transmit FIFO Buffer Available HDLC # 2 Transmit FIFO Buffer Available 9Fh, Afh 6 TFBA6 0 5 TFBA5 0 4 TFBA4 0 3 TFBA3 0 2 TFBA2 0 1 TFBA1 0 0 TFBA0 0 Bits 0 to 7/Transmit FIFO Bytes Available (TFBAO to TFBA7). TFBA0 is the LSB. 24.3.4 Receive Packet Bytes Available The lower 7 bits of the receive packet bytes available register indicate the number of bytes (0 through 127) that can be read from the receive FIFO. The value indicated by this register (lower 7 bits) informs the host as to how many bytes can be read from the receive FIFO without going past the end of a message. This value will refer to one of four possibilities: the first part of a packet, the continuation of a packet, the last part of a packet, or a complete packet. After reading the number of bytes indicated by this register, the host then checks the HDLC information register for detailed message status. If the value in the HxRPBA register refers to the beginning portion of a message or continuation of a message then the MSB of the HxRPBA register will return a value of 1. This indicates that the host can safely read the number of bytes returned by the lower 7 bits of the HxRPBA register but there is no need to check the information register since the packet has not yet terminated (successfully or otherwise). Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 MS 0 H1RPBA, H2RPBA HDLC # 1 Receive Packet Bytes Available HDLC # 2 Receive Packet Bytes Available 9Ch, Ach 6 RPBA6 0 5 RPBA5 0 4 RPBA4 0 3 RPBA3 0 2 RPBA2 0 1 RPBA1 0 0 RPBA0 0 Bits 0 to 6/Receive FIFO Packet Bytes Available Count (RPBA0 to RPBA6). RPBA0 is the LSB. Bit 7/Message Status (MS). 0 = bytes indicated by RPBA0 through RPBA6 are the end of a message. Host must check the INFO5 or INFO6 register for details. 1 = bytes indicated by RPBA0 through RPBA6 are the beginning or continuation of a message. The host does not need to check the INFO5 or INFO6 register. 153 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 24.3.5 HDLC FIFOS Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 THD7 0 H1TF, H2TF HDLC # 1 Transmit FIFO, HDLC # 2 Transmit FIFO 9Dh, Adh 6 THD6 0 5 THD5 0 4 THD4 0 3 THD3 0 2 THD2 0 1 THD1 0 0 THD0 0 1 RHD1 0 0 RHD0 0 Bit 0/Transmit HDLC Data Bit 0 (THD0). LSB of a HDLC packet data byte. Bit 1/Transmit HDLC Data Bit 1 (THD1). Bit 2/Transmit HDLC Data Bit 2 (THD2). Bit 3/Transmit HDLC Data Bit 3 (THD3). Bit 4/Transmit HDLC Data Bit 4 (THD4). Bit 5/Transmit HDLC Data Bit 5 (THD5). Bit 6/Transmit HDLC Data Bit 6 (THD6). Bit 7/Transmit HDLC Data Bit 7 (THD7). MSB of a HDLC packet data byte. Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 RHD7 0 H1RF, H2RF HDLC # 1 Receive FIFO, HDLC # 2 Receive FIFO 9Eh, Aeh 6 RHD6 0 5 RHD5 0 4 RHD4 0 3 RHD3 0 2 RHD2 0 Bit 0/Receive HDLC Data Bit 0 (RHD0). LSB of a HDLC packet data byte. Bit 1/Receive HDLC Data Bit 1 (RHD1). Bit 2/Receive HDLC Data Bit 2 (RHD2). Bit 3/Receive HDLC Data Bit 3 (RHD3). Bit 4/Receive HDLC Data Bit 4 (RHD4). Bit 5/Receive HDLC Data Bit 5 (RHD5). Bit 6/Receive HDLC Data Bit 6 (RHD6). Bit 7/Receive HDLC Data Bit 7 (RHD7). MSB of a HDLC packet data byte. 154 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 24.4 Receive HDLC Code Example Below is an example of a receive HDLC routine for controller #1. 1) Reset receive HDLC controller. 2) Set HDLC mode, mapping, and high watermark. 3) Start new message buffer. 4) Enable RPE and RHWM interrupts. 5) Wait for interrupt. 6) Disable RPE and RHWM interrupts. 7) Read HxRPBA register. N = HxRPBA (lower 7 bits are byte count, MSB is status). 8) Read (N AND 7Fh) bytes from receive FIFO and store in message buffer. 9) Read INFO5 register. 10) If PS2, PS1, PS0 = 000, then go to step 4. 11) If PS2, PS1, PS0 = 001, then packet terminated OK, save present message buffer. 12) If PS2, PS1, PS0 = 010, then packet terminated with CRC error. 13) If PS2, PS1, PS0 = 011, then packet aborted. 14) If PS2, PS1, PS0 = 100, then FIFO overflowed. 15) Go to step 3. 24.5 Legacy FDL Support (T1 Mode) To provide backward compatibility to the older DS21x52 T1 device, the DS21455/DS21458 maintain the circuitry that existed in the previous generation of the T1 framer. In new applications, it is recommended that the HDLC controllers and BOC controller are used. 24.5.1 Receive Section In the receive section, the recovered FDL bits or Fs bits are shifted bit-by-bit into the receive FDL register (RFDL). Since the RFDL is 8 bits in length, it will fill up every 2ms (8 x 250ms). The framer will signal an external microcontroller that the buffer has filled via the SR8.3 bit. If enabled via IMR8.3, the INT pin will toggle low indicating that the buffer has filled and needs to be read. The user has 2ms to read this data before it is lost. If the byte in the RFDL matches either of the bytes programmed into the RFDLM1 or RFDLM2 registers, then the SR8.1 bit will be set to a one and the INT pin will toggled low if enabled via IMR8.1. This feature allows an external microcontroller to ignore the FDL or Fs pattern until an important event occurs. The framer also contains a zero destuffer, which is controlled via the T1RCR2.3 bit. In both ANSI T1.403 and TR54016, communications on the FDL follows a subset of a LAPD protocol. The LAPD protocol states that no more than five ones should be transmitted in a row so that the data does not resemble an opening or closing flag (01111110) or an abort signal (11111111). If enabled via T1RCR2.3, the device will automatically look for five ones in a row, followed by a zero. If it finds such a pattern, it will automatically remove the zero. If the zero destuffer sees six or more ones in a row followed by a zero, the zero is not removed. The T1RCR2.3 bit should always be set to a one when the device is extracting the FDL. More on how to use the DS21455/DS21458 in FDL applications in this legacy support mode is covered in a separate application note. 155 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 RFDL7 0 RFDL Receive FDL Register C0h 6 RFDL6 0 5 RFDL5 0 4 RFDL4 0 3 RFDL3 0 2 RFDL2 0 1 RFDL1 0 0 RFDL0 0 Bit 0/Receive FDL Bit 0 (RFDL0). LSB of the Received FDL Code. Bit 1/Receive FDL Bit 1 (RFDL1). Bit 2/Receive FDL Bit 2 (RFDL2). Bit 3/Receive FDL Bit 3 (RFDL3). Bit 4/Receive FDL Bit 4 (RFDL4). Bit 5/Receive FDL Bit 5 (RFDL5). Bit 6/Receive FDL Bit 6 (RFDL6). Bit 7/Receive FDL Bit 7 (RFDL7). MSB of the Received FDL Code. The receive FDL register (RFDL) reports the incoming facility data link (FDL) or the incoming Fs bits. The LSB is received first. Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 RFDLM7 0 RFDLM1, RFDLM2 Receive FDL Match Register 1 Receive FDL Match Register 2 C2h, C3h 6 RFDLM6 0 5 RFDLM5 0 4 RFDLM4 0 3 RFDLM3 0 2 RFDLM2 0 Bit 0/Receive FDL Match Bit 0 (RFDLM0). LSB of the FDL Match Code. Bit 1/Receive FDL Match Bit 1 (RFDLM1). Bit 2/Receive FDL Match Bit 2 (RFDLM2). Bit 3/Receive FDL Match Bit 3 (RFDLM3). Bit 4/Receive FDL Match Bit 4 (RFDLM4). Bit 5/Receive FDL Match Bit 5 (RFDLM5). Bit 6/Receive FDL Match Bit 6 (RFDLM6). Bit 7/Receive FDL Match Bit 7 (RFDLM7). MSB of the FDL Match Code. 156 of 270 1 RFDLM1 0 0 RFDLM0 0 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 24.5.2 Transmit Section The transmit section will shift out into the T1 data stream, either the FDL (in the ESF framing mode) or the Fs bits (in the D4 framing mode) contained in the transmit FDL register (TFDL). When a new value is written to the TFDL, it will be multiplexed serially (LSB first) into the proper position in the outgoing T1 data stream. After the full eight bits has been shifted out, the framer will signal the host microcontroller that the buffer is empty and that more data is needed by setting the SR8.2 bit to a one. The INT will also toggle low if enabled via IMR8.2. The user has 2ms to update the TFDL with a new value. If the TFDL is not updated, the old value in the TFDL will be transmitted once again. The framer also contains a zero stuffer which is controlled via the T1TCR2.5 bit. In both ANSI T1.403 and TR54016, communications on the FDL follows a subset of a LAPD protocol. The LAPD protocol states that no more than five ones should be transmitted in a row so that the data does not resemble an opening or closing flag (01111110) or an abort signal (11111111). If enabled via T1TCR2.5, the framer will automatically look for 5 ones in a row. If it finds such a pattern, it will automatically insert a zero after the five ones. The T1TCR2.5 bit should always be set to a one when the framer is inserting the FDL. Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 TFDL7 0 TFDL Transmit FDL Register C1h 6 TFDL6 0 5 TFDL5 0 4 TFDL4 0 3 TFDL3 0 2 TFDL2 0 1 TFDL1 0 0 TFDL0 0 (Note: Also used to insert Fs framing pattern in D4 framing mode.) Bit 0/Transmit FDL Bit 0 (TFDL0). LSB of the Transmit FDL Code. Bit 1/Transmit FDL Bit 1 (TFDL1). Bit 2/Transmit FDL Bit 2 (TFDL2). Bit 3/Transmit FDL Bit 3 (TFDL3). Bit 4/Transmit FDL Bit 4 (TFDL4). Bit 5/Transmit FDL Bit 5 (TFDL5). Bit 6/Transmit FDL Bit 6 (TFDL6). Bit 7/Transmit FDL Bit 7 (TFDL7). MSB of the Transmit FDL Code. The transmit FDL Register (TFDL) contains the Facility Data Link (FDL) information that is to be inserted on a byte basis into the outgoing T1 data stream. The LSB is transmitted first. 24.6 D4/SLC-96 Operation In the D4 framing mode, the framer uses the TFDL register to insert the Fs framing pattern. To allow the device to properly insert the Fs framing pattern, the TFDL register at address C1h must be programmed to 1Ch and the following bits must be programmed as shown: T1TCR1.2 = 0 (source Fs data from the TFDL register) T1TCR2.6 = 1 (allow the TFDL register to load on multiframe boundaries). Since the SLC-96 message fields share the Fs-bit position, the user can access these message fields via the TFDL and RFDL registers. Please see the separate application note for a detailed description of how to implement a SLC-96 function. 157 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 25. LINE INTERFACE UNIT (LIU) The LIU in the DS21455/DS21458 contains three sections: the receiver, which handles clock and data recovery; the transmitter, which wave-shapes and drives the network line; and the jitter attenuator. These three sections are controlled by the line interface control registers (LIC1–LIC4), which are described below. The LIU has its own T1/E1 mode select bit and can operate independently of the framer function. The DS21455/DS21458 can switch between T1 or E1 networks without changing any external components on either the transmit or receive side. Figure 25-1 and Figure 25-2 show basic balanced and unbalanced network connections using minimal components. In this configuration the device can connect to T1, J1, or E1 (75Ω or 120Ω) without any component change. The receiver can adjust the 120Ω termination to 100Ω or 75Ω. The transmitter can adjust its output impedance to provide high return loss characteristics for 120Ω, 100Ω, and 75Ω lines. Other components may be added to this configuration in order to meet safety and network protection requirements. This is covered in Section 25.8 (Recommended Circuits). Figure 25-1. Basic Balanced Network Connections TTIP 0.047mF Tx TRING RTIP DS21455/ DS21458 Rx RRING 60W* 60W* 0.01mF *USE 60W WHEN USING INTERNAL TERMINATION FEATURE. 158 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Figure 25-2. Basic Unbalanced Network Connections TTIP 0.047mF Tx TRING RTIP DS21455/ DS21458 Rx RRING 60W* 60W* 0.01mF *USE 60W WHEN USING INTERNAL TERMINATION FEATURE. 25.1 LIU Operation The analog AMI/HDB3 waveform off of the E1 line or the AMI/B8ZS waveform off of the T1 line is transformer coupled into the RTIP and RRING pins of the DS21455/DS21458. The user has the option to use internal termination, software selectable for 75Ω/100Ω/120Ω applications, or external termination. The LIU recovers clock and data from the analog signal and passes it through the jitter attenuation MUX outputting the received line clock at RCLKO and bipolar or NRZ data at RPOSO and RNEGO. The DS21455/DS21458 contain an active filter that reconstructs the analog received signal for the nonlinear losses that occur in transmission. The receive circuitry also is configurable for various monitor applications. The device has a usable receive sensitivity of 0dB to -43dB for E1 and 0dB to -36dB for T1, which allows the device to operate on 0.63mm (22AWG) cables up to 2.5km (E1) and 6k feet (T1) in length. Data input at TPOSI and TNEGI is sent via the jitter attenuation MUX to the wave shaping circuitry and line driver. The DS21455/DS21458 will drive the E1 or T1 line from the TTIP and TRING pins via a coupling transformer. The line driver can handle both CEPT 30/ISDN-PRI lines for E1 and long-haul (CSU) or short-haul (DSX-1) lines for T1. 25.2 LIU Receiver The DS21455/DS21458 contain a digital clock recovery system. The device couples to the receive E1 or T1 twisted pair (or coaxial cable in 75Ω E1 applications) via a 1:1 transformer. See Table 25-6 for transformer details. The DS21455/DS21458 have the option of using software-selectable termination requiring only a single, fixed pair of termination resistors. The DS21455/DS21458’s LIU is designed to be fully software selectable for E1 and T1 without the need to change any external resistors for the receive-side. The receive-side will allow the user to configure the device for 75Ω, 100Ω, or 120Ω receive termination by setting the RT1 (LIC4.1) and RT0 (LIC4.0) bits. When using the internal termination feature, the resistors labeled R in Table 25-5 should be 60Ω each. If external termination is required, the resistors labeled R in Figure 25-5 will need to be 37.5Ω, 50Ω, or 60Ω each, depending on the line impedance. 159 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers There are two ranges of receive sensitivity for both T1 and E1, which is selectable by the user. The EGL bit of LIC1 (LIC1.4) selects the full or limited sensitivity. The resultant E1 or T1 clock derived from MCLK is multiplied by 16 via an internal PLL and fed to the clock recovery system. The clock recovery system uses the clock from the PLL circuit to form a 16 times over-sampler, which is used to recover the clock and data. This oversampling technique offers outstanding performance to meet jitter tolerance specifications shown in Figure 25-9. Normally, the clock that is output at the RCLK pin is the recovered clock from the E1 AMI/HDB3 or T1 AMI/B8ZS waveform presented at the RTIP and RRING inputs. If the jitter attenuator is placed in the receive path (as is the case in most applications), the jitter attenuator restores the RCLK to an approximate 50% duty cycle. If the jitter attenuator is either placed in the transmit path or is disabled, the RCLK output can exhibit slightly shorter high cycles of the clock. This is due to the highly over-sampled digital clock recovery circuitry. See the Receive AC Timing Characteristics section for more details. When no signal is present at RTIP and RRING, a receive carrier loss (RCL) condition will occur and the RCLK will be derived from the JACLK source. 25.2.1 Receive Level Indicator The DS21455/DS21458 will report the signal strength at RTIP and RRING in 2.5dB increments via RL3RL0 located in the Information Register 2 (INFO2). This feature is helpful when trouble shooting line performance problems. 25.2.2 Receive G.703 Section 10 Synchronization Signal The DS21455/DS21458 can receive a 2.048MHz square-wave synchronization clock as specified in Section 10 of ITU G.703. To use this mode, set the receive synchronization clock enable (LIC3.2) = 1. 25.2.3 Monitor Mode Monitor applications in both E1 and T1 require various flat gain settings for the receive-side circuitry. The DS21455/DS21458 can be programmed to support these applications via the monitor mode control bits MM1 and MM0 in the LIC3 register. Figure 25-3 depicts a typical monitor-mode application. Figure 25-3. Typical Monitor Application PRIMARY T1/E1 TERMINATING DEVICE T1/E1 LINE Rm Rm X F M R MONITOR PORT JACK Rt DS21455/ DS21458 SECONDARY T1/E1 TERMINATING DEVICE 160 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 25.3 LIU Transmitter The DS21455/DS21458 use a phase-lock loop along with a precision digital-to-analog converter (DAC) to create the waveforms that are transmitted onto the E1 or T1 line. The waveforms created by the transmitter meet the latest ETSI, ITU, ANSI, and AT&T specifications. The user will select which waveform is to be generated by setting the ETS bit (LIC2.7) for E1 or T1 operation, then programming the L2/L1/L0 bits in register LIC1 for the appropriate application. A 2.048MHz or 1.544MHz clock is required at TCLKI for transmitting data presented at TPOSI and TNEGI. Normally these pins are connected to TCLKO, TPOSO and TNEGO. However, the LIU may operate in an independent fashion. ITU specification G.703 requires an accuracy of ±50ppm for both T1 and E1. TR62411 and ANSI specs require an accuracy of ±32ppm for T1 interfaces. The clock can be sourced internally from RCLK or JACLK. See LIC2.3, LIC4.4 and LIC4.5 for details. Due to the nature of the design of the transmitter, very little jitter (less than 0.005 UIP-P broadband from 10Hz to 100kHz) is added to the jitter present on TCLK. Also, the waveforms created are independent of the duty cycle of TCLK. The transmitter couples to the E1 or T1 transmit twisted pair (or coaxial cable in some E1 applications) via a 1:2 step-up transformer. In order for the device to create the proper waveforms, the transformer used must meet the specifications listed in Table 25-6. The DS21455/DS21458 have the option of using software-selectable transmit termination. The transmit line drive has two modes of operation: fixed gain or automatic gain. In the fixed gain mode, the transmitter outputs a fixed current into the network load to achieve a nominal pulse amplitude. In the automatic gain mode, the transmitter adjusts its output level to compensate for slight variances in the network load. Automatic Gain Control is enabled by default. See the Transmit Line Build-Out Control (TLBC) register for details. 25.3.1 Transmit Short-Circuit Detector/Limiter The DS21455/DS21458 have automatic short-circuit limiters that limit the source current to 50mA (RMS) into a 1W load. This feature can be disabled by setting the SCLD bit (LIC2.1) = 1. TCLE (INFO2.5) provides a real-time indication of when the current limiter is activated. If the current limiter is disabled, TCLE will indicate that a short-circuit condition exist. Status Register SR1.2 provides a latched version of the information, which can be used to activate an interrupt when enable via the IMR1 register. When set low, the TPD bit (LIC1.0) will power-down the transmit line driver and tri-state the TTIP and TRING pins. 25.3.2 Transmit Open-Circuit Detector The DS21455/DS21458 can also detect when the TTIP or TRING outputs are open circuited. TOCD (INFO2.4) will provide a real-time indication of when an open circuit is detected. SR1 provides a latched version of the information (SR1.1), which can be used to activate an interrupt when enable via the IMR1 register. 161 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 25.3.3 Transmit BPV Error Insertion When IBPV (LIC2.5) is transitioned from a zero to a one, the device waits for the next occurrence of three consecutive ones to insert a BPV. IBPV must be cleared and set again for another BPV error insertion. 25.3.4 Transmit G.703 Section 10 Synchronization Signal (E1 Mode) The DS21455/DS21458 can transmit the 2.048MHz square-wave synchronization clock. When in E1 mode, to transmit the 2.048MHz clock, set the transmit synchronization clock enable (LIC3.1) = 1. 25.4 MCLK Prescaler A 16.384MHz, 8.192MHz, 4.096MHz, 2.048MHz, or 1.544MHz clock must be applied at the MCLK pin. ITU specification G.703 requires an accuracy of ±50ppm for both T1 and E1. TR62411 and ANSI specs require an accuracy of ±32ppm for T1 interfaces. A prescaler will divide the 16MHz, 8MHz, or 4MHz clock down to 2.048MHz. There is an onboard PLL for the jitter attenuator that will convert the 2.048MHz clock to a 1.544MHz rate for T1 applications. Setting JAMUX (LIC2.3) to a logic 0 bypasses this PLL. 25.5 Jitter Attenuator The DS21455/DS21458 contain an on-board jitter attenuator that can be set to a depth of either 32 bits or 128 bits via the JABDS bit (LIC1.2). The 128-bit mode is used in applications where large excursions of wander are expected. The 32-bit mode is used in delay-sensitive applications. The characteristics of the attenuation are shown in Figure 25-10 and Figure 25-11. The jitter attenuator can be placed in either the receive path or the transmit path by appropriately setting or clearing the JAS bit (LIC1.3). Also, the jitter attenuator can be disabled (in effect, removed) by setting the DJA bit (LIC1.1). Onboard circuitry adjusts either the recovered clock from the clock/data recovery block or the clock applied at the TCLK pin to create a smooth jitter free clock, which is used to clock data out of the jitter attenuator FIFO. It is acceptable to provide a gapped/bursty clock at the TCLK pin if the jitter attenuator is placed on the transmit side. If the incoming jitter exceeds either 120UIP-P (buffer depth is 128 bits) or 28UIP-P (buffer depth is 32 bits), then the jitter attenuator will divide the internal nominal 32.768MHz (E1) or 24.704MHz (T1) clock by either 15 or 17 instead of the normal 16 to keep the buffer from overflowing. When the device divides by either 15 or 17, it also sets the Jitter Attenuator Limit Trip (JALT) bit in Status Register 1 (SR1.4). 162 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 25.6 CMI (Code Mark Inversion) Option The DS21455/DS21458 provide a CMI interface for connection to optical transports. This interface is a unipolar 1T2B type of signal. Ones are encoded as either a logical one or zero level for the full duration of the clock period. Zeros are encoded as a zero-to-one transition at the middle of the clock period. Figure 25-4. CMI Coding CLOCK DATA 1 1 0 1 0 0 1 CMI Transmit and receive CMI is enabled via LIC4.7. When this register bit is set, the TTIP pin will output CMI-coded data at normal levels. This signal can be used to directly drive an optical interface. When CMI is enabled, the user can also use HDB3/B8ZS coding. When this register bit is set, the RTIP pin will become a unipolar CMI input. The CMI signal will be processed to extract and align the clock with data. 163 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 25.7 LIU Control Registers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: LIC1 Line Interface Control 1 78h Bit # Name Default 6 L1 0 7 L2 0 5 L0 0 4 EGL 0 3 JAS 0 2 JABDS 0 1 DJA 0 0 TPD 0 Bit 0/Transmit Power-Down (TPD). This bit along with the LIUC/TPD pin and the LTS (LBCR.7) bit controls the transmit power-down function. 0 = powers down the transmitter and tri-states the TTIP and TRING pins 1 = normal transmitter operation Table 25-1. TPD CONTROL LBCR.7 (LTS) 0 0 1 1 1 1 LIUC/TPD PIN X X 0 0 1 1 LIC1.0 (TPD) 0 1 0 1 0 1 FUNCTION Transmitter in power-down mode, TTIP and TRING tri-stated Transmitter enabled Transmitter in power-down mode, TTIP and TRING tri-stated Transmitter enabled Transmitter in power-down mode, TTIP and TRING tri-stated Transmitter in power-down mode, TTIP and TRING tri-stated Bit 1/Disable Jitter Attenuator (DJA). 0 = jitter attenuator enabled 1 = jitter attenuator disabled Bit 2/Jitter Attenuator Buffer Depth Select (JABDS). 0 = 128 bits 1 = 32 bits (use for delay sensitive applications) Bit 3/Jitter Attenuator Select (JAS). 0 = place the jitter attenuator on the receive side 1 = place the jitter attenuator on the transmit side Bit 4/Receive Equalizer Gain Limit (EGL). This bit controls the sensitivity of the receive equalizer. T1 Mode: 0 = -36dB (long haul) 1 = -15dB (limited long haul) E1 Mode: 0 = -12dB (short haul) 1 = -43dB (long haul) Bits 5 to 7/Line Build-Out Select (L0 to L2). These bits select the output waveshape. See Table 25-2, Table 25-3, Table 25-4, and Table 25-5 for the correct register settings for specific applications. In E1 mode, when using the internal termination, the user needs only to select 000 for 75Ω operation or 001 for 120Ω operation. Using TT0 and TT1 of the LICR4 register, users can then select the proper internal source termination. Line build-outs 100 and 101 are provided for backward compatibility with older products only. 164 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Table 25-2. E1 MODE WITH AUTOMATIC GAIN CONTROL MODE ENABLED (TLBC.6 = 0) APPLICATION 75W Normal 120W Normal 75W with High Return Loss* 120W with High Return Loss* LIC1.7 (L2) 0 0 1 1 LIC1.6 (L1) 0 0 0 0 LIC1.5 (L0) 0 1 0 1 PSA1 (F1h) 20h 20h 00h 20h PSA2 (F2h) 08h 00h 00h 00h RETURN LOSS N.M.** N.M. 21dB 21dB Rt (1) 0 0 6.2Ω 11.6Ω Table 25-3. E1 MODE WITH AUTOMATIC GAIN CONTROL MODE DISABLED (TLBC.6 = 1) APPLICATION 75W Normal 120W Normal 75W with High Return Loss* 120W with High Return Loss* LIC1.7 (L2) 0 0 1 1 LIC1.6 (L1) 0 0 0 0 LIC1.5 (L0) 0 1 0 1 PSA1 (F1h) 20h 00h 00h 00h PSA2 (F2h) 08h 00h 00h 00h RETURN LOSS N.M. N.M. 21dB 21dB Rt (1) 0 0 6.2Ω 11.6Ω Table 25-4. T1 MODE WITH AUTOMATIC GAIN CONTROL MODE ENABLED (TLBC.6 = 0) APPLICATION 0dB CSU DSX-1 (0 to 133 feet)/0dB CSU DSX-1 (133 to 266 feet) DSX-1 (266 to 399 feet) DSX-1 (399 to 533 feet) DSX-1 (533 to 655 feet) -7.5dB CSU -15dB CSU -22.5dB CSU LIC1.7 (L2) 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 LIC1.6 (L1) 0 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 LIC1.5 (L0) 0 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 PSA1 (F1h) 00h 00h 0Ah 0Ah 00h 0Ah 00h 00h 00h PSA2 (F2h) 00h 00h 00h 00h 00h 00h 00h 00h 00h RETURN LOSS N.M. N.M. N.M. N.M. N.M. N.M. N.M. N.M. N.M. Rt (1) 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Table 25-5. T1 MODE WITH AUTOMATIC GAIN CONTROL MODE DISABLED (TLBC.6 = 1) APPLICATION 0dB CSU DSX-1 (0 to 133 feet)/0dB CSU DSX-1 (133 to 266 feet) DSX-1 (266 to 399 feet) DSX-1 (399 to 533 feet) DSX-1 (533 to 655 feet) -7.5dB CSU -15dB CSU -22.5dB CSU LIC1.7 (L2) 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 LIC1.6 (L1) 0 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 LIC1.5 (L0) 0 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 *TT0 and TT1 of the LIC4 register must be set to zero in this configuration. **N.M. = not meaningful. 165 of 270 PSA1 (F1h) 00h 00h 00h 00h 00h 00h 00h 00h 00h PSA2 (F2h) 00h 00h 00h 00h 00h 00h 00h 00h 00h RETURN LOSS N.M. N.M. N.M. N.M. N.M. N.M. N.M. N.M. N.M. Rt (1) 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 — 0 TLBC Transmit Line Build-Out Control 7Dh 6 AGCD 0 5 GC5 0 4 GC4 0 3 GC3 0 2 GC2 0 1 GC1 0 0 GC0 0 Bit 0–5/Gain Control Bits 0–5 (GC0–GC5). The GC0 through GC5 bits control the gain setting automatic gain control is disabled. Use the tables below for setting the recommended values. The LB (line build-out) column refers to the value in the L0–L2 bits in LIC1 (Line Interface Control 1) register. NETWORK MODE T1, Impedance Match Off T1, Impedance Match On E1, Impedance Match Off E1, Impedance Match On LB 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 0 1 4 5 1 2 GC5 1 0 0 1 1 1 0 1 0 0 0 0 1 1 0 1 1 1 1 1 0 0 GC4 0 1 1 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 1 0 0 0 0 1 1 GC3 0 1 1 0 0 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 1 1 GC2 1 0 0 0 1 1 0 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 1 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bit 6/Automatic Gain Control Disable (AGCD). 0 = use Transmit AGC, TLBC bits 0–5 are “don’t care” 1 = do not use Transmit AGC, TLBC bits 0–5 set nominal level Bit 7/Unused, must be set to zero for proper operation. 166 of 270 GC1 1 1 1 0 1 1 1 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 0 0 1 0 1 1 GC0 0 1 0 0 1 1 1 1 0 1 1 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 ETS 0 LIC2 Line Interface Control 2 79h 6 LIRST 0 5 IBPV 0 4 TUA1 0 3 JAMUX 0 2 — 0 1 SCLD 0 0 CLDS 0 Bit 0/Custom Line Driver Select (CLDS). Setting this bit to a one will redefine the operation of the transmit line driver. When this bit is set to a one and LIC1.5 = LIC1.6 = LIC1.7 = 0, then the device will generate a square wave at the TTIP and TRING outputs instead of a normal waveform. When this bit is set to a one and LIC1.5 = LIC1.6 = LIC1.7 ¹ 0, then the device will force TTIP and TRING outputs to become open-drain drivers instead of their normal push-pull operation. This bit should be set to zero for normal operation of the device. Bit 1/Short Circuit Limit Disable (ETS = 1) (SCLD). Controls the 50mA (RMS) current limiter. 0 = enable 50mA current limiter 1 = disable 50mA current limiter Bit 2/Unused, must be set to zero for proper operation. Bit 3/Jitter Attenuator MUX (JAMUX). Controls the source for JACLK. 0 = JACLK sourced from MCLK (2.048MHz or 1.544MHz at MCLK) 1 = JACLK sourced from internal PLL (2.048MHz at MCLK) Bit 4/Transmit Unframed All Ones (TUA1). The polarity of this bit is set such that the device will transmit an all ones pattern on power-up or device reset. This bit must be set to a one to allow the device to transmit data. The transmission of this data pattern is always timed off of the JACLK. 0 = transmit all ones at TTIP and TRING 1 = transmit data normally Bit 5/Insert BPV (IBPV). A zero-to-one transition on this bit will cause a single BPV to be inserted into the transmit data stream. Once this bit has been toggled from a zero to a one, the device waits for the next occurrence of three consecutive ones to insert the BPV. This bit must be cleared and set again for a subsequent error to be inserted. Bit 6/Line Interface Reset (LIRST). Setting this bit from a zero to a one will initiate an internal reset that resets the clock recovery state machine and recenters the jitter attenuator. Normally this bit is only toggled on power-up. Must be cleared and set again for a subsequent reset. Bit 7/E1/T1 Select (ETS). 0 = T1 Mode Selected 1 = E1 Mode Selected 167 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 — 0 LIC3 Line Interface Control 3 7Ah 6 TCES 0 5 RCES 0 4 MM1 0 3 MM0 0 2 RSCLKE 0 1 TSCLKE 0 0 TAOZ 0 Bit 0/Transmit Alternate Ones and Zeros (TAOZ). Transmit a …101010… pattern (Customer Disconnect Indication Signal) at TTIP and TRING. The transmission of this data pattern is always timed off of TCLK. 0 = disabled 1 = enabled Bit 1/Transmit Synchronization G.703 Clock Enable (TSCLKE). 0 = disable 1.544MHz (T1)/2.048MHz (E1) transmit synchronization clock 1 = enable 1.544MHz (T1)/2.048MHz (E1) transmit synchronization clock Bit 2/Receive Synchronization G.703 Clock Enable (RSCLKE). 0 = disable 1.544MHz (T1)/2.048MHz (E1) synchronization receive mode 1 = enable 1.544MHz (T1)/2.048MHz (E1) synchronization receive mode Bits 3 to 4/Monitor Mode (MM0 to MM1). MM1 MM0 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 INTERNAL LINEAR GAIN BOOST (dB) Normal operation (no boost) 20 26 32 Bit 5/Receive Clock Edge Select (RCES). Selects which RCLKO edge to update RPOSO and RNEGO. 0 = update RPOSO and RNEGO on rising edge of RCLKO 1 = update RPOSO and RNEGO on falling edge of RCLKO Bit 6/Transmit Clock Edge Select (TCES). Selects which TCLKI edge to sample TPOSI and TNEGI. 0 = sample TPOSI and TNEGI on falling edge of TCLKI 1 = sample TPOSI and TNEGI on rising edge of TCLKI Bit 7/Unused, must be set to zero for proper operation. 168 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default LIC4 Line Interface Control 4 7Bh 7 CMIE 0 6 CMII 0 5 MPS1 0 4 MPS0 0 3 TT1 0 Bits 0 to 1/Receive Termination Select (RT0 to RT1). RT1 RT0 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 INTERNAL RECEIVE TERMINATION CONFIGURATION Internal Receive-Side Termination Disabled Internal Receive-Side 75Ω Enabled Internal Receive-Side 100Ω Enabled Internal Receive-Side 120Ω Enabled Bits 2 to 3/Transmit Termination Select (TT0 to TT1). TT1 TT0 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 INTERNAL TRANSMIT TERMINATION CONFIGURATION Internal Transmit-Side Termination Disabled Internal Transmit-Side 75Ω Enabled Internal Transmit-Side 100Ω Enabled Internal Transmit-Side 120Ω Enabled Bits 4 and 5/MCLK Prescaler for T1 Mode. MCLK (MHz) 1.544 3.088 6.176 12.352 2.048 4.096 8.192 16.384 MPS1 MPS0 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 JAMUX (LIC2.3) 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 Bits 4 and 5/MCLK Prescaler for E1 Mode. MCLK (MHz) 2.048 4.096 8.192 16.384 MPS1 MPS0 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 JAMUX (LIC2.3) 0 0 0 0 Bit 6/CMI Invert (CMII). 0 = CMI normal at TTIP and RTIP 1 = invert CMI signal at TTIP and RTIP Bit 7/CMI Enable (CMIE). 0 = disable CMI mode 1 = enable CMI mode 169 of 270 2 TT0 0 1 RT1 0 0 RT0 0 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: INFO2 Information Register 2 11h Bit # Name Default 6 BD 0 7 BSYNC 0 5 TCLE 0 4 TOCD 0 3 RL3 0 2 RL2 0 1 RL1 0 0 RL0 0 Bits 0 to 3/Receive Level Bits (RL0 to RL3). Real-time bits. RL3 RL2 RL1 RL0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 RECEIVE LEVEL (dB) Greater than -2.5 -2.5 to -5.0 -5.0 to -7.5 -7.5 to -10.0 -10.0 to -12.5 -12.5 to -15.0 -15.0 to -17.5 -17.5 to -20.0 -20.0 to -22.5 -22.5 to -25.0 -25.0 to -27.5 -27.5 to -30.0 -30.0 to –32.5 -32.5 to -35.0 -35.0 to -37.5 Less than -37.5 Bit 4/Transmit Open-Circuit Detect (TOCD). A real-time bit set when the device detects that the TTIP and TRING outputs are open-circuited. Bit 5/Transmit Current Limit Exceeded (TCLE). A real-time bit set when the 50mA (RMS) current limiter is activated, whether the current limiter is enabled or not. Bit 6/BOC Detected (BD). A real-time bit that is set high when the BOC detector is presently seeing a valid sequence and set low when no BOC is currently being detected. Bit 7/BERT Real-Time Synchronization Status (BSYNC). Real-time status of the synchronizer (this bit is not latched). Will be set when the incoming pattern matches for 32 consecutive bit positions. Will be cleared when six or more bits out of 64 are received in error. Refer to BSYNC in the BERT status register, SR9, for an interrupt-generating version of this signal. 170 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 ILUT 0 SR1 Status Register 1 16h 6 TIMER 0 5 RSCOS 0 4 JALT 0 3 LRCL 0 2 TCLE 0 1 TOCD 0 0 LOLITC 0 Bit 0/Loss of Line Interface Transmit Clock Condition (LOLITC). Set when TCLKI has not transitioned for one channel time. Bit 1/Transmit Open-Circuit Detect Condition (TOCD). Set when the device detects that the TTIP and TRING outputs are open-circuited. Bit 2/Transmit Current Limit Exceeded Condition (TCLE). Set when the 50mA (RMS) current limiter is activated whether the current limiter is enabled or not. Bit 3/Line Interface Receive Carrier Loss Condition (LRCL). Set when the carrier signal is lost. Bit 4/Jitter Attenuator Limit Trip Event (JALT). Set when the jitter attenuator FIFO reaches to within 4 bits of its useful limit. Will be cleared when read. Useful for debugging jitter-attenuation operation. Bit 5/Receive Signaling Change Of State Event (RSCOS). Set when any channel selected by the receive-signaling changeof-state interrupt-enable registers (RSCSE1 through RSCSE4) changes signaling state. Bit 6/Timer Event (TIMER). Follows the error counter update interval as determined by the ECUS bit in the Error Counter Configuration Register (ERCNT). T1 Mode: Set on increments of one second or 42ms based on RCLK. E1 Mode: Set on increments of one second or 62.5ms based on RCLK. Bit 7/Input Level Under Threshold (ILUT). This bit is set whenever the input level at RTIP and RRING falls below the threshold set by the value in CCR4.4 through CCR4.7. The level must remain below the programmed threshold for approximately 50ms for this bit to be set. This is a double interrupt bit (See Section 8.3). 171 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 ILUT 0 IMR1 Interrupt Mask Register 1 17h 6 TIMER 0 5 RSCOS 0 4 JALT 0 3 LRCL 0 2 TCLE 0 Bit 0/Loss of Transmit Clock Condition (LOLITC). 0 = interrupt masked 1 = interrupt enabled–generates interrupts on rising and falling edges Bit 1/Transmit Open Circuit Detect Condition (TOCD). 0 = interrupt masked 1 = interrupt enabled–generates interrupts on rising and falling edges Bit 2/Transmit Current Limit Exceeded Condition (TCLE). 0 = interrupt masked 1 = interrupt enabled–generates interrupts on rising and falling edges Bit 3/Line Interface Receive Carrier Loss Condition (LRCL). 0 = interrupt masked 1 = interrupt enabled–generates interrupts on rising and falling edges Bit 4/Jitter Attenuator Limit Trip Event (JALT). 0 = interrupt masked 1 = interrupt enabled Bit 5/Receive Signaling Change-of-State Event (RSCOS). 0 = interrupt masked 1 = interrupt enabled Bit 6/Timer Event (TIMER). 0 = interrupt masked 1 = interrupt enabled Bit 7/Input Level Under Threshold (ILUT) 0 = interrupt masked 1 = interrupt enabled 172 of 270 1 TOCD 0 0 LOLITC 0 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 25.8 Recommended Circuits Figure 25-5. Basic Interface VDD DS21455/458 2:1 TTIP TRANSMIT LINE C DVDD 0.1mF 0.01mF 0.1mF 10mF + 0.1mF 10mF DVSS TRING TVDD TVSS RVDD 1:1 RTIP + RVSS RECEIVE LINE RRING R R 0.1mF NOTES: 1) All resistor values are ±1%. 2) Resistors R should be set to 60Ω each if the internal receive-side termination feature is enabled. When this feature is disabled, R = 37.5Ω for 75Ω coaxial E1 lines, 60Ω for 120Ω twisted pair E1 lines, or 50Ω for 100Ω twisted pair T1 lines. 3) C = 1µF ceramic. 173 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Figure 25-6. Protected Interface Using Internal Receive Termination VDD D1 D2 2:1 TRANSMIT LINE TTIP F1 S1 C1 DVDD 0.1mF 0.01mF DVSS 0.1mF F2 VDD DS21455/458 X2 D4 D3 TRING TVDD 0.1mF 10mF + 0.1mF 10mF TVSS VDD D5 RVDD D6 1:1 RECEIVE LINE RTIP S2 F3 0.1mF D8 F4 RVSS X1 RRING D7 60W 60W 0.1mF NOTES: 1) 2) 3) 4) 5) 6) All resistor values are ±1%. X1 and X2 are very low DCR transformers C1 = 1µF ceramic. S1 and S2 are 6V transient suppressers. D1 to D8 are Schottky diodes. The fuses, F1–F4, are optional to prevent AC power-line crosses from compromising the transformers. 7) The 68mF is used to keep the local power-plane potential within tolerance during a surge. 174 of 270 + 68mF + DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 25.9 Component Specifications Table 25-6. TRANSFORMER SPECIFICATIONS SPECIFICATION Turns Ratio (3.3V Applications) Primary Inductance Leakage Inductance Intertwining Capacitance Transmit Transformer DC Resistance Primary (Device Side) Secondary Receive Transformer DC Resistance Primary (Device Side) Secondary RECOMMENDED VALUE 1:1 (receive) and 1:2 (transmit) ±2% 600mH minimum 1.0mH maximum 40pF maximum 1.0Ω maximum 2.0Ω maximum 1.2Ω maximum 1.2Ω maximum 175 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Figure 25-7. E1 Transmit Pulse Template 1.2 1.1 269ns SCALED AMPLITUDE (in 75 ohm systems, 1.0 on the scale = 2.37Vpeak in 120 ohm systems, 1.0 on the scale = 3.00Vpeak) 1.0 0.9 0.8 0.7 G.703 Template 194ns 0.6 0.5 219ns 0.4 0.3 0.2 0.1 0 -0.1 -0.2 -250 -200 -150 -100 -50 0 50 100 150 200 250 TIME (ns) Figure 25-8. T1 Transmit Pulse Template 1.2 1.0 -0.77 -0.39 -0.27 -0.27 -0.12 0.00 0.27 0.35 0.93 1.16 0.9 0.8 0.7 NORMALIZED AMPLITUDE MINIMUM CURVE UI Time Amp. MAXIMUM CURVE UI Time Amp. 1.1 0.6 -500 -255 -175 -175 -75 0 175 225 600 750 0.05 0.05 0.80 1.15 1.15 1.05 1.05 -0.07 0.05 0.05 0.5 -0.77 -0.23 -0.23 -0.15 0.00 0.15 0.23 0.23 0.46 0.66 0.93 1.16 -500 -150 -150 -100 0 100 150 150 300 430 600 750 -0.05 -0.05 0.50 0.95 0.95 0.90 0.50 -0.45 -0.45 -0.20 -0.05 -0.05 0.4 0.3 0.2 0.1 0 -0.1 -0.2 -0.3 T1.102/87, T1.403, CB 119 (Oct. 79), & I.431 Template -0.4 -0.5 -500 -400 -300 -200 -100 0 100 200 TIME (ns) 176 of 270 300 400 500 600 700 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Figure 25-9. Jitter Tolerance UNIT INTERVALS (UIpp) 1K DS21458 /455 Tolerance 100 TR 62411 (Dec. 90) 10 ITU-T G.823 1 0.1 10 1 100 1K FREQUENCY (Hz) 10K 100K Figure 25-10. Jitter Attenuation (T1 Mode) -20dB e rv Cu A TR 62411 (Dec. 90) Prohibited Area -40dB rve Cu JITTER ATTENUATION (dB) 0dB B DS21458/455 T1 MODE -60dB 1 10 100 1K FREQUENCY (Hz) 177 of 270 10K 100K DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Figure 25-11. Jitter Attenuation (E1 Mode) JITTER ATTENUATION (dB) 0dB TBR12 Prohibited Area ITU G.7XX Prohibited Area -20dB DS21458/455 E1 MODE -40dB -60dB 1 10 100 1K FREQUENCY (Hz) 178 of 270 10K 100K DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 26. PROGRAMMABLE IN-BAND LOOP CODE GENERATION AND DETECTION The DS21455/DS21458 can generate and detect a repeating bit pattern from 1 bit to 8 bits or 16 bits in length. This function is available only in T1 mode. To transmit a pattern, the user will load the pattern to be sent into the transmit code definition registers (TCD1 and TCD2) and select the proper length of the pattern by setting the TC0 and TC1 bits in the in-band code-control (IBCC) register. When generating a 1-, 2-, 4-, 8-, or 16-bit pattern both transmit code-definition registers (TCD1 and TCD2) must be filled with the proper code. Generation of a 3-, 5-, 6-, and 7-bit pattern only requires TCD1 to be filled. Once this is accomplished, the pattern will be transmitted as long as the TLOOP control bit (T1CCR1.0) is enabled. Normally (unless the transmit formatter is programmed to not insert the F-bit position) the framer will overwrite the repeating pattern once every 193 bits to allow the F-bit position to be sent. An example: to transmit the standard loop-up code for channel service units (CSUs), which is a repeating pattern of ...10000100001..., set TCD1 = 80h, IBCC = 0 and T1CCR1.0 = 1. The framer has three programmable pattern detectors. Typically, two of the detectors are used for loop-up and loop-down code detection. The user will program the codes to be detected in the receive-up codedefinition (RUPCD1 and RUPCD2) registers and the receive-down code-definition (RDNCD1 and RDNCD2) registers and the length of each pattern will be selected via the IBCC register. A third detector (spare) is defined and controlled via the RSCD1/RSCD2 and RSCC registers. Both receive codedefinition registers are used together to form a 16-bit register when detecting a 16-bit pattern. Both receive code-definition registers will be filled with the same value for 8-bit patterns. Detection of a 1-, 2-, 3-, 4-, 5-, 6-, and 7-bit pattern only requires the first receive code-definition register to be filled. The framer will detect repeating pattern codes in both framed and unframed circumstances with bit error rates as high as 10E-2. The detectors are capable of handling both F-bit inserted and F-bit overwrite patterns. Writing the least significant byte of the receive code-definition register resets the integration period for that detector. The code detector has a nominal integration period of 36ms. Hence, after about 36ms of receiving a valid code, the proper status bit (LUP at SR3.5, LDN at SR3.6, and LSPARE at SR3.7 ) will be set to a one. Normally codes are sent for a period of five seconds. It is recommended that the software poll the framer every 50ms to 1000ms until five seconds has elapsed to ensure that the code is continuously present. 179 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 TC1 0 IBCC In-Band Code Control Register B6h 6 TC0 0 5 RUP2 0 4 RUP1 0 3 RUP0 0 2 RDN2 0 Bits 0 to 2/Receive-Down Code Length Definition Bits (RDN0 to RDN2). RDN2 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 RDN1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 RDN0 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 LENGTH SELECTED (Bits) 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8/16 Bits 3 to 5/Receive-Up Code Length Definition Bits (RUP0 to RUP2). RUP2 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 RUP1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 RUP0 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 LENGTH SELECTED (Bits) 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8/16 Bits 6 to 7/Transmit Code Length Definition Bits (TC0 to TC1). TC1 0 0 1 1 TC0 0 1 0 1 LENGTH SELECTED (Bits) 5 6/3 7 16/8/4/2/1 180 of 270 1 RDN1 0 0 RDN0 0 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: TCD1 Transmit Code Definition Register 1 B7h Bit # Name Default 6 C6 0 7 C7 0 5 C5 0 4 C4 0 3 C3 0 2 C2 0 1 C1 0 0 C0 0 Bit 0/Transmit Code Definition Bit 0 (C0). A “don’t care” if a 5-, 6-, or 7-bit length is selected. Bit 1/Transmit Code Definition Bit 1 (C1). A “don’t care” if a 5-bit or 6-bit length is selected. Bit 2/Transmit Code Definition Bit 2 (C2). A “don’t care” if a 5-bit length is selected. Bit 3/Transmit Code Definition Bit 3 (C3). Bit 4/Transmit Code Definition Bit 4 (C4). Bit 5/Transmit Code Definition Bit 5 (C5). Bit 6/Transmit Code Definition Bit 6 (C6). Bit 7/Transmit Code Definition Bit 7 (C7). First bit of the repeating pattern. Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: TCD2 Transmit Code Definition Register 2 B8h Bit # Name Default 6 C6 0 7 C7 0 5 C5 0 4 C4 0 3 C3 0 2 C2 0 1 C1 0 Note: Least significant byte of 16-bit codes. Bit 0/Transmit Code Definition Bit 0 (C0). A “don’t care” if a 5-, 6-, or 7-bit length is selected. Bit 1/Transmit Code Definition Bit 1 (C1). A “don’t care” if a 5-, 6-, or 7-bit length is selected. Bit 2/Transmit Code Definition Bit 2 (C2). A “don’t care” if a 5-, 6-, or 7-bit length is selected. Bit 3/Transmit Code Definition Bit 3 (C3). A “don’t care” if a 5-, 6-, or 7-bit length is selected. Bit 4/Transmit Code Definition Bit 4 (C4). A “don’t care” if a 5-, 6-, or 7-bit length is selected. Bit 5/Transmit Code Definition Bit 5 (C5). A “don’t care” if a 5-, 6-, or 7-bit length is selected. Bit 6/Transmit Code Definition Bit 6 (C6). A “don’t care” if a 5-, 6-, or 7-bit length is selected. Bit 7/Transmit Code Definition Bit 7 (C7). A “don’t care” if a 5-, 6-, or 7-bit length is selected. 181 of 270 0 C0 0 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: RUPCD1 Receive-Up Code Definition Register 1 B9h Bit # Name Default 6 C6 0 7 C7 0 5 C5 0 4 C4 0 3 C3 0 2 C2 0 1 C1 0 0 C0 0 Note: Writing this register resets the detector’s integration period. Bit 0/Receive-Up Code Definition Bit 0 (C0). A “don’t care” if a 1-bit to 7-bit length is selected. Bit 1/Receive-Up Code Definition Bit 1 (C1). A “don’t care” if a 1-bit to 6-bit length is selected. Bit 2/Receive-Up Code Definition Bit 2 (C2). A “don’t care” if a 1-bit to 5-bit length is selected. Bit 3/Receive-Up Code Definition Bit 3 (C3). A “don’t care” if a 1-bit to 4 bit length is selected. Bit 4/Receive-Up Code Definition Bit 4 (C4). A “don’t care” if a 1-bit to 3-bit length is selected. Bit 5/Receive-Up Code Definition Bit 5 (C5). A “don’t care” if a 1-bit or 2-bit length is selected. Bit 6/Receive-Up Code Definition Bit 6 (C6). A “don’t care if a 1-bit length is selected. Bit 7/Receive-Up Code Definition Bit 7 (C7). First bit of the repeating pattern. Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: RUPCD2 Receive-Up Code Definition Register 2 Bah Bit # Name Default 6 C6 0 7 C7 0 5 C5 0 4 C4 0 3 C3 0 2 C2 0 1 C1 0 Bit 0/Receive-Up Code Definition Bit 0 (C0). A “don’t care” if a 1-bit to 7-bit length is selected. Bit 1/Receive-Up Code Definition Bit 1 (C1). A “don’t care” if a 1-bit to 7-bit length is selected. Bit 2/Receive-Up Code Definition Bit 2 (C2). A “don’t care” if a 1-bit to 7-bit length is selected. Bit 3/Receive-Up Code Definition Bit 3 (C3). A “don’t care” if a 1-bit to 7-bit length is selected. Bit 4/Receive-Up Code Definition Bit 4 (C4). A “don’t care” if a 1-bit to 7-bit length is selected. Bit 5/Receive-Up Code Definition Bit 5 (C5). A “don’t care” if a 1-bit to 7-bit length is selected. Bit 6/Receive-Up Code Definition Bit 6 (C6). A “don’t care” if a 1-bit to 7-bit length is selected. Bit 7/Receive-Up Code Definition Bit 7 (C7). A “don’t care” if a 1-bit to 7-bit length is selected. 182 of 270 0 C0 0 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: RDNCD1 Receive-Down Code Definition Register 1 BBh Bit # Name Default 6 C6 0 7 C7 0 5 C5 0 4 C4 0 3 C3 0 2 C2 0 1 C1 0 Note: Writing this register resets the detector’s integration period. Bit 0/Receive-Down Code Definition Bit 0 (C0). A “don’t care” if a 1-bit to 7-bit length is selected. Bit 1/Receive-Down Code Definition Bit 1 (C1). A “don’t care” if a 1-bit to 6-bit length is selected. Bit 2/Receive-Down Code Definition Bit 2 (C2). A “don’t care” if a 1-bit to 5-bit length is selected. Bit 3/Receive-Down Code Definition Bit 3 (C3). A “don’t care” if a 1-bit to 4-bit length is selected. Bit 4/Receive-Down Code Definition Bit 4 (C4). A “don’t care” if a 1-bit to 3-bit length is selected. Bit 5/Receive-Down Code Definition Bit 5 (C5). A “don’t care” if a 1-bit or 2-bit length is selected. Bit 6/Receive-Down Code Definition Bit 6 (C6). A “don’t care” if a 1-bit length is selected. Bit 7/Receive-Down Code Definition Bit 7 (C7). First bit of the repeating pattern. 183 of 270 0 C0 0 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: RDNCD2 Receive-Down Code Definition Register 2 BCh Bit # Name Default 6 C6 0 7 C7 0 5 C5 0 4 C4 0 3 C3 0 2 C2 0 1 C1 0 0 C0 0 Bit 0/Receive-Down Code Definition Bit 0 (C0). A “don’t care” if a 1-bit to 7-bit length is selected. Bit 1/Receive-Down Code Definition Bit 1 (C1). A “don’t care” if a 1-bit to 7-bit length is selected. Bit 2/Receive-Down Code Definition Bit 2 (C2). A “don’t care” if a 1-bit to 7-bit length is selected. Bit 3/Receive-Down Code Definition Bit 3 (C3). A “don’t care” if a 1-bit to 7-bit length is selected. Bit 4/Receive-Down Code Definition Bit 4 (C4). A “don’t care” if a 1-bit to 7-bit length is selected. Bit 5/Receive-Down Code Definition Bit 5 (C5). A “don’t care” if a 1-bit to 7-bit length is selected. Bit 6/Receive-Down Code Definition Bit 6 (C6). A “don’t care” if a 1-bit to 7-bit length is selected. Bit 7/Receive-Down Code Definition Bit 7 (C7). A “don’t care” if a 1-bit to 7-bit length is selected. Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: RSCC In-Band Receive Spare Control Register BDh Bit # Name Default 6 — 0 7 — 0 5 — 0 4 — 0 3 — 0 2 RSC2 0 Bits 0 to 2/Receive Spare Code Length Definition Bits (RSC0 to RSC2). RSC2 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 RSC1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 RSC0 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 LENGTH SELECTED (Bits) 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8/16 Bit 3/Unused, must be set to zero for proper operation. Bit 4/Unused, must be set to zero for proper operation. Bit 5/Unused, must be set to zero for proper operation. Bit 6/Unused, must be set to zero for proper operation. Bit 7/Unused, must be set to zero for proper operation. 184 of 270 1 RSC1 0 0 RSC0 0 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: RSCD1 Receive-Spare Code Definition Register 1 BEh Bit # Name Default 6 C6 0 7 C7 0 5 C5 0 4 C4 0 3 C3 0 2 C2 0 1 C1 0 0 C0 0 Note: Writing this register resets the detector’s integration period. Bit 0/Receive-Spare Code Definition Bit 0 (C0). A “don’t care” if a 1-bit to 7-bit length is selected. Bit 1/Receive-Spare Code Definition Bit 1 (C1). A “don’t care” if a 1-bit to 6-bit length is selected. Bit 2/Receive-Spare Code Definition Bit 2 (C2). A “don’t care” if a 1-bit to 5-bit length is selected. Bit 3/Receive-Spare Code Definition Bit 3 (C3). A “don’t care” if a 1-bit to 4-bit length is selected Bit 4/Receive-Spare Code Definition Bit 4 (C4). A “don’t care” if a 1-bit to 3-bit length is selected. Bit 5/Receive-Spare Code Definition Bit 5 (C5). A “don’t care” if a 1-bit or 2-bit length is selected. Bit 6/Receive-Spare Code Definition Bit 6 (C6). A “don’t care” if a 1-bit length is selected. Bit 7/Receive-Spare Code Definition Bit 7 (C7). First bit of the repeating pattern. Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: RSCD2 Receive-Spare Code Definition Register 2 BFh Bit # Name Default 6 C6 0 7 C7 0 5 C5 0 4 C4 0 3 C3 0 2 C2 0 1 C1 0 Bit 0/Receive-Spare Code Definition Bit 0 (C0). A “don’t care” if a 1-bit to 7-bit length is selected. Bit 1/Receive-Spare Code Definition Bit 1 (C1). A “don’t care” if a 1-bit to 7-bit length is selected. Bit 2/Receive-Spare Code Definition Bit 2 (C2). A “don’t care” if a 1-bit to 7-bit length is selected. Bit 3/Receive-Spare Code Definition Bit 3 (C3). A “don’t care” if a 1-bit to 7-bit length is selected. Bit 4/Receive-Spare Code Definition Bit 4 (C4). A “don’t care” if a 1-bit to 7-bit length is selected. Bit 5/Receive-Spare Code Definition Bit 5 (C5). A “don’t care” if a 1-bit to 7-bit length is selected. Bit 6/Receive-Spare Code Definition Bit 6 (C6). A “don’t care” if a 1-bit to 7-bit length is selected. Bit 7/Receive-Spare Code Definition Bit 7 (C7). A “don’t care” if a 1-bit to 7-bit length is selected. 185 of 270 0 C0 0 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 27. BERT FUNCTION The BERT (Bit Error-Rate Tester) block can generate and detect both pseudorandom and repeating-bit patterns. It is used to test and stress data-communication links. The BERT block can generate and detect the following patterns: § § § § The pseudorandom patterns 2E7, 2E11, 2E15, and QRSS A repetitive pattern from 1 to 32 bits in length Alternating (16-bit) words that flip every 1 to 256 words Daly pattern The BERT function is assigned on a per-channel basis for both the transmitter and receiver. This is accomplished by using the special per-channel function. Using this function, the BERT pattern can be transmitted and/or received in single or across multiple DS0s, contiguous or broken. Transmit and receive bandwidth assignments are independent of each other. The BERT receiver has a 32-bit bit counter and a 24-bit error counter. The BERT receiver will report three events: a change in receive-synchronizer status, a bit error detection, and if either the bit counter or the error counter overflows. Each of these events can be masked within the BERT function via the BERT control register 1 (BC1). If the software detects that the BERT has reported an event, then the software must read the BERT information register (BIR) to determine which event(s) has occurred. To activate the BERT block, the host must configure the BERT multiplexer via the BIC register. SR9 contains the status information on the BERT function. The host can be alerted when there is a change of state of the BERT via this register. A major change of state is defined as either a change in the receive synchronization (i.e., the BERT has gone into or out of receive synchronization), a bit error has been detected, or an overflow has occurred in either the bit counter or the error counter. The host must read SR9 to determine the change of state. 186 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 27.1 BERT Register Description Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 TC 0 BC1 BERT Control Register 1 E0h 6 TINV 0 5 RINV 0 4 PS2 0 3 PS1 0 2 PS0 0 1 LC 0 0 RESYNC 0 Bit 0/Force Resynchronization (RESYNC). A low-to-high transition will force the receive BERT synchronizer to resynchronize to the incoming data stream. This bit should be toggled from low to high whenever the host wishes to acquire synchronization on a new pattern. Must be cleared and set again for a subsequent resynchronization. Bit 1/Load Bit and Error Counters (LC). A low-to-high transition latches the current bit and error counts into the registers BBC1/BBC2/BBC3/BBC4 and BEC1/BEC2/BEC3 and clears the internal count. This bit should be toggled from low to high whenever the host wishes to begin a new acquisition period. Must be cleared and set again for a subsequent loads. Bits 2 to 4/Pattern Select Bits (PS0 to PS2) PS2 0 0 0 PS1 0 0 1 PS0 0 1 0 0 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 1 1 1 0 1 1 1 PATTERN DEFINITION Pseudorandom 2E7–1 Pseudorandom 2E11–1 Pseudorandom 2E15–1 Pseudorandom Pattern QRSS. A 220 - 1 pattern with 14 consecutive zero restriction. Repetitive Pattern Alternating Word Pattern Modified 55 Octet (Daly) Pattern The Daly pattern is a repeating 55 octet pattern that is byte-aligned into the active DS0 time slots. The pattern is defined in an ATIS (Alliance for Telecommunications Industry Solutions) Committee T1 Technical Report Number 25 (November 1993). Pseudorandom 2E9 - 1 Bit 5/Receive Invert Data Enable (RINV). 0 = do not invert the incoming data stream 1 = invert the incoming data stream Bit 6/Transmit Invert Data Enable (TINV). 0 = do not invert the outgoing data stream 1 = invert the outgoing data stream Bit 7/Transmit Pattern Load (TC). A low-to-high transition loads the pattern generator with the pattern that is to be generated. This bit should be toggled from low to high whenever the host wishes to load a new pattern. Must be cleared and set again for a subsequent loads. 187 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 EIB2 0 BC2 BERT Control Register 2 E1h 6 EIB1 0 5 EIB0 0 4 SBE 0 3 RPL3 0 2 RPL2 0 1 RPL1 0 0 RPL0 0 Bits 0 to 3/Repetitive Pattern Length Bit 3 (RPL0 to RPL3). RPL0 is the LSB and RPL3 is the MSB of a nibble that describes the how long the repetitive pattern is. The valid range is 17 (0000) to 32 (1111). These bits are ignored if the receive BERT is programmed for a pseudorandom pattern. To create repetitive patterns less than 17 bits in length, the user must set the length to an integer number of the desired length that is less than or equal to 32. For example, to create a 6-bit pattern, the user can set the length to 18 (0001) or to 24 (0111) or to 30 (1101). Length (Bits) 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 RPL3 RPL2 RPL1 RPL0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 Bit 4/Single Bit Error Insert (SBE). A low-to-high transition will create a single bit error. Must be cleared and set again for a subsequent bit error to be inserted. Bits 5 to 7/Error Insert Bits 0 to 2 (EIB0 to EIB2). Will automatically insert bit errors at the prescribed rate into the generated data pattern. Can be used for verifying error detection features. EIB2 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 EIB1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 EIB0 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 ERROR RATE INSERTED No errors automatically inserted 10E-1 10E-2 10E-3 10E-4 10E-5 10E-6 10E-7 188 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 — 0 BIC BERT Interface Control Register EAh 6 RFUS 0 5 — 0 4 TBAT 0 3 TFUS 0 2 — 0 1 BERTDIR 0 0 BERTEN 0 Bit 0/BERT Enable (BERTEN). 0 = BERT disabled 1 = BERT enabled Bit 1/BERT Direction (BERTDIR). 0 = network: BERT transmits toward the network (TTIP and TRING) and receives from the network (RTIP and RRING). The BERT pattern can be looped back to the receiver internally by using the Framer Loopback function. 1 = system: BERT transmits toward the system backplane (RSER) and receives from the system backplane (TSER) Bit 2/Unused, must be set to zero for proper operation. Bit 3/Transmit Framed/Unframed Select (TFUS). For T1 mode only. 0 = BERT will not source data into the F-bit position (framed) 1 = BERT will source data into the F-bit position (unframed) Bit 4/Transmit Byte Align Toggle (TBAT). A zero-to-one transition will force the BERT to byte align its pattern with the transmit formatter. This bit must be transitioned in order to byte-align the Daly Pattern. Bit 5/Unused, must be set to zero for proper operation. Bit 6/Receive Framed/Unframed Select (RFUS). For T1 mode only. 0 = BERT will not sample data from the F-bit position (framed) 1 = BERT will sample data from the F-bit position (unframed) Bit 7/Unused, must be set to zero for proper operation. 189 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 — 0 SR9 Status Register 9 26h 6 BBED 0 5 BBCO 0 4 BEC0 0 3 BRA1 0 2 BRA0 0 1 BRLOS 0 0 BSYNC 0 Bit 0/BERT in Synchronization Condition (BSYNC). Will be set when the incoming pattern matches for 32 consecutive bit positions. Refer to BSYNC in INFO2 register for a real-time version of this bit. Bit 1/BERT Receive Loss Of Synchronization Condition (BRLOS). A latched bit that is set whenever the receive BERT begins searching for a pattern. The BERT will lose sync after receiving six errored bits out of 63 bits. Synchronization is lost when six errors are received in 63 bits. Once synchronization is achieved, this bit will remain set until read. Bit 2/BERT Receive All Zeros Condition (BRA0). A latched bit that is set when 32 consecutive zeros are received. Allowed to be cleared once a one is received. Bit 3/BERT Receive All Ones Condition (BRA1). A latched bit that is set when 32 consecutive ones are received. Allowed to be cleared once a zero is received. Bit 4/BERT Error Counter Overflow (BECO) Event (BECO). A latched bit that is set when the 24-bit BERT error counter (BEC) overflows. Cleared when read and will not be set again until another overflow occurs. Bit 5/BERT Bit Counter Overflow Event (BBCO). A latched bit that is set when the 32-bit BERT bit counter (BBC) overflows. Cleared when read and will not be set again until another overflow occurs. Bit 6/BERT Bit Error Detected (BED) Event (BBED). A latched bit that is set when a bit error is detected. The receive BERT must be in synchronization for it detect bit errors. Cleared when read. 190 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 — 0 IMR9 Interrupt Mask Register 9 27h 6 BBED 0 5 BBCO 0 4 BEC0 0 3 BRA1 0 2 BRA0 0 1 BRLOS 0 0 BSYNC 0 Bit 0/BERT in Synchronization Condition (BSYNC). 0 = interrupt masked 1 = interrupt enabled–interrupts on rising and falling edges Bit 1/Receive Loss Of Synchronization Condition (BRLOS). 0 = interrupt masked 1 = interrupt enabled–interrupts on rising and falling edges Bit 2/Receive All Zeros Condition (BRA0). 0 = interrupt masked 1 = interrupt enabled–interrupts on rising and falling edges Bit 3/Receive All Ones Condition (BRA1). 0 = interrupt masked 1 = interrupt enabled–interrupts on rising and falling edges Bit 4/BERT Error Counter Overflow Event (BECO). 0 = interrupt masked 1 = interrupt enabled Bit 5/BERT Bit Counter Overflow Event (BBCO). 0 = interrupt masked 1 = interrupt enabled Bit 6/Bit Error Detected Event (BBED). 0 = interrupt masked 1 = interrupt enabled BERT Alternating Word Count Rate. When the BERT is programmed in the alternating word mode, the words will repeat for the count loaded into this register then flip to the other word and again repeat for the number of times loaded into this register Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 ACNT7 0 BAWC BERT Alternating Word Count Rate DBh 6 ACNT6 0 5 ACNT5 0 4 ACNT4 0 3 ACNT3 0 2 ACNT2 0 1 ACNT1 0 0 ACNT0 0 Bits 0 to 7/Alternating Word Count Rate Bits 0 to 7 (ACNT0 to ACNT7). ACNT0 is the LSB of the 8-bit alternating word count rate counter. 191 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 27.2 BERT Repetitive Pattern Set These registers must be properly loaded for the BERT to generate and synchronize to a repetitive pattern, a pseudorandom pattern, alternating word pattern, or a Daly pattern. For a repetitive pattern that is less than 32 bits, the pattern should be repeated so that all 32 bits are used to describe the pattern. For example, if the pattern was the repeating 5-bit pattern …01101… (where the right-most bit is the one sent first and received first) then BRP1 should be loaded with ADh, BRP2 with B5h, BRP3 with D6h, and BRP4 should be loaded with 5Ah. For a pseudorandom pattern, all four registers should be loaded with all ones (i.e., FFh). For an alternating word pattern, one word should be placed into BRP1 and BRP2 and the other word should be placed into BRP3 and BRP4. For example, if the DDS stress pattern “7E” is to be described, the user would place 00h in BRP1, 00h in BRP2, 7Eh in BRP3, and 7Eh in BRP4, and the alternating word counter would be set to 50 (decimal) to allow 100 bytes of 00h followed by 100 bytes of 7Eh to be sent and received. Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 RPAT7 0 BRP1 BERT Repetitive Pattern Set Register 1 DCh 6 RPAT6 0 5 RPAT5 0 4 RPAT4 0 3 RPAT3 0 2 RPAT2 0 1 RPAT1 0 0 RPAT0 0 Bits 0 to 7/BERT Repetitive Pattern Set Bits 0 to 7 (RPAT0 to RPAT7). RPAT0 is the LSB of the 32-bit repetitive pattern set. Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 RPAT15 0 BRP2 BERT Repetitive Pattern Set Register 2 DDh 6 RPAT14 0 5 RPAT13 0 4 RPAT12 0 3 RPAT11 0 2 RPAT10 0 1 RPAT9 0 0 RPAT8 0 1 RPAT17 0 0 RPAT16 0 1 RPAT25 0 0 RPAT24 0 Bits 0 to 7/BERT Repetitive Pattern Set Bits 8 to 15 (RPAT8 to RPAT15). Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 RPAT23 0 BRP3 BERT Repetitive Pattern Set Register 3 DEh 6 RPAT22 0 5 RPAT21 0 4 RPAT20 0 3 RPAT19 0 2 RPAT18 0 Bits 0 to 7/BERT Repetitive Pattern Set Bits 16 to 23 (RPAT16 to RPAT23). Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 RPAT31 0 BRP4 BERT Repetitive Pattern Set Register 4 DFh 6 RPAT30 0 5 RPAT29 0 4 RPAT28 0 3 RPAT27 0 2 RPAT26 0 Bits 0 to 7/BERT Repetitive Pattern Set Bits 24 to 31 (RPAT24 to RPAT31). RPAT31 is the LSB of the 32-bit repetitive pattern set. 192 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 27.3 BERT Bit Counter Once the BERT has achieved synchronization, this 32-bit counter will increment for each data bit (i.e., clock) received. Toggling the LC control bit in BC1 can clear this counter, which saturates when full and will set the BBCO status bit. Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 BBC7 0 BBC1 BERT Bit Count Register 1 E3h 6 BBC6 0 5 BBC5 0 4 BBC4 0 3 BBC3 0 2 BBC2 0 1 BBC1 0 0 BBC0 0 Bits 0 to 7/BERT Bit Counter Bits 0 to 7 (BBC0 to BBC7). BBC0 is the LSB of the 32-bit counter. Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 BBC15 0 BBC2 BERT Bit Count Register 2 E4h 6 BBC14 0 5 BBC13 0 4 BBC12 0 3 BBC11 0 2 BBC10 0 1 BBC9 0 0 BBC8 0 2 BBC18 0 1 BBC17 0 0 BBC16 0 2 BBC26 0 1 BBC25 0 0 BBC24 0 Bits 0 to 7/BERT Bit Counter Bits 8 to 15 (BBC8 to BBC15). Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 BBC23 0 BBC3 BERT Bit Count Register 3 E5h 6 BBC22 0 5 BBC21 0 4 BBC20 0 3 BBC19 0 Bits 0 to 7/BERT Bit Counter Bits 16 to 23 (BBC16 to BBC23). Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 BBC31 0 BBC4 BERT Bit Count Register 4 E6h 6 BBC30 0 5 BBC29 0 4 BBC28 0 3 BBC27 0 Bits 0 to 7/BERT Bit Counter Bits 24 to 31 (BBC24 to BBC31). BBC31 is the MSB of the 32-bit counter. 193 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 27.4 BERT Error Counter Once the BERT has achieved synchronization, this 24-bit counter will increment for each data bit received in error. Toggling the LC control bit in BC1 can clear this counter. This counter saturates when full and will set the BECO status bit. Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 EC7 0 BEC1 BERT Error Count Register 1 E7h 6 EC6 0 5 EC5 0 4 EC4 0 3 EC3 0 2 EC2 0 1 EC1 0 0 EC0 0 Bits 0 to 7/Error Counter Bits 0 to 7 (EC0 to EC7). EC0 is the LSB of the 24-bit counter. Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 EC15 0 BEC2 BERT Error Count Register 2 E8h 6 EC14 0 5 EC13 0 4 EC12 0 3 EC11 0 2 EC10 0 1 EC9 0 0 EC8 0 3 EC19 0 2 EC18 0 1 EC17 0 0 EC16 0 Bits 0 to 7/Error Counter Bits 8 to 15 (EC8 to EC15). Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 EC23 0 BEC3 BERT Error Count Register 3 E9h 6 EC22 0 5 EC21 0 4 EC20 0 Bits 0 to 7/Error Counter Bits 16 to 23 (EC16 to EC23). EC23 is the MSB of the 24-bit counter. 194 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 28. PAYLOAD ERROR INSERTION FUNCTION An error-insertion function is available in the DS21455/DS21458 and is used to create errors in the payload portion of the T1 frame in the transmit path. Errors can be inserted over the entire frame or on a per-channel basis. The user can select all DS0s or any combination of DS0s. See the Special Per-Channel Registration Operation section for information on using the per-channel function. Errors are created by inverting the last bit in the count sequence. For example, if the error rate 1 in 16 is selected, the 16th bit is inverted. F-bits are excluded from the count and are never corrupted. Error-rate changes occur on frame boundaries. Error-insertion options include continuous and absolute number with both options supporting selectable-insertion rates. Table 28-1. TRANSMIT ERROR INSERTION SETUP SEQUENCE STEP 1 2A or 2B ACTION Enter desired error rate in the ERC register. Note: If ER3 through ER0 = 0, no errors will be generated even if the constant error insertion feature is enabled. For constant error insertion set CE = 1 (ERC.4). For a defined number of errors: - Set CE = 0 (ERC.4) - Load NOE1 and NOE2 with the number of errors to be inserted - Toggle WNOE (ERC.7) from 0 to 1, to begin error insertion 195 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: ERC Error Rate Control Register EBh Bit # Name Default 6 — 0 7 WNOE 0 5 — 0 4 CE 0 3 ER3 0 2 ER2 0 1 ER1 0 0 ER0 0 Bits 0 to 3/Error Insertion Rate Select Bits (ER0 to ER3). ER3 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 ER2 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 ER1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 ER0 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 ERROR RATE No errors inserted 1 in 16 1 in 32 1 in 64 1 in 128 1 in 256 1 in 512 1 in 1024 1 in 2048 1 in 4096 1 in 8192 1 in 16,384 1 in 32,768 1 in 65,536 1 in 131,072 1 in 262,144 Bit 4/Constant Errors (CE). When this bit is set high (and the ER0 to ER3 bits are not set to 0000), the error insertion logic will ignore the number of error registers (NOE1, NOE2) and generate errors constantly at the selected insertion rate. When CE is set to zero, the NOEx registers determine how many errors are to be inserted. Bit 5/Unused, must be set to zero for proper operation. Bit 6/Unused, must be set to zero for proper operation. Bit 7/Write NOE Registers (WNOE). If the host wishes to update to the NOEx registers, this bit must be toggled from a zero to a one after the host has already loaded the prescribed error count into the NOEx registers. The toggling of this bit causes the error count loaded into the NOEx registers to be loaded into the error insertion circuitry on the next clock cycle. Subsequent updates require that the WNOE bit be set to zero and then one once again. 196 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 28.1 Number of Error Registers The number of error registers determines how many errors will be generated. Up to 1023 errors can be generated. The host will load the number of errors to be generated into the NOE1 and NOE2 registers. The host can also update the number of errors to be created by first loading the prescribed value into the NOE registers and then toggling the WNOE bit in the error rate control registers. Table 28-2. ERROR INSERTION EXAMPLES VALUE 000h 001h 002h 3FFh WRITE Do not create any errors Create a single error Create two errors Create 1023 errors Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: NOE1 Number Of Errors 1 ECh Bit # Name Default 6 C6 0 7 C7 0 5 C5 0 READ No errors left to be inserted One error left to be inserted Two errors left to be inserted 1023 errors left to be inserted 4 C4 0 3 C3 0 2 C2 0 1 C1 0 0 C0 0 Bits 0 to 7/Number of Errors Counter Bits 0 to 7 (C0 to C7). Bit C0 is the LSB of the 10-bit counter. Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: NOE2 Number Of Errors 2 EDh Bit # Name Default 6 — 0 7 — 0 5 — 0 4 — 0 3 — 0 2 — 0 1 C9 0 0 C8 0 Bits 0 to 1/Number of Errors Counter Bits 8 to 9 (C8 to C9). Bit C9 is the MSB of the 10-bit counter. 197 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 28.1.1 Number of Errors Left Register The host can read the NOELx registers at any time to determine how many errors are left to be inserted. Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: NOEL1 Number of Errors Left 1 EEh Bit # Name Default 6 C6 0 7 C7 0 5 C5 0 4 C4 0 3 C3 0 2 C2 0 1 C1 0 0 C0 0 Bits 0 to 7/Number of Errors Left Counter Bits 0 to 7 (C0 to C7). Bit C0 is the LSB of the 10-bit counter. Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: NOEL2 Number Of Errors Left 2 EFh Bit # Name Default 6 — 0 7 — 0 5 — 0 4 — 0 3 — 0 2 — 0 1 C9 0 0 C8 0 Bits 0 to 1/Number of Errors Left Counter Bits 8 to 9 (C8 to C9). Bit C9 is the MSB of the 10-bit counter. 198 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 29. INTERLEAVED PCM BUS OPERATION In many architectures, the PCM outputs of individual framers are combined into higher speed PCM buses to simplify transport across the system backplane. The DS21455/DS21458 can be configured to allow PCM data to be multiplexed into higher speed buses eliminating external hardware, saving board space and cost. The DS21455/DS21458 can be configured for channel or frame interleave. The interleaved PCM bus option (IBO) supports three bus speeds. The 4.096MHz bus speed allows two PCM data streams to share a common bus. The 8.192MHz bus speed allows four PCM data streams to share a common bus. The 16.384MHz bus speed allows eight PCM data streams to share a common bus. See Figure 30-1 for an example of four transceivers sharing a common 8.192MHz PCM bus. The receive elastic stores of each transceiver must be enabled. Via the IBO register the user can configure each transceiver for a specific bus position. For all IBO bus configurations each transceiver is assigned an exclusive position in the high-speed PCM bus. The 8kHz frame sync can be generated from the system backplane or from the first device on the bus. All other devices on the bus must have their frame syncs configured as inputs. Relative to this common frame sync, the devices will await their turn to drive or sample the bus according to the settings of the DA0, DA1, and DA2 bits of the IBOC register. 29.1 Channel Interleave Mode In channel interleave mode, data is output to the PCM data-out bus one channel at a time from each of the connected devices until all channels of frame n from each device has been placed on the bus. This mode can be used even when the DS21455/DS21458s are operating asynchronous to each other. The elastic stores will manage slip conditions. 29.2 Frame Interleave Mode In frame interleave mode, data is output to the PCM data-out bus one frame at a time from each of the devices. This mode is used only when all connected devices are operating in a synchronous fashion (all inbound T1 or E1 lines are synchronous) and are synchronous with the system clock (system clock derived from T1 or E1 line). In this mode, slip conditions are not allowed. 199 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default IBOC Interleave Bus Operation Control Register C5h 7 — 0 6 IBS1 0 5 IBS0 0 4 IBOSEL 0 3 IBOEN 0 2 DA2 0 1 DA1 0 0 DA0 0 Bits 0 to 2/Device Assignment bits (DA0 to DA2). DA2 DA1 DA0 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 DEVICE POSITION 1st device on bus 2nd device on bus 3rd device on bus 4th device on bus 5th device on bus 6th device on bus 7th device on bus 8th device on bus Bit 3/Interleave Bus Operation Enable (IBOEN). 0 = Interleave Bus Operation disabled 1 = Interleave Bus Operation enabled Bit 4/Interleave Bus Operation Select (IBOSEL). This bit selects channel- or frame-interleave mode. 0 = Channel Interleave 1 = Frame Interleave Bits 5 to 6/IBO Bus Size bit 1 (IBS0 to IBS1). Indicates how many devices on the bus. IBS1 0 0 1 1 IBS0 0 1 0 1 BUS SIZE Two Devices on Bus Four Devices on Bus Eight Devices on Bus Reserved for Future Use Bit 7/Unused, must be set to zero for proper operation. 200 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Figure 29-1. IBO Example DS21455 or DS21458 RSYSCLK1 TSYSCLK1 RSYNC1 TSSYNC1 RSIG1 TSIG1 SCT #1 TSER1 RSER1 8.192MHz System Clock In RSYSCLK2 TSYSCLK2 RSYNC2 TSSYNC2 RSIG2 System 8kHz Frame Sync In PCM Signaling Out PCM Signaling In TSIG2 SCT #2 TSER2 PCM Data In RSER2 PCM Data Out RSYSCLK3 TSYSCLK3 RSYNC3 TSSYNC3 RSIG3 TSIG3 SCT #3 TSER3 RSER3 RSYSCLK4 TSYSCLK4 RSYNC4 TSSYNC4 RSIG4 TSIG4 SCT #4 TSER4 RSER4 201 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 30. EXTENDED SYSTEM INFORMATION BUS (ESIB) The ESIB function is carried forward from the previous generation of single port transceiver devices such as the DS2155 and DS2156. This function allows the host to read interrupt and alarm status of multiple ports, up to 8, with a single read of any one of the devices in the ESIB group. Each device is programmed to drive a single bit on the CPU bus (leaving the other bits in high-Z) when one of the four ESIB registers (ESIB1–ESIB4) is accessed on any device in the group. Three signals were used to allow the separate devices to communicate with each other in order to respond to an ESIB register access on any device in the group. These signals are ESIBS0, ESIBS1, and ESIBRD. Since the DS21458 and DS21455 are quad monolithic devices, the ESIB function can be used to arrange two devices (eight transceivers) in an ESIB group. Primarily, this is used to quickly sort out interrupts since the host can determine which port or ports are causing and interrupt with a single CPU read cycle. The user can also read various alarm indicators on all members. There are two control registers, ESIBCR1 and ESIBCR2, and four information registers, ESIB1, ESIB2, ESIB3, and ESIB4, in each transceiver. Reading register ESIB1 of any member of the group, the host can read the interrupt status on all members. Via ESIB2 the host can gather synchronization status on all members of the group. ESIB3 and ESIB4 can be programmed to report various alarms on a device-by-device basis. 202 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Figure 30-1. DS21455 ESIB Group DS21455 #2 DS21455 #1 PORT # 1 PORT #5 ESIBS0_1 ESIBS0_1 ESIBS1_1 ESIBS1_1 ESIBRD_1 ESIBRD_1 PORT # 6 PORT # 2 ESIBS0_2 ESIBS0_2 ESIBS1_2 ESIBS1_2 ESIBRD_2 ESIBRD_2 PORT # 7 PORT # 3 ESIBS0_3 ESIBS0_3 ESIBS1_3 ESIBS1_3 ESIBRD_3 ESIBRD_3 PORT # 8 PORT # 4 ESIBS0_4 ESIBS0_4 ESIBS1_4 ESIBS1_4 ESIBRD_4 ESIBRD_4 CPU I/F CPU I/F NOTE: UP TO 8 PORTS (TWO DS21455s) CAN BE ARRANGED INTO AN ESIB GROUP. ON THE DS21455, ESIB SIGNALS ARE BROUGHT OUT FOR EACH TRANSCEIVER. 203 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Figure 30-2. DS21458 ESIB Group DS21458 #1 DS21458 #2 PORT # 1 PORT # 5 ESIBS0 ESIBS1 ESIBRD PORT # 2 PORT #6 PORT # 3 PORT # 7 PORT # 4 PORT # 8 CPU I/F CPU I/F NOTE: UP TO 8 PORTS (TWO DS21458s) CAN BE ARRANGED INTO AN ESIB GROUP. ON THE DS21458, THE ESIB IS INTERNALLY CONNECTED FOR EACH OF THE FOUR TRANSCEIVERS. 204 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: ESIBCR1 Extended System Information Bus Control Register 1 B0h Bit # Name Default 6 — 0 7 — 0 5 — 0 4 — 0 3 ESIBSEL2 0 2 ESIBSEL1 0 1 ESIBSEL0 0 0 ESIEN 0 Bit 0/Extended System Information Bus Enable (ESIEN). 0 = disabled 1 = enabled Bits 1 to 3/Output Data Bus Line Select (ESIBSEL0 to ESIBSEL2). These bits tell the device which data bus bit to output the ESIB data on when one of the ESIB information registers is accessed. Each member of the ESIB group must have a unique bit selected. ESIBSEL2 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 ESIBSEL1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 ESIBSEL0 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 BUS BIT DRIVEN AD0 AD1 AD2 AD3 AD4 AD5 AD6 AD7 Bit 4/Unused, must be set to zero for proper operation. Bit 5/Unused, must be set to zero for proper operation. Bit 6/Unused, must be set to zero for proper operation. Bit 7/Unused, must be set to zero for proper operation. 205 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default ESIBCR2 Extended System Information Bus Control Register 2 B1h 7 — 0 6 ESI4SEL2 0 5 ESI4SEL1 0 4 ESI4SEL0 0 3 — 0 2 ESI3SEL2 0 1 ESI3SEL1 0 0 ESI3SEL0 0 Bits 0 to 2/Address ESI3 Data Output Select (ESI3SEL0 to ESI3SEL2). These bits select what status is to be output when the device decodes an ESI3 address during a bus read operation. ESI3SEL2 ESI3SEL1 ESI3SEL0 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 STATUS OUTPUT T1 MODE E1 MODE RBL RUA1 RYEL RRA LUP RDMA LDN V52LNK SIGCHG SIGCHG ESSLIP ESSLIP — — — — Bit 3/Unused, must be set to zero for proper operation. Bits 4 to 6/Address ESI4 Data Output Select (ESI4SEL0 to ESI4SEL2). These bits select what status is to be output when the device decodes an ESI4 address during a bus-read operation. ESI4SEL2 ESI4SEL1 ESI4SEL0 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 STATUS OUTPUT T1 MODE E1 MODE RBL RUA1 RYEL RRA LUP RDMA LDN V52LNK SIGCHG SIGCHG ESSLIP ESSLIP — — — — Bit 7/Unused, must be set to zero for proper operation. 206 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: ESIB1 Extended System Information Bus Register 1 B2h Bit # Name Default 6 DISn 0 7 DISn 0 5 DISn 0 4 DISn 0 3 DISn 0 2 DISn 0 1 DISn 0 0 DISn 0 Bits 0 to 7/Device Interrupt Status (DISn). Causes all devices participating in the ESIB group to output their interrupt status on the appropriate data bus line selected by the ESIBSEL0 to ESIBSEL2 bits of the ESIBCR1 register. Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 DRLOSn 0 ESIB2 Extended System Information Bus Register 2 B3h 6 DRLOSn 0 5 DRLOSn 0 4 DRLOSn 0 3 DRLOSn 0 2 DRLOSn 0 1 DRLOSn 0 0 DRLOSn 0 Bits 0 to 7/Device Receive Loss of Sync (DRLOSn). Causes all devices participating in the ESIB group to output their frame synchronization status on the appropriate data bus line selected by the ESIBSEL0 to ESIBSEL2 bits of the ESIBCR1 register. Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 UST1n 0 ESIB3 Extended System Information Bus Register 3 B4h 6 UST1n 0 5 UST1n 0 4 UST1n 0 3 UST1n 0 2 UST1n 0 1 UST1n 0 0 UST1n 0 Bits 0 to 7/User-Selected Status 1 (UST1n). Causes all devices participating in the ESIB group to output status or alarms as selected by the ESI3SEL0 to ESI3SEL2 bits in the ESIBCR2 configuration register on the appropriate data bus line selected by the ESIBSEL0 to ESIBSEL2 bits of the ESIBCR2 register. Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 UST2n 0 ESIB4 Extended System Information Bus Register 4 B5h 6 UST2n 0 5 UST2n 0 4 UST2n 0 3 UST2n 0 2 UST2n 0 1 UST2n 0 0 UST2n 0 Bits 0 to 7/User-Selected Status 2 (UST2n). Causes all devices participating in the ESIB group to output status or alarms as selected by the ESI4SEL0 to ESI4SEL2 bits in the ESIBCR2 configuration register on the appropriate data bus line selected by the ESIBSEL0 to ESIBSEL2 bits of the ESIBCR2 register. 207 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 31. PROGRAMMABLE BACKPLANE CLOCK SYNTHESIZER The DS21455/DS21458 contain an on-chip clock synthesizer that generates a user-selectable clock referenced to the recovered receive clock (RCLK). The synthesizer uses a phase-locked loop to generate low-jitter clocks. Common applications include generation of port and backplane system clocks. Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: CCR2 Common Control Register 2 71h Bit # Name Default 6 — 0 7 — 0 5 — 0 4 — 0 3 — 0 Bit 0/Backplane Clock Enable (BPEN). 0 = disable BPCLK pin (Pin held at logic 0) 1 = enable BPCLK pin Bits 1 to 2/Backplane Clock Selects (BPCS0, BPCS1). BPCS1 0 0 1 1 BPCS0 0 1 0 1 BPCLK FREQUENCY (MHz) 16.384 8.192 4.096 2.048 Bit 3/Unused, must be set to zero for proper operation. Bit 4/Unused, must be set to zero for proper operation. Bit 5/Unused, must be set to zero for proper operation. Bit 6/Unused, must be set to zero for proper operation. Bit 7/Unused, must be set to zero for proper operation. 208 of 270 2 BPCS1 0 1 BPCS0 0 0 BPEN 0 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 32. FRACTIONAL T1/E1 SUPPORT The DS21455/DS21458 can be programmed to output gapped clocks for selected channels in the receive and transmit paths to simplify connections into a USART or LAPD controller in fractional T1/E1 or ISDN-PRI applications. This is accomplished by assigning an alternate function to the RCHCLK and TCHCLK pins. When the gapped clock feature is enabled, a gated clock is output on the RCHCLK and/or TCHCLK pins. The channel selection is controlled via the special per-channel control registers. No clock is generated at the F-bit position. The receive and transmit paths have independent enables. Channel formats supported include 56kbps and 64kbps. When 56kbps mode is selected, the clock corresponding to the data/control bit in the channel is omitted. Only the seven most significant bits of the channel have clocks. Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default 7 — 0 CCR3 Common Control Register 3 72h 6 — 0 5 — 0 4 — 0 3 TDATFMT 0 Bit 0/Receive Gapped-Clock Enable (RGPCKEN). 0 = RCHCLK functions normally 1 = enable gapped-bit clock output on RCHCLK Bit 1/Receive Channel-Data Format (RDATFMT). 0 = 64kbps (data contained in all 8 bits) 1 = 56kbps (data contained in 7 out of the 8 bits) Bit 2/Transmit Gapped-Clock Enable (TGPCKEN). 0 = TCHCLK functions normally 1 = enable gapped-bit clock output on TCHCLK Bit 3/Transmit Channel-Data Format (TDATFMT). 0 = 64kbps (data contained in all 8 bits) 1 = 56kbps (data contained in 7 out of the 8 bits) Bit 4/Unused, must be set to zero for proper operation. Bit 5/Unused, must be set to zero for proper operation. Bit 6/Unused, must be set to zero for proper operation. Bit 7/Unused, must be set to zero for proper operation. 209 of 270 2 TGPCKEN 0 1 RDATFMT 0 0 RGPCKEN 0 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 33. USER-PROGRAMMABLE OUTPUT PINS The DS21455/DS21458 provide four user-programmable output pins. The pins are automatically cleared to zero at power-up or as a reset of a hardware- or software-issued reset. Register Name: Register Description: Register Address: Bit # Name Default CCR4 Common Control Register 4 73h 7 RLT3 0 6 RLT2 0 5 RLT1 0 4 RLT0 0 3 UOP3 0 Bit 0/User-Defined Output 0 (UOP0). 0 = logic 0 level at pin 1 = logic 1 level at pin Bit 1/User-Defined Output 1 (UOP1). 0 = logic 0 level at pin 1 = logic 1 level at pin Bit 2/User-Defined Output 2 (UOP2). 0 = logic 0 level at pin 1 = logic 1 level at pin Bit 3/User-Defined Output 3 (UOP3). 0 = logic 0 level at pin 1 = logic 1 level at pin Bits 4 to 7/Receive Level Threshold Bits (RLT0 to RLT3). RLT3 RLT2 RLT1 RLT0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 Receive Level (dB) Greater than -2.5 -2.5 -5.0 -7.5 -10.0 -12.5 -15.0 -17.5 -20.0 -22.5 -25.0 -27.5 -30.0 -32.5 -35.0 Less than -37.5 210 of 270 2 UOP2 0 1 UOP1 0 0 UOP0 0 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 34. TRANSMIT FLOW DIAGRAMS Figure 34-1. T1 Transmit Data Flow TSIG TSER T1 TRANSMIT FLOW DIAGRAM Hardware Signaling HSIE1-3 through PCPR TX ESTORE KEY - PIN Estore Mux ESCR.4 TESE - SELECTOR RDATA From T1_rcv_logic LBCR1.1 PLB Payload Loopback HDLC Engine #1 TLINK H1TC.4 THMS1 HDLC FDL #1 HDLC Mux #1 HDLC Engine #2 H2TC.4 THMS2 THMS1 H1TC.4 H1TCS1-3 H1TTSBS THMS2 H2TC.4 H2TCS1-3 HDLC Mux #2 HDLC FDL #2 TFDL T1TCR2.5 TZSE - REGISTER H2TTSBS Idle Code Array Tx FDL Zero Stuffer TCICE1-3 Idle Code Mux T1TCR1.2 TFDLS FDL Mux TFDL Loop Code Gen BOC Engine BOCC.0 SBOC Loop Code BOC Mux T1CCR1.2 TFM T1TCR2.2 TD4YM T1TCR1.0 TYEL D4 12th Fs Yellow alarm ESF Yellow Alarm FPS or Ft/Fs insertion Per-Channel Loopback To ESF Yellow Mux 211 of 270 PCLR1-3 Software Sig Registers Software Sig F-bit Mux To FDL Mux TLOOP T1CCR1.0 To FDL Mux SSIE1-3 TFPT T1TCR1.5 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Figure 34-2. T1 Transmit Data Flow (continued) From ESF Yellow Alarm From BOC Mux From F-bit Mux TFPT T1TCR1.5 FDL Mux TFM T1CCR1.2 ESF Yellow TYEL T1TCR1.0 CRC Mux TCPT T1TCR1.5 D4 bit 2 Yellow Alm BERT Engine TFM T1CCR1.2 TD4YM T1TCR2.2 TYEL T1TCR1.0 TFUS BIC.3 F-bit BERT Mux T1TCR2.3 FBCT1 T1TCR2.4 FBCT2 F-bit Corruption BTCS1-3 Payload error insertion NOEL != 0 ERC.4 CE BERTEN BIC.0 PEICS1-3 SSIE1-3 Bit 7 stuffing T1CCR1.1 PDE GB7S T1TCR1.3 B7SE T1TCR2.0 Pulse Density Enforcer TPDV INFO1.6 DS0 Monitor CRC Calculation B8ZS Encoding T1TCR2.7 B8ZSE T1TCR1.1 TBL Blue Alarm IOCR1.0 ODF Bipolar/ NRZ coding 1/2 CLK/ FULL CLK CCR1.4 ODM TPOS from PCPR TNEG 212 of 270 TCM0-4 TDS0SEL.0 - .3 TDSOM DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Figure 34-3. E1 Transmit Data Flow TSER HSIE1-4 through PCPR E1 TRANSMIT FLOW DIAGRAM TSIG Hardware Signaling tx_hsig_buf KEY TX ESTORE - PIN ESCR.4 TESE Estore Mux - SELECTOR RDATA From E1_rcv_logic LBCR1.1 PLB Payload Loopback Mux - REGISTER HDLC Engine #1 THMS1 H1TC.4 HDLC DS0 Mux #1 H1TCS1-4 H1TTSBS THMS1 H1TC.4 HDLC Sa-bit Mux #1 T1SaBE4T1SaBE8 H1TTSBS.4 - H1TTSBS.0 HDLC Engine #2 THMS2 H2TC.4 H2TCS1-4 H2TTSBS HDLC DS0 Mux #2 THMS2 H2TC.4 HDLC Sa-bit Mux #2 T2SaBE4-T2SaBE8 H2TTSBS.4 H2TTSBS.0 BERT Engine BERTEN (BIC.0) BERT Mux BTCS1-4 Idle Code Array Idle Code MUX TCICE1-4 To Per-Channel Mux 213 of 270 from PCPR DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Figure 34-4. E1 Transmit Data Flow (continued) From Idle Code Mux RDATA From E1_rcv_logic Per-Channel Loopback E1 TRANSMIT FLOW DIAGRAM PCLR1-4 TNAF THMS1 Sa-bit Mux THMS2 H2TC.4 TAF/TNAF(non Sa) TS0 Mux E1TCR1.4 TSIS H1TC.4 TFPT E1TCR1.7 Si-bit Mux Si = CRC4 MF Align Word (Does not overwrite E-bits) E1TCR1.0 TCRC4 E1TCR2.2 AEBE Sa4S - Sa8S E1TCR2.5 - E1TCR2.7 E1TCR2.8 ARA TSaCR Si/CRC4 Mux TLINK Auto Ebit Gen TLINK Mux TSiAF TSiNAF TRA TSa4 Auto RA Gen TSa5 TSa6 TSa7 TSa8 TSaCR Mux TSA1 E1TCR1.3 SSIE1-4 E1TCR1.0 T16S Software Sig E1TCR1.0 TCRC4 CRC Calculate CCR1.6 CRC4R CRC Recalculate E1TCR2.1 AAIS Auto AIS Gen E1TCR1.5 TUA1 UA1 Gen E1TCR1.2 THDB3 TS1-16 TDS0SEL.0 - TDS0SEL.4 TCM0-TCM4 DS0 Monitor HDB3 Encoding To Bipolar/NRZ coding Mux 214 of 270 TDSOM DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Figure 34-5. E1 Transmit Data Flow (continued) From HDB3 Encoding Mux IOCR1.0 ODF Bipolar/ NRZ coding E1 TRANSMIT FLOW DIAGRAM FLB LBCR1.0 FLB Select RPOS TO RECEIVER RNEG RLB Mux RLB Mux RLB LBCR1.2 1/2 CLK/ FULL CLK CCR1.4 ODM TPOS TNEG 215 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 35. JTAG-BOUNDARY-SCAN ARCHITECTURE AND TEST-ACCESS PORT The DS21455/DS21458 IEEE 1149.1 design supports the standard instruction codes SAMPLE/PRELOAD, BYPASS, and EXTEST. Optional public instructions included are HIGH-Z, CLAMP, and IDCODE. The DS21455/DS21458 contain the following as required by IEEE 1149.1 Standard Test-Access Port and Boundary-Scan Architecture: § § § § § § Test Access Port (TAP) TAP Controller Instruction Register Bypass Register Boundary Scan Register Device Identification Register The Test Access Port has the necessary interface pins: JTRST, JTCLK, JTMS, JTDI, and JTDO. See the pin descriptions for details. Figure 35-1. JTAG Functional Block Diagram BOUNDRY SCAN REGISTER IDENTIFICATION REGISTER BYPASS REGISTER MUX INSTRUCTION REGISTER TEST ACCESS PORT CONTROLLER VDD 10kW VDD 10kW JTDI SELECT OUTPUT ENABLE VDD 10kW JTMS JTCLK JTRST 216 of 270 JTDO DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers TAP Controller State Machine The TAP controller is a finite state machine that responds to the logic level at JTMS on the rising edge of JTCLK (Figure 35-2). Test-Logic-Reset Upon power-up, the TAP controller will be in the test-logic-reset state. The instruction register will contain the IDCODE instruction. All system logic of the device will operate normally. Run-Test-Idle The run-test-idle is used between scan operations or during specific tests. The instruction register and test registers will remain idle. Select-DR-Scan All test registers retain their previous state. With JTMS LOW, a rising edge of JTCLK moves the controller into the capture-DR state and will initiate a scan sequence. JTMS HIGH during a rising edge on JTCLK moves the controller to the select-IR-scan state. Capture-DR Data can be parallel-loaded into the test-data registers selected by the current instruction. If the instruction does not call for a parallel load or the selected register does not allow parallel loads, the test register will remain at its current value. On the rising edge of JTCLK, the controller will go to the shiftDR state if JTMS is LOW or it will go to the exit1-DR state if JTMS is HIGH. Shift-DR The test-data register selected by the current instruction will be connected between JTDI and JTDO and will shift data one stage towards its serial output on each rising edge of JTCLK. If a test register selected by the current instruction is not placed in the serial path, it will maintain its previous state. Exit1-DR While in this state, a rising edge on JTCLK will put the controller in the update-DR state, which terminates the scanning process, if JTMS is HIGH. A rising edge on JTCLK with JTMS LOW will put the controller in the pause-DR state. Pause-DR Shifting of the test registers is halted while in this state. All test registers selected by the current instruction will retain their previous state. The controller will remain in this state while JTMS is LOW. A rising edge on JTCLK with JTMS HIGH will put the controller in the exit2-DR state. Exit2-DR A rising edge on JTCLK with JTMS HIGH while in this state will put the controller in the update-DR state and terminate the scanning process. A rising edge on JTCLK with JTMS LOW will enter the shiftDR state. Update-DR A falling edge on JTCLK while in the update-DR state will latch the data from the shift register path of the test registers into the data output latches. This prevents changes at the parallel output due to changes in the shift register. 217 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Select-IR-Scan All test registers retain their previous state. The instruction register will remain unchanged during this state. With JTMS LOW, a rising edge on JTCLK moves the controller into the capture-IR state and will initiate a scan sequence for the instruction register. JTMS HIGH during a rising edge on JTCLK puts the controller back into the test-logic-reset state. Capture-IR The capture-IR state is used to load the shift register in the instruction register with a fixed value. This value is loaded on the rising edge of JTCLK. If JTMS is HIGH on the rising edge of JTCLK, the controller will enter the exit1-IR state. If JTMS is LOW on the rising edge of JTCLK, the controller will enter the shift-IR state. Shift-IR In this state, the shift register in the instruction register is connected between JTDI and JTDO and shifts data one stage for every rising edge of JTCLK towards the serial output. The parallel register as well as all test registers remain at their previous states. A rising edge on JTCLK with JTMS HIGH will move the controller to the exit1-IR state. A rising edge on JTCLK with JTMS LOW will keep the controller in the shift-IR state while moving data one stage thorough the instruction shift register. Exit1-IR A rising edge on JTCLK with JTMS LOW will put the controller in the pause-IR state. If JTMS is HIGH on the rising edge of JTCLK, the controller will enter the update-IR state and terminate the scanning process. Pause-IR Shifting of the instruction shift register is halted temporarily. With JTMS HIGH, a rising edge on JTCLK will put the controller in the exit2-IR state. The controller will remain in the pause-IR state if JTMS is LOW during a rising edge on JTCLK. Exit2-IR A rising edge on JTCLK with JTMS LOW will put the controller in the update-IR state. The controller will loop back to shift-IR if JTMS is HIGH during a rising edge of JTCLK in this state. Update-IR The instruction code shifted into the instruction shift register is latched into the parallel output on the falling edge of JTCLK as the controller enters this state. Once latched, this instruction becomes the current instruction. A rising edge on JTCLK with JTMS LOW, will put the controller in the run-test-idle state. With JTMS HIGH, the controller will enter the select-DR-scan state. 218 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Figure 35-2. TAP Controller State Diagram 1 Test Logic Reset 0 0 Run Test/ Idle 1 Select DR-Scan 1 Select IR-Scan 0 1 0 1 Capture DR Capture IR 0 Shift DR 0 Shift IR 0 1 Exit IR Pause IR 0 1 0 1 0 0 Pause DR 0 1 1 Exit DR 1 Exit2 DR 1 0 Exit2 IR 1 1 Update DR Update IR 1 1 0 219 of 270 0 0 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 35.1 Instruction Register The instruction register contains a shift register as well as a latched parallel output and is 3 bits in length. When the TAP controller enters the shift-IR state, the instruction shift register will be connected between JTDI and JTDO. While in the shift-IR state, a rising edge on JTCLK with JTMS LOW will shift the data one stage towards the serial output at JTDO. A rising edge on JTCLK in the exit1-IR state or the exit2-IR state with JTMS HIGH will move the controller to the update-IR state. The falling edge of that same JTCLK will latch the data in the instruction shift register to the instruction parallel output. Instructions supported by the DS21455/DS21458 and their respective operational binary codes are shown in Table 35-1. Table 35-1. INSTRUCTION CODES FOR IEEE 1149.1 ARCHITECTURE INSTRUCTION SELECTED REGISTER INSTRUCTION CODES SAMPLE/PRELOAD BYPASS EXTEST CLAMP HIGH-Z IDCODE Boundary Scan Bypass Boundary Scan Bypass Bypass Device Identification 010 111 000 011 100 001 220 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers SAMPLE/PRELOAD This is a mandatory instruction for the IEEE 1149.1 specification that supports two functions. The digital I/Os of the device can be sampled at the boundary scan register without interfering with the normal operation of the device by using the capture-DR state. SAMPLE/PRELOAD also allows the device to shift data into the boundary scan register via JTDI using the shift-DR state. BYPASS When the BYPASS instruction is latched into the parallel instruction register, JTDI connects to JTDO through the one-bit bypass test register. This allows data to pass from JTDI to JTDO not affecting the device’s normal operation. EXTEST This allows testing of all interconnections to the device. When the EXTEST instruction is latched in the instruction register, the following actions occur. Once enabled via the Update-IR state, the parallel outputs of all digital output pins will be driven. The boundary scan register will be connected between JTDI and JTDO. The Capture-DR will sample all digital inputs into the boundary scan register. CLAMP All digital outputs of the device will output data from the boundary scan parallel output while connecting the bypass register between JTDI and JTDO. The outputs will not change during the CLAMP instruction. HIGH-Z All digital outputs of the device will be placed in a high-impedance state. The BYPASS register will be connected between JTDI and JTDO. IDCODE When the IDCODE instruction is latched into the parallel instruction register, the identification test register is selected. The device identification code will be loaded into the identification register on the rising edge of JTCLK following entry into the capture-DR state. Shift-DR can be used to shift the identification code out serially via JTDO. During test-logic-reset, the identification code is forced into the instruction register’s parallel output. The ID code will always have a 1 in the LSB position. The next 11 bits identify the manufacturer’s JEDEC number and number of continuation bytes followed by 16 bits for the device and 4 bits for the version (Table 35-2). Table 35-3 lists the device ID codes for the DS21455 and DS21458. Table 35-2. ID CODE STRUCTURE MSB Version Contact Factory 4 bits LSB Device ID JEDEC 1 16 bits 00010100001 1 Table 35-3. DEVICE ID CODES DEVICE DS21455 DS21458 16-BIT ID 0021h 0022h 221 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 35.2 Test Registers IEEE 1149.1 requires a minimum of two test registers: the bypass register and the boundary scan register. An optional test register has been included with the DS21455/DS21458 design. This test register is the identification register and is used with the IDCODE instruction and the test-logic-reset state of the TAP controller. 35.3 Boundary Scan Register This register contains both a shift register path and a latched parallel output for all control cells and digital I/O cells and is n bits in length. See Table 35-4 for the cell bit locations and definitions. 35.4 Bypass Register This is a single 1-bit shift register used with the BYPASS, CLAMP, and HIGH-Z instructions that provides a short path between JTDI and JTDO. 35.5 Identification Register The identification register contains a 32-bit shift register and a 32-bit latched parallel output. This register is selected during the IDCODE instruction and when the TAP controller is in the test-logic-reset state. See Table 35-2 and Table 35-3 for more information about bit usage. 222 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Table 35-4. BOUNDARY SCAN CONTROL BITS CELL # NAME TYPE 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 RCLKO3 RLINK3 TSYNC3 TSYNC3_CTL TSSYNC3 TLCLK3 TCHCLK3 TCHBLK3 RSYNC3 RSYNC3_CTL RSIGF3 RMSYNC3 RLOS/LOTC3 RLCLK3 RFSYNC3 RCHCLK3 RCHBLK3 ESIBS1_3 ESIBS1_3_CTL ESIBS0_3 ESIBS0_3_CTL ESIBRD3 ESIBRD3_CTL RSIG3 RNEGI3 RPOSI3 RNEGO3 RPOSO3 BPCLK3 RSER3 RSYSCLK3 TSYSCLK3 CS3/NC LIUC WR (R/W) A5 A1 D1/AD1 RD (DS) BTS RCLKI2 RCLK2 TSIG2 TSER2 TLINK2 TCLKI2 TCLK2 TNEGI2 TPOSI2 observe_only observe_only output3 controlr observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only output3 controlr observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only output3 controlr output3 controlr output3 controlr observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only output3 observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only CONTROL CELL 3 9 18 20 22 133 223 of 270 NOTES DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers CELL # NAME TYPE 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 TCLKO2 TPOSO2 TNEGO2 RCLKO2 RLINK2 TSYNC2 TSYNC2_CTL TSSYNC2 TLCLK2 TCHCLK2 TCHBLK2 RSYNC2 RSYNC2_CTL RSIGF2 RMSYNC2 RLOS/LOTC2 RLCLK2 RFSYNC2 RCHCLK2 RCHBLK2 observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only output3 controlr observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only output3 controlr observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only 69 ESIBS1_2 output3 70 ESIBS1_2_CTL controlr 71 ESIBS0_2 output3 72 ESIBS0_2_CTL controlr 73 ESIBRD2 output3 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86 87 88 89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 ESIBRD2_CTL RSIG2 RNEGI2 RPOSI2 RNEGO2 RPOSO2 BPCLK2 RSER2 RSYSCLK2 TSYSCLK2 CS2/A9 TSTRST RCLKI4 RCLK4 TSIG4 TSER4 TLINK4 TCLKI4 TCLK4 TNEGI4 TPOSI4 TCLKO4 TPOSO4 controlr observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only CONTROL CELL NOTES 55 61 70 Internally bonded to ESIBS1_1, ESIBS1_3, ESIBS1_4 on DS21458 72 Internally bonded to ESIBS0_1, ESIBS0_3, ESIBS0_4 on DS21458 74 Internally bonded to ESIBRD1, ESIBRD3, ESIBRD4 on DS21458 224 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers CELL # NAME TYPE 97 98 99 100 101 102 103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112 113 114 TNEGO4 RCLKO4 RLINK4 TSYNC4 TSYNC4_CTL TSSYNC4 TLCLK4 TCHCLK4 TCHBLK4 RSYNC4 RSYNC4_CTL RSIGF4 RMSYNC4 RLOS/LOTC4 RLCLK4 RFSYNC4 RCHCLK4 RCHBLK4 observe_only observe_only observe_only output3 controlr observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only output3 controlr observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only 115 ESIBS1_4 output3 116 ESIBS1_4_CTL controlr 117 ESIBS0_4 output3 118 ESIBS0_4_CTL controlr 119 ESIBRD4 output3 120 121 122 123 124 125 126 127 128 129 130 131 132 133 134 135 136 137 138 139 140 141 142 143 144 ESIBRD4_CTL RSIG4 RNEGI4 RPOSI4 RNEGO4 RPOSO4 BPCLK4 RSER4 RSYSCLK4 TSYSCLK4 CS4/CS D2/AD2 D0/AD0 AD_BUS_CTL MUX D4/AD4 A4 A6 D3/AD3 D5/AD5 RCLKI1 RCLK1 TSIG1 TSER1 TLINK1 controlr observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only output3 output3 controlr observe_only output3 observe_only observe_only output3 output3 observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only CONTROL CELL NOTES 101 107 116 Internally bonded to ESIBS1_1, ESIBS1_2, ESIBS1_3 on DS21458 118 Internally bonded to ESIBS0_1, ESIBS0_2, ESIBS0_3 on DS21458 120 Internally bonded to ESIBRD1, ESIBRD2, ESIBRD3 on DS21458 133 133 133 133 133 225 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers CELL # NAME TYPE 145 146 147 148 149 150 151 152 153 154 155 156 157 158 159 160 161 162 163 164 165 166 167 168 TCLKI1 TCLK1 TNEGI1 TPOSI1 TCLKO1 TPOSO1 TNEGO1 RCLKO1 RLINK1 TSYNC1 TSYNC1_CTL TSSYNC1 TLCLK1 TCHCLK1 TCHBLK1 RSYNC1 RSYNC1_CTL RSIGF1 RMSYNC1 RLOS/LOTC1 RLCLK1 RFSYNC1 RCHCLK1 RCHBLK1 observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only output3 controlr observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only output3 controlr observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only 169 ESIBS1_1 output3 170 ESIBS1_1_CTL controlr 171 ESIBS0_1 output3 172 ESIBS0_1_CTL controlr 173 ESIBRD1 output3 174 175 176 177 178 179 180 181 182 183 184 185 186 187 188 189 190 191 192 ESIBRD1_CTL RSIG1 RNEGI1 RPOSI1 RNEGO1 RPOSO1 BPCLK1 RSER1 RSYSCLK1 TSYSCLK1 CS1/A8 INT A2 A0 A3 D7/AD7 D6/AD6 A7/ALE RCLKI3 controlr observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only output3 output3 observe_only observe_only CONTROL CELL NOTES 155 161 170 Internally bonded to ESIBS1_2, ESIBS1_3, ESIBS1_4 on DS21458 172 Internally bonded to ESIBS0_2, ESIBS0_3, ESIBS0_4 on DS21458 174 Internally bonded to ESIBRD2, ESIBRD3, ESIBRD4 on DS21458 133 133 226 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers CELL # NAME TYPE 193 194 195 196 197 198 199 200 201 202 203 RCLK3 TSIG3 TSER3 TLINK3 TCLKI3 TCLK3 TNEGI3 TPOSI3 TCLKO3 TPOSO3 TNEGO3 observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only observe_only CONTROL CELL 227 of 270 NOTES DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 36. FUNCTIONAL TIMING DIAGRAMS 36.1 T1 Mode Figure 36-1. Receive Side D4 Timing FRAME# 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4 5 RFSYNC RSYNC 1 RSYNC 2 3 RSYNC RLCLK RLINK 4 NOTES: 1) 2) 3) 4) RSYNC in the frame mode (IOCR1.5 = 0) and double-wide frame sync is not enabled (IOCR1.6 = 0). RSYNC in the frame mode (IOCR1.5 = 0) and double-wide frame sync is enabled (IOCR1.6 = 1). RSYNC in the multiframe mode (IOCR1.5 = 1). RLINK data (Fs-bits) is updated one bit prior to even frames and held for two frames. 228 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Figure 36-2. Receive Side ESF Timing FRAME# 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 1 2 3 4 5 1 RSYNC RFSYNC RSYNC 2 RSYNC 3 RLCLK 4 5 RLINK TLCLK 6 TLINK 7 NOTES: 1) 2) 3) 4) 5) 6) 7) RSYNC in frame mode (IOCR1.4 = 0) and double-wide frame sync is not enabled (IOCR1.6 = 0). RSYNC in frame mode (IOCR1.4 = 0) and double-wide frame sync is enabled (IOCR1.6 = 1). RSYNC in multiframe mode (IOCR1.4 = 1). ZBTSI mode disabled (T1RCR2.2 = 0). RLINK data (FDL bits) is updated one bit time before odd frames and held for two frames. ZBTSI mode is enabled (T1RCR2.2 = 1). RLINK data (Z bits) is updated one bit time before odd frames and held for four frames. 229 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Figure 36-3. Receive Side Boundary Timing (With Elastic Store Disabled) RCLK CHANNEL 23 RSER CHANNEL 24 CHANNEL 1 LSB LSB MSB F MSB RSYNC RFSYNC RSIG CHANNEL 23 A B C/A D/B CHANNEL 24 A B C/A D/B RCHCLK RCHBLK1 RLCLK RLINK 2 NOTES: 1) RCHBLK is programmed to block channel 24. 2) Shown is RLINK/RLCLK in the ESF framing mode. 230 of 270 CHANNEL 1 A DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Figure 36-4. Receive Side 1.544MHz Boundary Timing (With Elastic Store Enabled) RSYSCLK CHANNEL 23 RSER CHANNEL 24 CHANNEL 1 LSB LSB MSB F MSB RSYNC1 RMSYNC RSYNC2 RSIG CHANNEL 23 A B C/A D/B CHANNEL 24 A B C/A D/B RCHCLK RCHBLK 3 NOTES: 1) RSYNC is in the output mode (IOCR1.4 = 0). 2) RSYNC is in the input mode (IOCR1.4 = 1). 3) RCHBLK is programmed to block channel 24. 231 of 270 CHANNEL 1 A DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Figure 36-5. Receive Side 2.048MHz Boundary Timing (With Elastic Store Enabled) RSYSCLK RSER RSYNC 1 CHANNEL 31 CHANNEL 32 CHANNEL 1 LSB LSB MSB 2 RMSYNC 3 RSYNC RSIG A CHANNEL 31 B C/A D/B A CHANNEL 32 B C/A D/B RCHCLK RCHBLK 4 NOTES: 1) 2) 3) 4) 5) RSER data in channels 1, 5, 9, 13, 17, 21, 25, and 29 are forced to one. RSYNC is in the output mode (IOCR1.4 = 0). RSYNC is in the input mode (IOCR1.4 = 1). RCHBLK is forced to one in the same channels as RSER (Note 1). The F-bit position is passed through the receive-side elastic store. 232 of 270 CHANNEL 1 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Figure 36-6. Transmit Side D4 Timing FRAME# 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4 5 1 TSYNC TSSYNC 2 TSYNC 3 TSYNC TLCLK TLINK 4 NOTES: 1) 2) 3) 4) TSYNC in the frame mode (IOCR1.2 = 0) and double-wide frame sync is not enabled (IOCR1.1 = 0). TSYNC in the frame mode (IOCR1.2 = 0) and double-wide frame sync is enabled (IOCR1.1 = 1). TSYNC in the multiframe mode (IOCR1.2 = 1). TLINK data (Fs-bits) is sampled during the F-bit position of even frames for insertion into the outgoing T1 stream when enabled via T1TCR1.2. 233 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Figure 36-7. Transmit Side ESF Timing FRAME# 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 1 2 3 4 5 TSYNC1 TSSYNC TSYNC 2 3 TSYNC TLCLK 4 TLINK TLCLK 5 TLINK 6 NOTES: 1) 2) 3) 4) TSYNC in frame mode (IOCR1.2 = 0) and double-wide frame sync is not enabled (IOCR1.3 = 0). TSYNC in frame mode (IOCR1.2 = 0) and double-wide frame sync is enabled (IOCR1.3 = 1). TSYNC in multiframe mode (IOCR1.2 = 1). TLINK data (FDL bits) sampled during the F-bit time of odd frame and inserted into the outgoing T1 stream if enabled via TCR1.2. 5) ZBTSI mode is enabled (T1TCR2.1 = 1). 6) TLINK data (Z bits) sampled during the F-bit time of frames 1, 5, 9, 13, 17, and 21 and inserted into the outgoing stream if enabled via T1TCR1.2. 234 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Figure 36-8. Transmit Side Boundary Timing (With Elastic Store Disabled) TCLK CHANNEL 1 LSB TSER F CHANNEL 2 MSB LSB MSB LSB MSB TSYNC1 TSYNC2 CHANNEL 1 TSIG D/B A B CHANNEL 2 C/A D/B TCHCLK TCHBLK 3 TLCLK TLINK 4 DON'T CARE NOTES: 1) 2) 3) 4) TSYNC is in the output mode (IOCR1.1 = 1). TSYNC is in the input mode (IOCR1.1 = 0). TCHBLK is programmed to block channel 2. Shown is TLINK/TLCLK in the ESF framing mode. 235 of 270 A B C/A D/B DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Figure 36-9. Transmit Side 1.544MHz Boundary Timing (With Elastic Store Enabled) TSYSCLK CHANNEL 23 CHANNEL 24 LSB MSB TSER CHANNEL 1 LSB F MSB TSSYNC CHANNEL 23 TSIG A B CHANNEL 24 C/A D/B A B CHANNEL 1 C/A D/B A TCHCLK TCHBLK 1 NOTE: 1) TCHBLK is programmed to block channel 24 (if the TPCSI bit is set, then the signaling data at TSIG will be ignored during channel 24). 236 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Figure 36-10. Transmit Side 2.048MHz Boundary Timing (With Elastic Store Enabled) TSYSCLK CHANNEL 31 TSER 1 CHANNEL 32 LSB MSB CHANNEL 1 LSB F 4 TSSYNC CHANNEL 31 TSIG A B CHANNEL 32 C/A D/B A B CHANNEL 1 C/A D/B A TCHCLK TCHBLK 2,3 NOTES: 1) TSER data in channels 1, 5, 9, 13, 17, 21, 25, and 29 is ignored. 2) TCHBLK is programmed to block channel 31 (if the TPCSI bit is set, then the signaling data at TSIG will be ignored). 3) TCHBLK is forced to one in the same channels as TSER is ignored (Note 1). 4) The F-bit position for the T1 frame is sampled and passed through the transmit side elastic store into the MSB bit position of channel 1. (Normally the transmit side formatter overwrites the F-bit position unless the formatter is programmed to pass-through the F-bit position). 237 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 36.2 E1 Mode Figure 36-11. Receive Side Timing FRAME# 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 RFSYNC RSYNC 1 RSYNC 2 RLCLK RLINK 3 4 NOTES: 1) 2) 3) 4) 5) RSYNC in frame mode (IOCR1.5 = 0). RSYNC in multiframe mode (IOCR1.5 = 1). RLCLK is programmed to output just the Sa bits. RLINK will always output all five Sa bits as well as the rest of the receive data stream. This diagram assumes the CAS MF begins in the RAF frame. 238 of 270 1 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Figure 36-12. Receive Side Boundary Timing (With Elastic Store Disabled) RCLK CHANNEL 32 CHANNEL 1 RSER LSB Si 1 A CHANNEL 2 Sa4 Sa5 Sa6 Sa7 Sa8 MSB RSYNC RFSYNC CHANNEL 32 RSIG A B CHANNEL 1 C D CHANNEL 2 A B Note 4 RCHCLK RCHBLK 1 RLCLK RLINK 2 Sa4 Sa5 Sa6 Sa7 Sa8 NOTES: 1) 2) 3) 4) RCHBLK is programmed to block channel 1. RLCLK is programmed to mark the Sa4 bit in RLINK. Shown is a RNAF frame boundary. RSIG normally contains the CAS multiframe-alignment nibble (0000) in channel 1. 239 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Figure 36-13. Receive Side Boundary Timing, RSYSCLK = 1.544MHz (With Elastic Store Enabled) RSYSCLK CHANNEL 23/31 1 RSER CHANNEL 24/32 CHANNEL 1/2 LSB LSB MSB F MSB RSYNC2 RMSYNC 3 RSYNC RCHCLK RCHBLK 4 NOTES: 1) Data from the E1 channels 1, 5, 9, 13, 17, 21, 25, and 29 is dropped (channel 2 from the E1 link is mapped to channel 1 of the T1 link, etc.) and the F-bit position is added (forced to one). 2) RSYNC in the output mode (IOCR1.4 = 0). 3) RSYNC in the input mode (IOCR1.4 = 1). 4) RCHBLK is programmed to block channel 24. 240 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Figure 36-14. Receive Side Boundary Timing, RSYSCLK = 2.048MHz (With Elastic Store Enabled) RSYSCLK CHANNEL 31 RSER CHANNEL 32 LSB MSB CHANNEL 1 LSB MSB RSYNC1 RMSYNC RSYNC 2 RSIG A CHANNEL 31 C B D A CHANNEL 32 C B D CHANNEL 1 Note 4 RCHCLK RCHBLK 3 NOTES: 1) 2) 3) 4) RSYNC is in the output mode (IOCR1.4 = 0). RSYNC is in the input mode (IOCR1.4 = 1). RCHBLK is programmed to block channel 1. RSIG normally contains the CAS multiframe-alignment nibble (0000) in channel 1. 241 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Figure 36-15. Receive IBO Channel Interleave Mode Timing RSYNC 1 RSER FR1 CH32 FR0 CH1 FR1 CH1 FR0 CH2 FR1 CH2 RSIG1 FR1 CH32 FR0 CH1 FR1 CH1 FR0 CH2 FR1 CH2 RSER2 FR2 CH32 FR3 CH32 FR0 CH1 FR1 CH1 FR2 CH1 FR3 CH1 FR0 CH2 FR1 CH2 FR2 CH2 FR3 CH2 RSIG2 FR2 CH32 FR3 CH32 FR0 CH1 FR1 CH1 FR2 CH1 FR3 CH1 FR0 CH2 FR1 CH2 FR2 CH2 FR3 CH2 BIT DETAIL RSYSCLK 3 RSYNC FRAMER 3, CHANNEL 32 RSER FRAMER 3, CHANNEL 32 RSIG FRAMER 1, CHANNEL 1 FRAMER 0, CHANNEL 1 LSB MSB LSB MSB A B C FRAMER 1, CHANNEL 1 FRAMER 0, CHANNEL 1 D A B NOTES: 1) 4.096MHz bus configuration. 2) 8.192MHz bus configuration. 3) RSYNC is in the input mode (IOCR1.4 = 0). 242 of 270 C LSB D A B C D DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Figure 36-16. Receive IBO Frame Interleave Mode Timing RSYNC 1 RSER FR1 CH1-32 FR0 CH1-32 FR1 CH1-32 FR0 CH1-32 FR1 CH1-32 RSIG1 FR1 CH1-32 FR0 CH1-32 FR1 CH1-32 FR0 CH1-32 FR1 CH1-32 RSER2 FR2 CH1-32 FR3 CH1-32 FR0 CH1-32 FR1 CH1-32 FR2 CH1-32 FR3 CH1-32 FR0 CH1-32 FR1 CH1-32 FR2 CH1-32 FR3 CH1-32 RSIG2 FR2 CH1-32 FR3 CH1-32 FR0 CH1-32 FR1 CH1-32 FR2 CH1-32 FR3 CH1-32 FR0 CH1-32 FR1 CH1-32 FR2 CH1-32 FR3 CH1-32 BIT DETAIL RSYSCLK 3 RSYNC FRAMER 3, CHANNEL 32 RSER FRAMER 3, CHANNEL 32 RSIG FRAMER 0, CHANNEL 1 A B FRAMER 0, CHANNEL 2 LSB MSB LSB MSB FRAMER 0, CHANNEL 1 C/A D/B A NOTES: 1) 4.096MHz bus configuration. 2) 8.192MHz bus configuration. 3) RSYNC is in the input mode (IOCR1.4 = 0). 243 of 270 B C/A D/B LSB FRAMER 0, CHANNEL 2 A B C/A D/B DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Figure 36-17. G.802 Timing, E1 Mode Only TS # 31 32 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 0 1 2 RSYNC TSYNC RCHCLK TCHCLK RCHBLK TCHBLK RCLK / RSYSCLK TCLK / TSYSCLK CHANNEL 25 RSER / TSER CHANNEL 26 LSB MSB RCHCLK / TCHCLK RCHBLK / TCHBLK NOTE: 1) RCHBLK or TCHBLK programmed to pulse high during time slots 1 through 15, 17 through 25, and bit 1 of time slot 26. 244 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Figure 36-18. Transmit Side Timing FRAME# 14 15 16 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 1 TSYNC TSSYNC TSYNC TLCLK TLINK 2 3 3 NOTES: 1) 2) 3) 4) 5) TSYNC in frame mode (IOCR1.2 = 0). TSYNC in multiframe mode (IOCR1.2 = 1). TLINK is programmed to source just the Sa4 bit. This diagram assumes both the CAS MF and the CRC-4 MF begin with the TAF frame. TLINK and TLCLK are not synchronous with TSSYNC. 245 of 270 9 10 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Figure 36-19. Transmit Side Boundary Timing (With Elastic Store Disabled) TCLK CHANNEL 1 LSB TSER Si 1 A CHANNEL 2 Sa4 Sa5 Sa6 Sa7 Sa8 MSB LSB MSB TSYNC1 TSYNC2 CHANNEL 1 TSIG CHANNEL 2 D A B C D TCHCLK TCHBLK 3 TLCLK TLINK 4 4 DON'T CARE DON'T CARE NOTES: 1) 2) 3) 4) 5) TSYNC is in the output mode (IOCR1.1 = 1.) TSYNC is in the input mode (IOCR1.1 = 0). TCHBLK is programmed to block channel 2. TLINK is programmed to source the Sa4 bit. The signaling data at TSIG during channel 1 is normally overwritten in the transmit formatter with the CAS multiframe-alignment nibble (0000). 6) Shown is a TNAF frame boundary. 246 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Figure 36-20. Transmit Side Boundary Timing, TSYSCLK = 1.544MHz (With Elastic Store Enabled) TSYSCLK CHANNEL 23 1 TSER CHANNEL 24 LSB MSB LSB TSSYNC TCHCLK TCHBLK CHANNEL 1 2 NOTES: 1) The F-bit position in the TSER data is ignored. 2) TCHBLK is programmed to block channel 24. 247 of 270 F MSB DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Figure 36-21. Transmit Side Boundary Timing, TSYSCLK = 2.048MHz (With Elastic Store Enabled) TSYSCLK CHANNEL 31 CHANNEL 32 TSER1 CHANNEL 1 LSB MSB LSB F 4 TSSYNC CHANNEL 31 TSIG A B CHANNEL 32 C D A TCHCLK TCHBLK 2,3 NOTE: 1) TCHBLK is programmed to block channel 31. 248 of 270 B CHANNEL 1 C D A DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Figure 36-22. Transmit IBO Channel Interleave Mode Timing TSSYNC 1 TSER TSIG1 FR1 CH32 FR0 CH1 FR1 CH1 FR0 CH2 FR1 CH2 FR1 CH32 FR0 CH1 FR1 CH1 FR0 CH2 FR1 CH2 TSER2 FR2 CH32 FR3 CH32 FR0 CH1 FR1 CH1 FR2 CH1 FR3 CH1 FR0 CH2 FR1 CH2 FR2 CH2 FR3 CH2 TSIG2 FR2 CH32 FR3 CH32 FR0 CH1 FR1 CH1 FR2 CH1 FR3 CH1 FR0 CH2 FR1 CH2 FR2 CH2 FR3 CH2 BIT DETAIL TSYSCLK TSSYNC FRAMER 3, CHANNEL 32 TSER LSB MSB LSB MSB FRAMER 3, CHANNEL 32 TSIG A B C/A D/B FRAMER 1, CHANNEL 1 FRAMER 0, CHANNEL 1 FRAMER 0, CHANNEL 1 A NOTES: 1) 4.096MHz bus configuration. 2) 8.192MHz bus configuration. 249 of 270 B C/A D/B LSB FRAMER 1, CHANNEL 1 A B C/A D/B DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Figure 36-23. Transmit IBO Frame Interleave Mode Timing TSSYNC 1 TSER TSIG1 FR1 CH1-32 FR0 CH1-32 FR1 CH1-32 FR0 CH1-32 FR1 CH1-32 FR1 CH1-32 FR0 CH1-32 FR1 CH1-32 FR0 CH1-32 FR1 CH1-32 TSER2 FR2 CH1-32 FR3 CH1-32 FR0 CH1-32 FR1 CH1-32 FR2 CH1-32 FR3 CH1-32 FR0 CH1-32 FR1 CH1-32 FR2 CH1-32 FR3 CH1-32 TSIG2 FR2 CH1-32 FR3 CH1-32 FR0 CH1-32 FR1 CH1-32 FR2 CH1-32 FR3 CH1-32 FR0 CH1-32 FR1 CH1-32 FR2 CH1-32 FR3 CH1-32 BIT DETAIL TSYSCLK TSSYNC FRAMER 3, CHANNEL 32 TSER FRAMER 3, CHANNEL 32 TSIG FRAMER 0, CHANNEL 1 A B C/A D/B FRAMER 0, CHANNEL 2 LSB MSB LSB MSB FRAMER 0, CHANNEL 1 A NOTES: 1) 4.096MHz bus configuration. 2) 8.192MHz bus configuration. 250 of 270 B C/A D/B LSB FRAMER 0, CHANNEL 2 A B C/A D/B DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 37. OPERATING PARAMETERS ABSOLUTE MAXIMUM RATINGS Voltage Range on Any Pin Relative to Ground……………………………………………..-1.0V to +6.0V Operating Temperature Range for DS21455/DS21458………………………………………0°C to +70°C Operating Temperature Range for DS21455N/DS21458N………………………………...-40°C to +85°C Storage Temperature Range……………………………………………………………….-55°C to +125°C Soldering Temperature ………………………………………………………..See IPC/JEDEC J-STD-20A This is a stress rating only and functional operation of the device at these or any other conditions above those indicated in the operation sections of this specification is not implied. Exposure to absolute maximum rating conditions for extended periods of time can affect reliability. THERMAL CHARACTERISTICS PARAMETER Ambient Temperature Junction Temperature Theta-JA (qJA) in Still Air for 100-pin LQFP Theta-JA (qJA) in Still Air for 10mm CSBGA pin LQFP MIN -40°C — — — TYP — — MAX +85°C +125°C — NOTES 1 — 2 2 NOTES: 1) The package is mounted on a four-layer JEDEC standard test board. 2) Theta-JA (qJA) is the junction-to-ambient thermal resistance, when the package is mounted on a fourlayer JEDEC standard test board. THETA-JA (qJA) vs. AIRFLOW FORCED AIR (meters per second) 0 1 2.5 THETA-JA (qJA) 100-PIN LQFP 251 of 270 THETA-JA (qJA) 10mm CSBGA DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers RECOMMENDED DC OPERATING CONDITIONS (TA = 0°C to +70°C for DS21455/DS21458; TA = -40°C to +85°C for DS21455N/DS21458N.) PARAMETER Logic 1 Logic 0 Supply SYMBOL VIH VIL VDD MIN 2.0 -0.3 3.135 TYP SYMBOL CIN COUT MIN TYP 5 7 3.3 MAX 5.5 +0.8 3.465 UNITS V V V NOTES MAX UNITS pF pF NOTES MAX UNITS mA mA mA mA mA NOTES 2 3 4 1 CAPACITANCE (TA = +25°C) PARAMETER Input Capacitance Output Capacitance DC CHARACTERISTICS (VDD = 3.3V ±5%, TA = 0°C to +70°C for DS21455/DS21458; VDD = 3.3V ±5%, TA = -40°C to +85°C for DS21455N/DS21458N.) PARAMETER Supply Current Input Leakage Output Leakage Output Current (2.4V) Output Current (0.4V) SYMBOL IDD IIL ILO IOH IOL MIN TYP 75 -1.0 -1.0 +4.0 +1.0 1.0 NOTES: 1) 2) 3) 4) Applies to RVDD, TVDD, and DVDD. TCLK = TCLKI = RCLKI = TSYSCLK = RSYSCLK = MCLK = 1.544MHz; outputs open circuited. 0.0V < VIN < VDD. Applied to INT when tri-stated. 252 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 38. AC TIMING PARAMETERS AND DIAGRAMS Capacitive test loads are 40pF for bus signals, 20pF for all others. 38.1 Multiplexed Bus AC Characteristics AC CHARACTERISTICS–MULTIPLEXED PARALLEL PORT (MUX = 1) (VDD = 3.3V ±5%, TA = 0°C to +70°C for DS21455/DS21458; VDD = 3.3V ±5%, TA = -40°C to +85°C for DS21455N/DS21458N.) (See Figure 38-1 to Figure 38-3.) PARAMETER Cycle Time Pulse Width, DS Low or RD High Pulse Width, DS High or RD Low Input Rise/Fall Times R/W Hold Time R/W Setup Time Before DS High CS Setup Time Before DS, WR, or RD Active CS Hold Time Read Data Hold Time Write Data Hold Time Muxed Address Valid to AS or ALE Fall Muxed Address Hold Time Delay Time DS, WR, or RD to AS or ALE Rise Pulse Width AS or ALE High Delay Time, AS or ALE to DS, WR, or RD Output Data Delay Time from DS or RD Data Setup Time SYMBOL tCYC PWEL PWEH tR , tF tRWH tRWS MIN 200 100 100 10 50 UNITS ns ns ns ns ns ns tCS 20 ns tCH tDHR tDHW 0 10 5 ns ns ns tASL 15 ns tAHL 10 ns tASD 20 ns PWASH 30 ns tASED 10 ns MAX 20 50 80 tDDR tDSW TYP 50 253 of 270 ns ns NOTES DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Figure 38-1. Intel Bus Read Timing (BTS = 0 / MUX = 1) t CYC ALE WR PWASH t ASD t ASD t ASED PWEH RD t CH t CS PWEL CS t ASL t DHR t DDR AD0-AD7 t AHL A8 & A9 Figure 38-2. Intel Bus Write Timing (BTS = 0 / MUX = 1) t CYC ALE RD PWASH t ASD t ASED t ASD WR PWEL PWEH t CH t CS CS t ASL t DHW AD0-AD7 t AHL A8 & A9 254 of 270 t DSW DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Figure 38-3. Motorola Bus Timing (BTS = 1 / MUX = 1) PWASH AS DS PWEH t ASED t ASD PWEL t CYC t RWS t RWH R/W AD0-AD7 (read) t DDR t ASL t AHL t DHR t CH t CS CS AD0-AD7 (write) t DSW t ASL t AHL A8 & A9 255 of 270 t DHW DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 38.2 Nonmultiplexed Bus AC Characteristics AC CHARACTERISTICS–NONMULTIPLEXED PARALLEL PORT (MUX = 0) (VDD = 3.3V ±5%, TA = 0°C to +70°C for DS21455/DS21458; VDD = 3.3V ±5%, TA = -40°C to +85°C for DS21455N/DS21458N.) (See Figure 38-4 to Figure 38-7.) PARAMETER SYMBOL Setup Time for A0 to A7, Valid to t1 CS Active Setup Time for CS Active to Either t2 RD, WR, or DS Active Delay Time from Either RD or DS t3 Active to Data Valid Hold Time from Either RD, WR, t4 or DS Inactive to CS Inactive Hold Time from CS Inactive to t5 Data Bus Tri-State Wait Time from Either WR or DS t6 Activate to Latch Data Data Setup Time to Either WR or t7 DS Inactive Data Hold Time from Either WR t8 or DS Inactive Address Hold from Either WR or t9 DS Inactive MIN TYP MAX UNITS 0 ns 0 ns 75 0 5 ns ns 20 ns 75 ns 10 ns 10 ns 10 ns 256 of 270 NOTES DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Figure 38-4. Intel Bus Read Timing (BTS = 0 / MUX = 0) A0 to A9 Address Valid D0 to D7 Data Valid t5 WR t1 CS t2 t3 t4 RD* Figure 38-5. Intel Bus Write Timing (BTS = 0 / MUX = 0) A0 to A9 Address Valid D0 to D7 t7 t8 RD t1 CS t2 t6 WR 257 of 270 t4 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Figure 38-6. Motorola Bus Read Timing (BTS = 1 / MUX = 0) A0 to A9 Address Valid D0 to D7 Data Valid t5 R/W t1 CS t2 t3 t4 DS Figure 38-7. Motorola Bus Write Timing (BTS = 1 / MUX = 0) A0 to A9 Address Valid D0 to D7 t7 t8 R/W t1 CS t2 t6 DS 258 of 270 t4 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 38.3 Receive Side AC Characteristics AC CHARACTERISTICS–RECEIVE SIDE (VDD = 3.3V ±5%, TA = 0°C to +70°C for DS21455/DS21458; VDD = 3.3V ±5%, TA = -40°C to +85°C for DS21455N/DS21458N.) (See Figure 38-8 to Figure 38-12.) PARAMETER RCLKO Period RCLKO Pulse Width RCLKO Pulse Width RCLKI Period RCLKI Pulse Width RSYSCLK Period RSYSCLK Pulse Width RSYNC Setup to RSYSCLK Falling RSYNC Pulse Width RPOSI/RNEGI Setup to RCLKI Falling RPOSI/RNEGI Hold from RCLKI Falling RSYSCLK, RCLKI Rise and Fall Times Delay RCLKO to RPOSO, RNEGO Valid Delay RCLK to RSER, RDATA, RSIG, RLINK Valid Delay RCLK to RCHCLK, RSYNC, RCHBLK, RFSYNC, RLCLK Delay RSYSCLK to RSER, RSIG Valid Delay RSYSCLK to RCHCLK, RCHBLK, RMSYNC, RSYNC SYMBOL MIN tLP tLH tLL tLH tLL 200 200 150 150 tCP tCH tCL tSP tSP tSP tSP tSP tSH tSL tSU tPW tSU 20 20 tHD 20 20 20 20 50 20 TYP 488 (E1) 648 (T1) 0.5 tLP 0.5 tLP 0.5 tLP 0.5 tLP 488 (E1) 648 (T1) 0.5 tCP 0.5 tCP 648 488 244 122 61 0.5 tSP 0.5 tSP MAX UNITS ns ns ns ns ns ns 1 1 2 2 ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns t R , tF 22 ns tDD 50 ns tD1 50 ns tD2 50 ns tD3 22 ns tD4 22 ns 259 of 270 NOTES 3 4 5 6 7 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers AC CHARACTERISTICS–RECEIVE SIDE (continued) (VDD = 3.3V ±5%, TA = 0°C to +70°C for DS21455/DS21458; VDD = 3.3V ±5%, TA = -40°C to +85°C for DS21455N/DS21458N.) (See Figure 38-8 to Figure 38-12.) NOTES: 1) 2) 3) 4) 5) 6) 7) Jitter attenuator enabled in the receive path. Jitter attenuator disabled or enabled in the transmit path. RSYSCLK = 1.544MHz. RSYSCLK = 2.048MHz. RSYSCLK = 4.096MHz. RSYSCLK = 8.192MHz. RSYSCLK = 16.384MHz. Figure 38-8. Receive Side Timing, Elastic Store Disabled (T1 Mode) RCLK t D1 F Bit RSER / RDATA / RSIG t D2 RCHCLK t D2 RCHBLK t D2 RFSYNC / RMSYNC t D2 RSYNC 1 RLCLK t D2 2 t D1 RLINK NOTES: 1) RSYNC is in the output mode. 2) Shown is RLINK/RLCLK in the ESF framing mode. 3) No relationship between RCHCLK and RCHBLK and other signals is implied. 260 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Figure 38-9. Receive Side Timing, Elastic Store Disabled (E1 Mode) RCLK t D1 MSB of Channel 1 RSER / RDATA / RSIG t D2 RCHCLK t D2 RCHBLK t D2 RFSYNC / RMSYNC t D2 RSYNC1 t D2 2 RLCLK t D1 RLINK Sa4 to Sa8 Bit Position Notes: 1. RSYNC is in the output mode (RCR1.5 = 0). 2. RLCLK will only pulse high during Sa bit locations as defined in RCR2; no relationship between RLCLK and RSYNC or RFSYNC is implied. 261 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Figure 38-10. Receive Side Timing, Elastic Store Enabled (T1 Mode) t SL tF tR RSYSCLK t SP t D3 F-BIT RSER / RSIG t D4 RCHCLK t D4 RCHBLK t D4 RMSYNC RSYNC RSYNC 1 t D4 t HD 2 t SH t SU NOTES: 1) RSYNC is in the output mode. 2) RSYNC is in the input mode. 262 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Figure 38-11. Receive Side Timing, Elastic Store Enabled (E1 Mode) t SL tF tR RSYSCLK t SH t SP t D3 MSB of Channel 1 RSER / RSIG t D4 RCHCLK t D4 RCHBLK t D4 RMSYNC / CO t D4 RSYNC1 t HD t SU 2 RSYNC t SC t WC CI NOTES: 1) RSYNC is in the output mode. 2) RSYNC is in the input mode. 263 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Figure 38-12. Receive Line Interface Timing t LL RCLKO t LH t LP t DD RPOSO, RNEGO tR t CL tF RCLKI t CP t SU RPOSI, RNEGI t HD 264 of 270 t CH DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 38.4 Transmit AC Characteristics AC CHARACTERISTICS–TRANSMIT SIDE (VDD = 3.3V ±5%, TA = 0°C to +70°C for DS21455/DS21458; VDD = 3.3V ±5%, TA = -40°C to +85°C; for DS21455N/DS21458N.) (See Figure 38-13 to Figure 38-15.) PARAMETER SYMBOL TCLK Period tCP TCLK Pulse Width tCH tCL TCLKI Period tLP TCLKI Pulse Width tLH tLL MIN 20 20 20 20 TYP (E1) 488 (E1) 648 (T1) 0.5 tCP 0.5 tCP 488 (E1) 648 (T1) 0.5 tLP 0.5 tLP 648 448 244 122 61 0.5 tSP 0.5 tSP MAX UNITS ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns TSYSCLK Period tSP TSYSCLK Pulse Width tSP 20 20 tSU 20 ns tPW 50 ns tSU 20 ns tHD 20 ns tHD 20 ns TSYNC or TSSYNC Setup to TCLK or TSYSCLK Falling TSYNC or TSSYNC Pulse Width TSER, TSIG, TDATA, TLINK, TPOSI, TNEGI Setup to TCLK, TSYSCLK, TCLKI Falling TSER, TSIG, TDATA, TLINK Hold from TCLK or TSYSCLK, Falling TPOSI, TNEGI Hold from TCLKI Falling TCLK, TCLKI, or TSYSCLK Rise and Fall Times Delay TCLKO to TPOSO, TNEGO Valid Delay TCLK to TESO Valid Delay TCLK to TCHBLK, TCHCLK, TSYNC, TLCLK Delay TSYSCLK to TCHCLK, TCHBLK tR , tF 25 ns tDD 50 ns tD1 50 ns tD2 50 ns tD3 22 ns NOTES: 1) 2) 3) 4) 5) TSYSCLK = 1.544MHz. TSYSCLK = 2.048MHz. TSYSCLK = 4.096MHz. TSYSCLK = 8.192MHz. TSYSCLK = 16.384MHz. 265 of 270 NOTES 1 2 3 4 5 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Figure 38-13. Transmit Side Timing t CP t CL tF tR t CH TCLK t D1 TESO t SU TSER / TSIG / TDATA t HD t D2 TCHCLK t D2 TCHBLK t D2 TSYNC1 t SU t HD TSYNC2 5 TLCLK t D2 t HD TLINK t SU NOTES: 1) TSYNC is in the output mode (TCR2.2 = 1). 2) TSYNC is in the input mode (TCR2.2 = 0). 3) TSER is sampled on the falling edge of TCLK when the transmit-side elastic store is disabled. 4) TCHCLK and TCHBLK are synchronous with TCLK when the transmit-side elastic store is disabled. 5) TLINK is only sampled during F-bit locations. 6) No relationship between TCHCLK and TCHBLK and the other signals is implied. 266 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Figure 38-14. Transmit Side Timing, Elastic Store Enabled t SP t SL tF tR t SH TSYSCLK t SU TSER t D3 t HD TCHCLK t D3 TCHBLK t SU t HD TSSYNC NOTES: 1) TSER is only sampled on the falling edge of TSYSCLK when the transmit-side elastic store is enabled. 2) TCHCLK and TCHBLK are synchronous with TSYSCLK when the transmit-side elastic store is enabled. 267 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Figure 38-15. Transmit Line Interface Timing TCLKO TPOSO, TNEGO t DD tR t LP t LL tF t LH TCLKI t SU TPOSI, TNEGI t HD NOTES: 1) TSER is only sampled on the falling edge of TSYSCLK when the transmit-side elastic store is enabled. 2) TCHCLK and TCHBLK are synchronous with TSYSCLK when the transmit-side elastic store is enabled. 268 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers 39. PACKAGE INFORMATION (The package drawing(s) in this data sheet may not reflect the most current specifications. For the latest package outline information, go to www.maxim-ic.com/DallasPackInfo.) Figure 39-1. DS21458 (17mm CSBGA) 269 of 270 DS21455/DS21458 Quad T1/E1/J1 Transceivers Figure 39-2. DS21455 (27mm BGA) 270 of 270 Maxim/Dallas Semiconductor cannot assume responsibility for use of any circuitry other than circuitry entirely embodied in a Maxim/Dallas Semiconductor product. No circuit patent licenses are implied. Maxim/Dallas Semiconductor reserves the right to change the circuitry and specifications without notice at any time. Maxim Integrated Products, 120 San Gabriel Drive, Sunnyvale, CA 94086 408-737-7600 © 2004 Maxim Integrated Products · Printed USA